Doc: s/DNS/domains/ in new text
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
45. the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.75"
49.set version "4.80"
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54
55. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
56. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
57. provided in the xfpt library.
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59
60. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
61
62.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
63
64. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
65. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
66
67.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
68.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
69
70. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
71. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
72. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
73. --- index entry.
74
75.macro option
76.arg 5
77.oindex "&%$5%&"
78.endarg
79.arg -5
80.oindex "&%$1%&"
81.endarg
82.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
83.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
84.endtable
85.endmacro
86
87. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
88. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
89. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
90
91.macro table2 196pt 254pt
92.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
93.endmacro
94
95. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
96. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
97. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
98
99.macro irow
100.arg 4
101.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
102.endarg
103.arg -4
104.arg 3
105.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
106.endarg
107.arg -3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2"
109.endarg
110.endarg
111.endmacro
112
113. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
114. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
115. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
116. --- ID that ties them together.
117
118.macro cindex
119&<indexterm role="concept">&
120&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
121.arg 2
122&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
123.endarg
124&</indexterm>&
125.endmacro
126
127.macro scindex
128&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
129&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
130.arg 3
131&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
132.endarg
133&</indexterm>&
134.endmacro
135
136.macro ecindex
137&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
138.endmacro
139
140.macro oindex
141&<indexterm role="option">&
142&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
143.arg 2
144&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
145.endarg
146&</indexterm>&
147.endmacro
148
149.macro vindex
150&<indexterm role="variable">&
151&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
152.arg 2
153&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
154.endarg
155&</indexterm>&
156.endmacro
157
158.macro index
159.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
160.endmacro
161. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
162
163
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
166. output formats.
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168
169.literal xml
170<bookinfo>
171<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
172<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
173<date>17 May 2012</date>
174<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
175<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
176<revhistory><revision>
177 <revnumber>4.80</revnumber>
178 <date>17 May 2012</date>
179 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
180</revision></revhistory>
181<copyright><year>2012</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
182</bookinfo>
183.literal off
184
185
186. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
187. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
188. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
189. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
190. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191
192.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
193.literal xml
194
195<indexterm role="variable">
196 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
197 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
198</indexterm>
199<indexterm role="concept">
200 <primary>address</primary>
201 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
202 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
203</indexterm>
204<indexterm role="concept">
205 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
206 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
207</indexterm>
208<indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
211</indexterm>
212<indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>CR character</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
215</indexterm>
216<indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CRL</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
219</indexterm>
220<indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>delivery</primary>
222 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
223 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
224</indexterm>
225<indexterm role="concept">
226 <primary>dialup</primary>
227 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
228</indexterm>
229<indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>exiscan</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
232</indexterm>
233<indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>failover</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
236</indexterm>
237<indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>fallover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
240</indexterm>
241<indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>filter</primary>
243 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
244 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
245</indexterm>
246<indexterm role="concept">
247 <primary>ident</primary>
248 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
249</indexterm>
250<indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>LF character</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
253</indexterm>
254<indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>maximum</primary>
256 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
257</indexterm>
258<indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>monitor</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
261</indexterm>
262<indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
264 <see>entry for xxx</see>
265</indexterm>
266<indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>NUL</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
269</indexterm>
270<indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>passwd file</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
273</indexterm>
274<indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>process id</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
277</indexterm>
278<indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>RBL</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
281</indexterm>
282<indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>redirection</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
285</indexterm>
286<indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>return path</primary>
288 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
289</indexterm>
290<indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>scanning</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
293</indexterm>
294<indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>SSL</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
297</indexterm>
298<indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>string</primary>
300 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
301 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
302</indexterm>
303<indexterm role="concept">
304 <primary>top bit</primary>
305 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
306</indexterm>
307<indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>variables</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
310</indexterm>
311<indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
314</indexterm>
315
316.literal off
317
318
319. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
320. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
321. we can't have the .chapter line here.
322. chapter "Introduction"
323. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324
325Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
326Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
327run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
328used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
329
330Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
331BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
332GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
333OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
334Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
335Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
336tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
337
338There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
339that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
340not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
341
342The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
343the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
344Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
345
346The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
347unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
348which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
349of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
350mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
351
352Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
353experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
354contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
355were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
356new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
357
358Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
359development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
360systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
361&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
362contributors.
363
364
365.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
366. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
367
368.new
369.cindex "documentation"
370This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
371Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
372renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
373capable of showing a change indicator.
374.wen
375
376This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
377is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
378with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
379and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
380it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
381Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
382a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
383very wide interest.
384
385.cindex "books about Exim"
386An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
387introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
388SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
389(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
390
391This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
392Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
393with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
394published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
395
396.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
397If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
398Debian-specific features in the file
399&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
400The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
401information.
402
403.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
404.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
405.cindex "change log"
406As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
407yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
408digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
409new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
410&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
411
412Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
413incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
414they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
415can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
416
417All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
418change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
419
420.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
421This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
422that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
423directory are:
424
425.table2 100pt
426.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
427.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
428.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
429.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
430.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
431.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
432.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
433.endtable
434
435The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
436available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
437&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438
439
440
441.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
442.cindex "web site"
443.cindex "FTP site"
444The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
445Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
446distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
447&%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
448&%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
449Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
450
451.cindex "wiki"
452.cindex "FAQ"
453As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
454differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
455online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
456which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
457examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
458
459.cindex Bugzilla
460An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
461this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
462first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
463
464
465
466.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
467.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
468The following Exim mailing lists exist:
469
470.table2 140pt
471.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
472.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
475.endtable
476
477You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
478or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
479.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
480If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
481the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
482via this web page:
483.display
484&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
485.endd
486Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
487lists.
488
489.section "Exim training" "SECID4"
490.cindex "training courses"
491Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
492Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
493further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
494information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
495
496.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497.cindex "bug reports"
498.cindex "reporting bugs"
499Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507.cindex "FTP site"
508.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510.display
511&*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
512.endd
513This is mirrored by
514.display
515&*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
516.endd
517The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
518these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520
521Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
525.display
526&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
527&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
528.endd
529where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
530files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
532
533.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
534.cindex "distribution" "public key"
535.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
536The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
537corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
538also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
539in:
540.display
541&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
542&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
543.endd
544For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
545separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
546find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
547
548.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
549The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
550documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
551inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
552.display
553&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
554&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557.endd
558These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
559distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
560
561
562.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
563.ilist
564.cindex "limitations of Exim"
565.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
566Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
567RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
568simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
569configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
570UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
571.next
572.cindex "domainless addresses"
573.cindex "address" "without domain"
574Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
575local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
576configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
577systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
578arrival.
579.next
580.cindex "transport" "external"
581.cindex "external transports"
582The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
583and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
584transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
585and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
586to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
587handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
588.next
589Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
590such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
591(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
592other means.
593.next
594Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
595are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
596are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
597compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
598a number of common scanners are provided.
599.endlist
600
601
602.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
603Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
604into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
605values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
606file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
607distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
608
609
610.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
611.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
612Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
613can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
614&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
615about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
616Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
617example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
618format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6193, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
620documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
621made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
622
623Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
624line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
625which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
626interface to Exim's command line administration options.
627
628
629
630.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
631.cindex "terminology definitions"
632.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
633The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
634It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
635below) by a blank line.
636
637.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
638When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
639delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
640&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
641called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
642failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
643message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
644rise to further bounce messages.
645
646The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
647value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
648also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
649otherwise.
650
651The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
652destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
653down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
654until a later time.
655
656The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
657host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
658the part of an email address following the @ sign.
659
660.cindex "envelope, definition of"
661.cindex "sender" "definition of"
662A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
663body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
664be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
665sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
666envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
667messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
668
669.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
670.cindex "header section" "definition of"
671The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
672of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
673&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
674indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
675line.
676
677.cindex "local part" "definition of"
678.cindex "domain" "definition of"
679The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
680part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
681@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
682
683.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
684.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
685The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
686delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
687TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
688host it is running on are &'remote'&.
689
690.cindex "return path" "definition of"
691&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
692message's envelope.
693
694.cindex "queue" "definition of"
695The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
696because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
697Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
698normally no ordering of waiting messages.
699
700.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
701The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
702and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
703is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
704the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
705
706.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
707The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
708messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
709delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
710mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
711the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
712
713
714
715
716
717
718. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
719. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
720
721.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
722.cindex "incorporated code"
723.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
724.cindex "PCRE"
725A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
726
727.ilist
728Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
729Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
730&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
731Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
732or obtain and install the full version of the library from
733&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
734.next
735.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
736Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
737contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
738Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
739It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
740following statements:
741
742.blockquote
743Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
744
745This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
746the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
747Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
748version.
749This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
750the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
751&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
752some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
753restrictions applied to it).
754.endblockquote
755.next
756.cindex "SPA authentication"
757.cindex "Samba project"
758.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
759Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
760by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
761Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
762under the Gnu GPL.
763.next
764.cindex "Cyrus"
765.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
766.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
767Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
768by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
769Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
770conditions expressed therein.
771
772.blockquote
773Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
774
775Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
776modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
777are met:
778
779.olist
780Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
781notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
782.next
783Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
784notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
785the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
786distribution.
787.next
788The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
789endorse or promote products derived from this software without
790prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
791details, please contact
792.display
793 Office of Technology Transfer
794 Carnegie Mellon University
795 5000 Forbes Avenue
796 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
797 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
798 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
799.endd
800.next
801Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
802acknowledgment:
803
804&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
805at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
806
807CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
808THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
809AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
810FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
811WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
812AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
813OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
814.endlist
815.endblockquote
816
817.next
818.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
819.cindex "X-windows"
820.cindex "Athena"
821The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
822modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
823This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
824below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
825
826.blockquote
827Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
828and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
829
830All Rights Reserved
831
832Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
833documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
834provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
835both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
836supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
837used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
838software without specific, written prior permission.
839
840DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
841ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
842DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
843ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
844WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
845ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
846SOFTWARE.
847.endblockquote
848
849.next
850Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
852contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
853.endlist
854
855
856
857
858
859. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
861
862.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
864
865
866.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867.cindex "design philosophy"
868Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
874
875
876.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877.cindex "policy control" "overview"
878Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
880&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
883
884.ilist
885.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
894error code.
895.next
896An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
898.next
899When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
903.next
904When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
909.next
910Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
913.next
914After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916runs at the start of every delivery process.
917.endlist
918
919
920
921.section "User filters" "SECID12"
922.cindex "filter" "introduction"
923.cindex "Sieve filter"
924In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929of filtering are available:
930
931.ilist
932Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
933by RFC 3028.
934.next
935Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
937.endlist
938
939User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
940
941
942
943.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945.cindex "format" "of message id"
946.cindex "id of message"
947.cindex "base62"
948.cindex "base36"
949.cindex "Darwin"
950.cindex "Cygwin"
951Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
958not always case-sensitive.
959
960.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
966somewhat eccentric:
967
968.ilist
969The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972way of representing the date and time of day).
973.next
974After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975received the message.
976.next
977There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
978.olist
979.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
984.next
985If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
987(1/100) of a second.
988.endlist
989.endlist
990
991After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995will already have ticked while the message was being received.
996
997
998.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999.cindex "receiving mail"
1000.cindex "message" "reception"
1001The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004there are several possibilities:
1005
1006.ilist
1007If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1010.next
1011If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1017.next
1018If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1023.next
1024A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1028.endlist
1029
1030
1031.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1039unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043users to change sender addresses.
1044
1045Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1050requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1052
1053Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058message is received.
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1072
1073.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082affect file system performance.
1083
1084The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1089
1090.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1102
1103
1104
1105.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106.cindex "message" "life of"
1107.cindex "message" "frozen"
1108A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1114
1115.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1120to be sent.
1121
1122.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1127
1128.cindex "message" "log file for"
1129.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1135deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1138systems.
1139
1140.cindex "journal file"
1141.cindex "file" "journal"
1142All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149minimize the possibility of data loss.
1150
1151Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1152the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155deliveries caused by crashes.
1156
1157
1158
1159.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161.cindex "router" "definition of"
1162.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1167ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1168
1169.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1171of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177the driver's features in general.
1178
1179A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1183to be bounced.
1184
1185A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1191
1192.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1198
1199To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1202configuration.
1203
1204The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1206are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212configured to fail the address.
1213
1214The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1220
1221The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226the address is bounced.
1227
1228
1229
1230.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231.cindex "router" "for verification"
1232.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237&%-bvs%& command line options.
1238
1239When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1244previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252.cindex "router" "running details"
1253.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254.cindex "router" "result of running"
1255As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1259the following:
1260
1261.ilist
1262&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264original address ceases,
1265.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1270end of routing.
1271
1272Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1277.next
1278&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1280is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1283.next
1284&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1289.next
1290&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1293.next
1294&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297next time the message is considered for delivery.
1298.next
1299&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1301.endlist
1302
1303If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1308
1309Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313facility for this purpose.
1314
1315
1316.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317.cindex "case of local parts"
1318.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1323actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324routed addresses are shown.
1325
1326
1327
1328.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1334
1335.ilist
1336The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1337the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1338suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1339skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1340removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1341of any other conditions.
1342.next
1343Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1344only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1345&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1346address.
1347Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1348&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1349sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1350you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1351.next
1352If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1353run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1354when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1355makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1356having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1357.next
1358Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1359opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1360.next
1361Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1362check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1363.next
1364If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1365of domains that it defines.
1366.next
1367.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1368.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1369.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1370If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1371the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1372&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1373part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1374that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1375that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1376&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1377.next
1378.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1379.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1380.vindex "&$home$&"
1381If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1382an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1383local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1384user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1385remaining preconditions.
1386.next
1387If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1388because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1389later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1390subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1391could lead to confusion.
1392.next
1393If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1394set of addresses that it defines.
1395.next
1396If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1397specified files is tested.
1398.next
1399.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1400If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1401uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1402Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1403.endlist
1404
1405
1406Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1407it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1408part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1409&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1410&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1411going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1412example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1413
1414
1415
1416.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1417.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1418When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1419
1420.ilist
1421If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1422filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1423message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1424fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1425files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1426filtering'&.
1427.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1428(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1429
1430Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1431&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1432filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1433if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1434be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1435condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1436filter.
1437.next
1438Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1439its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1440address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1441can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1442processed entirely independently of each other.
1443.next
1444.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1445.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1446A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1447transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1448is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1449Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1450from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1451process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1452which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1453.next
1454When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1455handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1456doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1457local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1458collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1459addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1460address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1461addresses to the same domain.
1462.next
1463Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1464non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1465deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1466to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1467run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1468one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1469The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1470deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1471.next
1472.cindex "queue runner"
1473When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1474database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1475address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1476Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1477reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1478queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1479follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1480better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1481causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1482.next
1483.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1484Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1485deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1486retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1487reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1488not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1489.next
1490If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1491appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1492for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1493messages to other addresses.
1494.next
1495.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1496If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1497the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1498&'deferred'&.
1499.next
1500When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1501handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1502deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1503.endlist
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1509.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1510.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1511.cindex "queue runner"
1512Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1513attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1514uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1515intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1516not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1517first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1518its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1519passed its retry time.
1520You can run several queue runners at once.
1521
1522Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1523address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1524should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1525bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1526error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1527as permanent.
1528
1529
1530
1531.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1532.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1533There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1534particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1535connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1536detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1537Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1538is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1539impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1540also apply.
1541
1542If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1543waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1544connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1545deferred,
1546.cindex "hints database"
1547Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1548SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1549for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1550connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1551one connection.
1552
1553
1554
1555.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1556.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1557.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1558When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1559bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1560errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1561delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1562many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1563attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1564message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1565See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1566
1567.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1568Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1569failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1570automatically.
1571
1572.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1573A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1574obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1575address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1576forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1577failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1578&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1579of the list.
1580
1581
1582
1583.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1584.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1585If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1586itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1587but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1588that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1589for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1590&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1597. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1598
1599.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1600.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1601
1602.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1603Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1604creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1605&_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1606
1607.table2 140pt
1608.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1609.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1610 documented"
1611.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1612.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1613.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1614.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1615 instructions"
1616.endtable
1617
1618Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1619following subdirectories are created:
1620
1621.table2 140pt
1622.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1623.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1624.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1625.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1626.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1627.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1628.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1629.endtable
1630
1631The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1632with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1633that may be useful to some sites.
1634
1635
1636.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1637.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1638The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1639a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1640source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1641Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1642system.
1643.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1644Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1645the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1646architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1647overridden if necessary.
1648
1649
1650.new
1651.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1652.cindex "PCRE library"
1653Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1654modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1655to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1656system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1657process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1658headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1659and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1660or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1661If your operating system has no
1662PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1663from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1664More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1665.wen
1666
1667.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1668.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1669.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1670Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1671DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1672databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1673different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1674
1675.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1676.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1677.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1678.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1679If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1680Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1681may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1682you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1683
1684.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1685Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1686via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1687versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1688some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1689distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1690versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1691Berkeley DB library.
1692
1693Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1694use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1695possibilities:
1696
1697.olist
1698A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1699Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1700.next
1701.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1702The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1703compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1704&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1705file name is used unmodified.
1706.next
1707.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1708The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1709operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1710programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1711.next
1712If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1713file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1714the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1715.next
1716To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1717Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17182.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1719numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1720versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1721&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1722.next
1723.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1724Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1725&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1726operates on a single file.
1727.endlist
1728
1729.cindex "USE_DB"
1730.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1731Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1732to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1733USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1734&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1735.code
1736USE_DB=yes
1737.endd
1738Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1739error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1740
1741At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1742thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1743configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1744Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1745configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1746&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1747
1748As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1749necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1750in one of these lines:
1751.code
1752DBMLIB = -ldb
1753DBMLIB = -ltdb
1754.endd
1755Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1756place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1757the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1758file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1759this example:
1760.code
1761INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1762DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1763.endd
1764There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1765file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1766
1767
1768
1769.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1770.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1771.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1772.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1773.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1774Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1775independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1776&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1777&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1778therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1779building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1780&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1781
1782There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1783without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1784(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1785(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1786maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1787a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1788
1789There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1790at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1791machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1792directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1793you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1794detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1795be logged.
1796
1797.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1798Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1799access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1800facilities, you need to set
1801.code
1802WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1803.endd
1804in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1805chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1806
1807
1808.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1809.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1810If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1811required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1812your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1813happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1814&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1815
1816This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1817operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1818to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1819configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1820defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1821do this.
1822
1823
1824
1825.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1826.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1827.cindex "RFC 2047"
1828The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1829described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1830in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1831character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1832mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1833(default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1834supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1835
1836However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1837very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1838&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1839systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1840&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1841.code
1842HAVE_ICONV=yes
1843.endd
1844to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1845
1846
1847
1848.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1849.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1850.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1851.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1852.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1853.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1854Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1855command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1856start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1857&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1858line option).
1859
1860If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1861OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1862implementing SSL.
1863
1864If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1865.code
1866SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1867TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1868.endd
1869in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1870OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1871.code
1872SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1873TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1874TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1875.endd
1876.new
1877.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1878If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1879.code
1880SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1881USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1882.endd
1883.wen
1884.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1885If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1886.code
1887SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1888USE_GNUTLS=yes
1889TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1890.endd
1891in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1892library and include files. For example:
1893.code
1894SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1895USE_GNUTLS=yes
1896TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1897TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1898.endd
1899.new
1900.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1901If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1902.code
1903SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1904USE_GNUTLS=yes
1905USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1906.endd
1907.wen
1908
1909You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1910specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1911given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1912
1913
1914
1915
1916.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1917
1918.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1919.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1920.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1921.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1922Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1923SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1924alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1925already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1926should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1927&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1928&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1929EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1930you might have
1931.code
1932USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1933CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1934EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1935.endd
1936in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1937files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1938.code
1939exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1940.endd
1941in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1942the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1943All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1944can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1945in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1946configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1947further details.
1948
1949
1950.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1951.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1952Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1953&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1954it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1955where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1956library files.
1957
1958Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1959defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1960currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1961as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1962over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1963if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1964this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1965support has not been tested for some time.
1966
1967
1968
1969.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1970.cindex "lookup modules"
1971.cindex "dynamic modules"
1972.cindex ".so building"
1973On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1974the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1975on demand.
1976This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1977library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1978dependencies.
1979Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1980
1981Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1982installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1983measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
1984for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
1985Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
1986see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
1987
1988Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
1989&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
1990For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
1991on demand:
1992.code
1993LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
1994LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
1995LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
1996.endd
1997
1998
1999.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2000.cindex "build directory"
2001Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2002created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2003operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2004For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2005&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2006.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2007Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2008
2009&*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2010building process fails if it is set.
2011
2012If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2013a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2014&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2015&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2016then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2017number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2018makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2019directory, should this ever be necessary.
2020
2021If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2022&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2023FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2024
2025
2026
2027.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2028The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2029unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2030output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2031appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2032each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2033get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2034.code
2035FULLECHO='' make -e
2036.endd
2037The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2038command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2039given in addition to the short output.
2040
2041
2042
2043.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2044.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2045The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2046consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2047values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2048more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2049convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2050order:
2051.display
2052&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2053&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2054&_Local/Makefile_&
2055&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2056&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2057&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2058&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2059.endd
2060.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2061.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2062.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2063where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2064architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2065process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2066and are often not needed.
2067
2068The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2069called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2070the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2071values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2072Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2073fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2074of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2075that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2076to find out what values are being used on your system.
2077
2078
2079&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2080therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2081needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2082file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2083default values are.
2084
2085
2086.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2087If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2089need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2090putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2091.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2092when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2093formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2094compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2095called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2096Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2097default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2098containing the lines
2099.code
2100CC=cc
2101CFLAGS=-std1
2102.endd
2103If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2104these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2105
2106Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2107files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2108the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2109
2110
2111.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2112.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2113.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2114.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2115Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2116lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2117not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2118and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2119which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2120case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2121.code
2122LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2123LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2124LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2125.endd
2126and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2127&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2128libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2129.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2130However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2131the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2132files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2133binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2134errors.
2135
2136.new
2137.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2138.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2139Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2140about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2141being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2142makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2143variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2144name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2145&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2146with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2147syntax. For instance:
2148.code
2149LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2150LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2151AUTH_GSASL=yes
2152AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2153AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2154AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2155.endd
2156.wen
2157
2158.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2159Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2160subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2161.code
2162EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2163.endd
2164must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2165chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2166
2167.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2168The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2169operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2170with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2171monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2172The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2173.code
2174X11=/usr/X11R6
2175XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2176XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2177.endd
2178These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2179example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2180.code
2181X11=/usr/openwin
2182XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2183XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2184.endd
2185If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2186definition of all three of these variables into your
2187&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2188
2189.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2190If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2191variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2192default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2193command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2194
2195.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2196There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2197use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2198EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2199binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2200libraries.
2201
2202.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2203The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2204files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2205necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2206&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2207
2208
2209.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2210.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2211.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2212The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2213&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2214normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2215recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2216are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2217
2218
2219
2220.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2221.cindex "building Eximon"
2222A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2223where the files that are involved are
2224.display
2225&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2226&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2227&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2228&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2229&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2230&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2231.endd
2232.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2233As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2234&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2235&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2236variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2237EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2238LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2239.ecindex IIDbuex
2240
2241
2242.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2243.cindex "installing Exim"
2244.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2245The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2246arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2247whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2248.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2249The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2250going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2251&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2252install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2253some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2254it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2255chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2256
2257.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2258Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2259in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2260exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2261by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2262is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2263alternative files, no default is installed.
2264
2265.cindex "system aliases file"
2266.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2267One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2268default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2269The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2270SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2271If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2272and outputs a comment to the user.
2273
2274The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2275aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2276kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2277&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2278Exim's configuration if necessary.
2279
2280The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2281and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2282running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2283directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2284other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2285over SMTP.
2286
2287It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2288distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2289command such as
2290.code
2291make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2292.endd
2293This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2294paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2295configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2296For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2297but this usage is deprecated.
2298
2299.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2300Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2301&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2302upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2303directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2304INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2305
2306For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2307to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2308installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2309for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2310called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2311of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2312from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2313
2314.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2315If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2316real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2317command:
2318.code
2319make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2320.endd
2321The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2322script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2323the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2324directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2325command:
2326.code
2327(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2328.endd
2329.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2330There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2331
2332.ilist
2333&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2334to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2335.next
2336&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2337installed binary.
2338.endlist
2339
2340INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2341.code
2342make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2343.endd
2344The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2345to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2346without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2347.code
2348make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2349.endd
2350
2351
2352
2353.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2354.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2355Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2356reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2357distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2358&<<SECTavail>>&).
2359
2360If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2361source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2362install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2363
2364
2365
2366.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2367.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2368When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2369exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2370directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2371necessary.
2372
2373
2374
2375
2376.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2377.cindex "testing" "installation"
2378Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2379syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2380Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2381.code
2382exim -bV
2383.endd
2384If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2385Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2386the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2387other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2388Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2389example,
2390.display
2391&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2392.endd
2393should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2394.display
2395&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2396.endd
2397a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2398This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2399user agent. For example:
2400.code
2401exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2402From: user@your.domain.example
2403To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2404Subject: Testing Exim
2405
2406This is a test message.
2407^D
2408.endd
2409The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2410In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2411arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2412
2413.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2414If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2415&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2416of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2417&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2418with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2419.display
2420&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2421.endd
2422You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2423produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2424For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2425relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2426&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2427
2428.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2429.cindex "lock files"
2430One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2431local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2432&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2433writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2434is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2435directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2436that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2437&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2438approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2439&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2440agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2441see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2442
2443One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2444the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2445&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2446port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2447&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2448incoming SMTP mail.
2449
2450Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2451be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2452within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2453that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2454production version.
2455
2456
2457.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2458.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2459Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2460general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2461is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2462operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2463binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2464normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2465or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2466.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2467a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2468privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2469and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2470
2471.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2472.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2473Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2474example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2475&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2476described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2477as follows:
2478.code
2479sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2480send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2481mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2482newaliases /usr/bin/true
2483.endd
2484Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2485your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2486favourite user agent.
2487
2488You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2489have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2490various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2491command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2492use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2493&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2494
2495
2496
2497.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2498.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2499If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2500version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2501call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2502to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2503new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2504version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2505configuration file.
2506
2507
2508
2509
2510.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2511.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2512The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2513.code
2514/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2515.endd
2516If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2517fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2518for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2519(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2520solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2521.code
2522pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2523.endd
2524to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2525
2526Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2527still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2528(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2534. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2535
2536.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2537.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2538.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2539Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2540each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2541options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2542some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2543combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2544The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2545
2546
2547.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2548.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2549If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2550were present before any other options.
2551The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2552standard output.
2553This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2554that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2555&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2556
2557.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2558If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2559were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2560&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2561format.
2562
2563.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2564If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2565&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2566Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2567
2568.cindex "&'runq'&"
2569.cindex "queue runner"
2570If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2571were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2572option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2573
2574.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2575.cindex "alias file" "building"
2576.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2577If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2578&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2579This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2580the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2581command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2582
2583
2584.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2585Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2586available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2587user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2588EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2589&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2590
2591.ilist
2592.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2593.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2594The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2595&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2596supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2597configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2598
2599.cindex '&"From"& line'
2600.cindex "envelope sender"
2601Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2602&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2603Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2604See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2605users to set envelope senders.
2606
2607.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2608.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2609For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2610header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2611&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2612
2613Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2614protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2615locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2616have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2617users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2618that are available to trusted users.
2619.next
2620.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2621.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2622The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2623Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2624The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2625
2626Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2627operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2628necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2629the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2630
2631By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2632Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2633However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2634option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2635
2636Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2637is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2638false.
2639.endlist
2640
2641
2642&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2643edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2644getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2645&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2646
2647
2648
2649
2650.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2651Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2652of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2653a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2654format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2655on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2656with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2657outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2658
2659. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2660. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2661. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2662. creates a man page for the options.
2663. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2664
2665.literal xml
2666<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2667.literal off
2668
2669
2670.vlist
2671.vitem &%--%&
2672.oindex "--"
2673.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2674This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2675therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2676rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2677
2678.vitem &%--help%&
2679.oindex "&%--help%&"
2680This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2681The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2682no arguments.
2683
2684.vitem &%--version%&
2685.oindex "&%--version%&"
2686This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2687displayed.
2688
2689.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2690.oindex "&%-B%&"
2691.cindex "8-bit characters"
2692.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2693This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2694clean; it ignores this option.
2695
2696.vitem &%-bd%&
2697.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2698.cindex "daemon"
2699.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2700.cindex "queue runner"
2701This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2702the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2703that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2704
2705The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2706(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2707disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2708stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2709
2710By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2711all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2712ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2713&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2714
2715When a listening daemon
2716.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2717.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2718is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2719configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2720in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2721PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2722running as root.
2723
2724When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2725process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2726used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2727
2728The SIGHUP signal
2729.cindex "SIGHUP"
2730.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2731can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2732whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2733means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2734of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2735referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2736because these are reread each time they are used.
2737
2738.vitem &%-bdf%&
2739.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2740This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2741from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2742
2743.vitem &%-be%&
2744.oindex "&%-be%&"
2745.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2746.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2747Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2748prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2749files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2750of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2751
2752If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2753to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2754used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2755function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2756test data. A line history is supported.
2757
2758Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2759continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2760continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2761string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2762configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2763message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2764is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2765
2766&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2767files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2768the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2769of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2770
2771.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2772.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2773.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2776of a file. For example:
2777.code
2778exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2779.endd
2780The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2781message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2782variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2783no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2784recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2785&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2786line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2787&%-be%&).
2788
2789.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2790.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2791.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2792.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2793This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2794tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2795system filters are recognized.
2796
2797.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2798.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2799.cindex "filter" "testing"
2800.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2801.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2802.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2803.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2804This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2805to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2806there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2807supplied.
2808
2809If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2810can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2811filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2812.code
2813exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2814.endd
2815This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2816variables that are used by the user filter.
2817
2818If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2819.code
2820# Exim filter
2821# Sieve filter
2822.endd
2823it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2824that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2825&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2826redirection lists.
2827
2828The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2829detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2830with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2831separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2832
2833When testing a filter file,
2834.cindex "&""From""& line"
2835.cindex "envelope sender"
2836.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2837the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2838or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2839that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2840can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2841options).
2842
2843.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2844.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2845.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2846This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2847tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2848&$qualify_domain$&.
2849
2850.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2851.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2852This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2853tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2854process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2855suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2856actually being delivered.
2857
2858.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2859.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2860This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2861file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2862prefix.
2863
2864.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2865.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2866This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2867file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2868suffix.
2869
2870.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2871.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2872.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2873.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2874.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2875.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2876.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2877.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2878This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2879standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2880after a full stop. For example:
2881.code
2882exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2883exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2884.endd
2885When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2886of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2887conversion to the canonical form is
2888&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2889
2890Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2891include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2892This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2893messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2894test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2895
2896&*Warning 1*&:
2897.cindex "RFC 1413"
2898You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2899information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2900an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2901connection.
2902
2903&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2904are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2905occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2906
2907Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2908written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2909lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2910can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2911and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2912session were authenticated.
2913
2914The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2915output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2916acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2917
2918Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2919plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2920specialized SMTP test program such as
2921&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2922
2923.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2924.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2925This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2926verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2927updating the callout cache database.
2928
2929.vitem &%-bi%&
2930.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2931.cindex "alias file" "building"
2932.cindex "building alias file"
2933.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2934Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2935Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2936this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2937tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2938recognized.
2939
2940If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2941configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2942the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2943The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2944use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2945if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2946&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2947
2948.vitem &%-bm%&
2949.oindex "&%-bm%&"
2950.cindex "local message reception"
2951This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2952locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2953command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2954argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2955default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2956if no other conflicting option is present.
2957
2958If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2959qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2960options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2961suppressing this for special cases.
2962
2963Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2964the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2965
2966.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2967The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2968action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2969
2970The format
2971.cindex "message" "format"
2972.cindex "format" "message"
2973.cindex "&""From""& line"
2974.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2975.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2976of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2977compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2978.code
2979From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2980From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2981.endd
2982(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2983is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2984authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2985matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2986option, which can be changed if necessary.
2987
2988.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2989The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2990&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2991preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2992trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2993
2994.vitem &%-bnq%&
2995.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
2996.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2997By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2998without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2999is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3000envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3001&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3002defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3003
3004Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3005being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3006content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3007header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3008syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3009
3010The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3011messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3012addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3013unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3014
3015
3016.vitem &%-bP%&
3017.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3018.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3019.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3020If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3021main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3022of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3023arguments, for example:
3024.code
3025exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3026.endd
3027.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3028.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3029.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3030However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3031configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3032users, the output is as in this example:
3033.code
3034mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3035.endd
3036If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3037configuration file is output.
3038If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3039is the name of the file that was actually used.
3040
3041.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3042.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3043If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3044directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3045respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3046sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3047written directly into the spool directory.
3048
3049If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3050.code
3051exim -bP +local_domains
3052.endd
3053it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3054local part) and outputs what it finds.
3055
3056.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3057.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3058.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3059If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3060followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3061that driver are output. For example:
3062.code
3063exim -bP transport local_delivery
3064.endd
3065The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3066options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3067using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3068&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3069settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3070&%authenticators%&.
3071
3072.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3073If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3074are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3075for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3076The output format is one item per line.
3077
3078.vitem &%-bp%&
3079.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3080.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3081.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3082This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3083standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3084just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3085admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3086to allow any user to see the queue.
3087
3088Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3089.code
309025m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3091 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3092 <other addresses>
3093.endd
3094.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3095.cindex "size" "of message"
3096The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3097(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3098identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3099envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3100&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3101the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3102before the sender address.
3103
3104.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3105If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3106&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3107
3108The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3109displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3110been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3111expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3112displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3113complete.
3114
3115
3116.vitem &%-bpa%&
3117.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3118This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3119that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3120alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3121of just &"D"&.
3122
3123
3124.vitem &%-bpc%&
3125.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3126.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3127This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3128to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3129&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3130
3131
3132.vitem &%-bpr%&
3133.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3134This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3135chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3136lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3137going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3138
3139.vitem &%-bpra%&
3140.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3141This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3142
3143.vitem &%-bpru%&
3144.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3145This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3146
3147
3148.vitem &%-bpu%&
3149.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3150This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3151addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3152forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3153router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3154
3155
3156.vitem &%-brt%&
3157.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3158.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3159.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3160This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3161arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3162and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3163.code
3164exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3165Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3166.endd
3167See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3168argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3169&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3170contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3171retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3172with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3173rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3174sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3175used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3176.code
3177exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3178Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3179.endd
3180
3181.vitem &%-brw%&
3182.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3183.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3184.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3185This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3186a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3187complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3188would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3189&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3190
3191.vitem &%-bS%&
3192.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3193.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3194.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3195This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3196for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3197submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3198input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3199input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3200&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3201believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3202
3203The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3204dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3205provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3206
3207As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3208messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3209Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3210&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3211
3212Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3213as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3214QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3215
3216.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3217If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3218error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3219was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3220was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3221
3222More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3223&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3224
3225.vitem &%-bs%&
3226.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3227.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3228.cindex "local SMTP input"
3229This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3230on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3231policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3232Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3233messages to the MTA.
3234
3235In
3236.cindex "sender" "source of"
3237this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3238set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3239Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3240the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3241&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3242&%-bnq%& option is used.
3243
3244.cindex "inetd"
3245The
3246&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3247using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3248whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3249&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3250above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3251Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3252the listening daemon.
3253
3254.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3255.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3256.cindex "testing", "malware"
3257.cindex "malware scan test"
3258This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3259using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3260this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3261the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3262not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3263will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3264
3265Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3266using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3267user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3268This option requires admin privileges.
3269
3270The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3271there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3272administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3273
3274.vitem &%-bt%&
3275.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3276.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3277.cindex "address" "testing"
3278This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3279as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3280written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3281user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3282sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3283
3284If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3285right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3286
3287Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3288&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3289security issues.
3290
3291Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3292(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3293written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3294&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3295genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3296program.
3297
3298.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3299The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3300failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3301code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3302
3303.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3304&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3305addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3306This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3307always shown.
3308
3309&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3310routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3311message,
3312.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3313you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3314&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3315default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3316whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3317those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3318doing such tests.
3319
3320.vitem &%-bV%&
3321.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3322.cindex "version number of Exim"
3323This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3324number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3325It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3326specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3327name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3328
3329As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3330configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3331values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3332detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3333alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3334realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3335dynamic testing facilities.
3336
3337.vitem &%-bv%&
3338.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3339.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3340.cindex "address" "verification"
3341This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3342taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3343not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3344happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3345(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3346including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3347
3348If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3349failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3350usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3351
3352If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3353right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3354
3355Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3356&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3357security issues.
3358
3359Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3360that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3361router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3362verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3363address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3364
3365If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3366address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3367latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3368causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3369addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3370and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3371to succeed.
3372
3373When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3374and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3375considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3376
3377The
3378.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3379return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3380failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3381code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3382
3383If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3384address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3385sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3386calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3387
3388.vitem &%-bvs%&
3389.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3390This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3391than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3392might happen.
3393
3394.vitem &%-bw%&
3395.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3396.cindex "daemon"
3397.cindex "inetd"
3398.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3399This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3400similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3401and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3402
3403In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3404listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3405inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3406each port only when the first connection is received.
3407
3408If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3409which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3410
3411.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3412.oindex "&%-C%&"
3413.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3414.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3415.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3416This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3417list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3418compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3419name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3420file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3421proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3422
3423When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3424from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3425runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3426However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3427file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3428which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3429listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3430CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3431not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3432
3433Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3434configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3435even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3436running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3437delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3438test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3439on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3440
3441If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3442prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3443must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3444However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3445CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3446usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3447unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3448
3449ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3450to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3451broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3452configuration file.
3453
3454The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3455syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3456caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3457require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3458specified by this option.
3459
3460
3461.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3462.oindex "&%-D%&"
3463.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3464This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3465(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3466unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3467If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3468completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3469
3470If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3471colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3472supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3473not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3474the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3475to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3476regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3477
3478The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3479command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3480string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3481synonymous:
3482.code
3483exim -DABC ...
3484exim -DABC= ...
3485.endd
3486To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3487quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3488example:
3489.code
3490exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3491.endd
3492&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3493
3494
3495.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3496.oindex "&%-d%&"
3497.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3498.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3499This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3500error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3501database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3502filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3503writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3504return code.
3505
3506When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3507standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3508some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3509made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3510of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3511debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3512no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3513are:
3514.display
3515&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3516&`auth `& authenticators
3517&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3518&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3519&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3520&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3521&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3522&`filter `& filter handling
3523&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3524&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3525&`ident `& ident lookup
3526&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3527&`lists `& matching things in lists
3528&`load `& system load checks
3529&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3530 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3531&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3532&`memory `& memory handling
3533&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3534&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3535&`queue_run `& queue runs
3536&`receive `& general message reception logic
3537&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3538&`retry `& retry handling
3539&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3540&`route `& address routing
3541&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3542&`tls `& TLS logic
3543&`transport `& transports
3544&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3545&`verify `& address verification logic
3546&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3547.endd
3548The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3549for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3550tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3551is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3552generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3553turn everything off.
3554
3555.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3556.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3557The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3558with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3559unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3560rather than stderr.
3561
3562The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3563&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3564However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3565daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3566automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3567run in parallel.
3568
3569The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3570of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3571in processing.
3572
3573If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3574any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3575
3576.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3577.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3578This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3579starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3580subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3581behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3582
3583.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3584.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3585This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3586handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3587described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3588
3589.vitem &%-E%&
3590.oindex "&%-E%&"
3591.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3592This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3593failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3594and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3595generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3596could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3597follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3598new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3599
3600.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3601.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3602There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3603called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3604example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3605form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3606
3607.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3608.oindex "&%-F%&"
3609.cindex "sender" "name"
3610.cindex "name" "of sender"
3611This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3612message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3613entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3614their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3615between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3616
3617.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3618.oindex "&%-f%&"
3619.cindex "sender" "address"
3620.cindex "address" "sender"
3621.cindex "trusted users"
3622.cindex "envelope sender"
3623.cindex "user" "trusted"
3624This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3625message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3626by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3627users to use it.
3628
3629Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3630trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3631options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3632of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3633domain.
3634
3635There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3636can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3637never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3638string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3639examples of shell commands:
3640.code
3641exim -f '<>' user@domain
3642exim -f "" user@domain
3643.endd
3644In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3645with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3646&%-bv%& options.
3647
3648Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3649it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3650refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3651though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3652
3653White
3654.cindex "&""From""& line"
3655space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3656given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3657locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3658&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3659if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3660
3661.vitem &%-G%&
3662.oindex "&%-G%&"
3663.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3664This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3665
3666.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3667.oindex "&%-h%&"
3668.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3669This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3670Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3671headers.)
3672
3673.vitem &%-i%&
3674.oindex "&%-i%&"
3675.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3676.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3677This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3678line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3679no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3680command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3681
3682.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3683.oindex "&%-M%&"
3684.cindex "forcing delivery"
3685.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3686.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3687This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3688any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3689delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3690and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3691
3692Retry
3693.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3694hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3695the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3696to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3697which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3698for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3699
3700The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3701not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3702produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3703use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3704
3705.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3706.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3707.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3708.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3709This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3710message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3711id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3712active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3713can be used only by an admin user.
3714
3715.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3716 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3717.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3718.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3719.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3720.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3721This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3722by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3723an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3724given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3725must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3726
3727.vitem &%-MCA%&
3728.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3729This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3730by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3731connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3732
3733.vitem &%-MCP%&
3734.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3735This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3736by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3737which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3738
3739.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3740.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3741This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3742by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3743started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3744together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3745signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3746messages through the same SMTP connection.
3747
3748.vitem &%-MCS%&
3749.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3750This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3751by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3752SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3753connection.
3754
3755.vitem &%-MCT%&
3756.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3757This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3758by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3759host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3760
3761.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3762.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3763.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3764.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3765This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3766but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3767that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3768provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3769order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3770However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3771respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3772overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3773If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3774&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3775and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3776
3777.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3778.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3779.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3780.cindex "sender" "changing"
3781This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3782given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3783&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3784be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3785is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3786This option can be used only by an admin user.
3787
3788.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3789.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3790.cindex "freezing messages"
3791.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3792This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3793prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3794either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3795However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3796attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3797user.
3798
3799.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3800.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3801.cindex "giving up on messages"
3802.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3803.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3804This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3805including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3806their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3807is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3808Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3809user.
3810
3811.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3812.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3813.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3814This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3815as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3816message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3817altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3818
3819.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3820.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3821.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3822.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3823.cindex "removing recipients"
3824This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3825(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3826the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3827addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3828(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3829can be used only by an admin user.
3830
3831.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3832.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3833.cindex "removing messages"
3834.cindex "abandoning mail"
3835.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3836This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3837bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3838the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3839only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3840placed on the queue.
3841
3842.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3843.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3844.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3845.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3846This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3847string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3848the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3849&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3850available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3851make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3852user. See also &%-bem%&.
3853
3854.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3855.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3856.cindex "thawing messages"
3857.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3858.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3859.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3860This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3861&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3862messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3863by an admin user.
3864
3865.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3866.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3867.cindex "listing" "message body"
3868.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3869This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3870written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3871
3872.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3873.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3874.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3875.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3876This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3877be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3878only by an admin user.
3879
3880.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3881.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3882.cindex "listing" "message headers"
3883.cindex "header lines" "listing"
3884.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3885This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3886written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3887
3888.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3889.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3890.cindex "listing" "message log"
3891.cindex "message" "listing message log"
3892This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3893the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3894
3895.vitem &%-m%&
3896.oindex "&%-m%&"
3897This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3898treats it that way too.
3899
3900.vitem &%-N%&
3901.oindex "&%-N%&"
3902.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3903.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3904This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3905level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3906it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3907had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3908database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3909than &"=>"&.
3910
3911Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3912user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3913words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3914which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3915address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3916routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3917the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3918for that message.
3919
3920.vitem &%-n%&
3921.oindex "&%-n%&"
3922.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3923This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3924by Exim.
3925
3926.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3927.oindex "&%-O%&"
3928This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3929Exim.
3930
3931.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3932.oindex "&%-oA%&"
3933.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3934This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3935alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3936description above.
3937
3938.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3939.oindex "&%-oB%&"
3940.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3941.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3942.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3943This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3944be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3945transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3946
3947.vitem &%-odb%&
3948.oindex "&%-odb%&"
3949.cindex "background delivery"
3950.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3951This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3952including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3953messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3954delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3955processes to finish.
3956
3957When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3958leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3959and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3960This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3961
3962If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3963(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3964overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3965setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3966
3967.vitem &%-odf%&
3968.oindex "&%-odf%&"
3969.cindex "foreground delivery"
3970.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3971This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3972accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3973&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3974and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3975
3976The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3977process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3978during deliveries.
3979
3980However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3981false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3982
3983If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3984message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3985process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3986restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3987
3988
3989.vitem &%-odi%&
3990.oindex "&%-odi%&"
3991This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3992Sendmail.
3993
3994.vitem &%-odq%&
3995.oindex "&%-odq%&"
3996.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3997.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3998.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3999This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4000including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4001not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4002are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4003process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4004&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4005conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4006forces queueing.
4007
4008.vitem &%-odqs%&
4009.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4010.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4011This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4012However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4013&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4014configuration file is in effect.
4015
4016When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4017message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4018also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4019in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4020done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4021runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4022messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4023host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4024configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4025&%-qq%& option.
4026
4027.vitem &%-oee%&
4028.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4029.cindex "error" "reporting"
4030If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4031example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4032message.
4033
4034.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4035Provided
4036this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4037exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4038is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
4039the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4040
4041.vitem &%-oem%&
4042.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4043.cindex "error" "reporting"
4044.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4045This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4046return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4047This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4048
4049.vitem &%-oep%&
4050.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4051.cindex "error" "reporting"
4052If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4053error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4054.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4055The return code is 1 for all errors.
4056
4057.vitem &%-oeq%&
4058.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4059.cindex "error" "reporting"
4060This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4061effect as &%-oep%&.
4062
4063.vitem &%-oew%&
4064.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4065.cindex "error" "reporting"
4066This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4067effect as &%-oem%&.
4068
4069.vitem &%-oi%&
4070.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4071.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4072This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4073line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4074single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4075lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4076&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4077
4078.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4079.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4080This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4081
4082.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4083.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4084.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4085A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4086with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4087over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4088&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4089other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4090
4091The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4092number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4093.code
4094exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4095.endd
4096An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4097followed by a colon and the port number:
4098.code
4099exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4100.endd
4101The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4102port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4103are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4104whichever one is last.
4105
4106.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4107.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4108.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4109See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4110option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4111name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4112This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4113authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4114
4115.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4116.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4117.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4118See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4119option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4120This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4121where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4122&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4123
4124.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4125.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4126.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4127See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4128option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4129overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4130messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4131default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4132specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4133&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4134
4135.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4136.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4137.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4138See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4139option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4140using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4141&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4142
4143.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4144.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4145.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4146.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4147See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4148option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4149&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4150or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4151SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4152&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4153one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4154be set by &%-oMr%&.
4155
4156.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4157.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4158.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4159See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4160option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4161present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4162uses the name it is given.
4163
4164.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4165.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4166.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4167See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4168option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4169local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4170used, when there is no default.
4171
4172.vitem &%-om%&
4173.oindex "&%-om%&"
4174.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4175In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4176message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4177expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4178
4179.vitem &%-oo%&
4180.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4181.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4182This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4183whatever that means.
4184
4185.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4186.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4187.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4188.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4189This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4190value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4191written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4192without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4193because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4194
4195.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4196.oindex "&%-or%&"
4197.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4198This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4199set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4200by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4201described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4202
4203.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4204.oindex "&%-os%&"
4205.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4206.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4207This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4208applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4209the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4210for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4211
4212.vitem &%-ov%&
4213.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4214This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4215
4216.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4217.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4218.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4219.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4220.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4221This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4222is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4223of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4224in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4225file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4226
4227.vitem &%-pd%&
4228.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4229.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4230This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4231chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4232option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4233needed.
4234
4235.vitem &%-ps%&
4236.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4237.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4238This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4239chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4240option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4241started.
4242
4243.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4244.oindex "&%-p%&"
4245For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4246.display
4247&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4248.endd
4249It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4250host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4251Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4252to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4253or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4254
4255.vitem &%-q%&
4256.oindex "&%-q%&"
4257.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4258This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4259configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4260relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4261and &%-S%& options).
4262
4263.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4264The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4265waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4266for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4267process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4268have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4269
4270If
4271.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4272.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4273.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4274the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4275passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4276proceeding.
4277
4278When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4279process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4280mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4281this to be repeated periodically.
4282
4283Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4284random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4285If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4286MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4287
4288It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4289order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4290&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4291
4292.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4293The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4294behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4295appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4296
4297.vitem &%-qq...%&
4298.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4299.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4300.cindex "queue" "routing"
4301.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4302An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4303stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4304every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4305transports are run.
4306
4307.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4308The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4309is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4310complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4311place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4312delivered down a single SMTP
4313.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4314.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4315.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4316connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4317This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4318intermittently.
4319
4320.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4321.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4322.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4323If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4324those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4325delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4326&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4327
4328.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4329.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4330.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4331.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4332If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4333message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4334their retry times are tried.
4335
4336.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4337.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4338.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4339If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4340frozen or not.
4341
4342.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4343.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4344.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4345The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4346be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4347for later delivery.
4348
4349.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4350.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4351When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4352lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4353starting message id. For example:
4354.code
4355exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4356.endd
4357Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4358second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4359are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4360.code
4361exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4362.endd
4363just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4364&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4365that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4366mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4367are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4368queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4369
4370.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4371.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4372.cindex "periodic queue running"
4373When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4374starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4375(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4376&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4377single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4378combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4379.code
4380/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4381.endd
4382Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4383process every 30 minutes.
4384
4385When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4386pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4387
4388.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4389.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4390This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4391compatibility.
4392
4393.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4394.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4395This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4396
4397.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4398.oindex "&%-R%&"
4399.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4400.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4401.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4402The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4403is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4404which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4405<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4406
4407This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4408perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4409queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4410address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4411way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4412regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4413
4414If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4415you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4416.code
4417exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4418.endd
4419This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4420every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4421applied to each queue run.
4422
4423Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4424are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4425information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4426means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4427existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4428address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4429will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4430information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4431address will be skipped.
4432
4433.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4434If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4435all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4436&'ff'& is present.
4437
4438The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4439to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4440command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4441effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4442an arbitrary command instead.
4443
4444.vitem &%-r%&
4445.oindex "&%-r%&"
4446This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4447
4448.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4449.oindex "&%-S%&"
4450.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4451.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4452This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4453message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4454conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4455has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4456
4457.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4458.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4459This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4460recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4461&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4462
4463.vitem &%-t%&
4464.oindex "&%-t%&"
4465.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4466.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4467.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4468.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4469When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4470input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4471from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4472from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4473takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4474
4475.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4476If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4477is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4478the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4479and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4480Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4481Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4482argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4483Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4484instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4485&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4486
4487.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4488If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4489recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4490lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4491with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4492&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4493
4494RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4495message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4496added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4497not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4498nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4499In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4500are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4501once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4502&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4503
4504.vitem &%-ti%&
4505.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4506This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4507compatibility with Sendmail.
4508
4509.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4510.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4511.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4512.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4513This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4514incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4515&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4516&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4517
4518
4519.vitem &%-U%&
4520.oindex "&%-U%&"
4521.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4522Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4523documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4524syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4525set. Exim ignores this option.
4526
4527.vitem &%-v%&
4528.oindex "&%-v%&"
4529This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4530describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4531receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4532dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4533the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4534selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4535unconditional.
4536
4537.vitem &%-x%&
4538.oindex "&%-x%&"
4539AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4540National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4541It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4542this option.
4543.endlist
4544
4545.ecindex IIDclo1
4546.ecindex IIDclo2
4547
4548
4549. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4550. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4551. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4552. creates a man page for the options.
4553. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4554
4555.literal xml
4556<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4557.literal off
4558
4559
4560
4561
4562
4563. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4564. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4565
4566
4567.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4568 "The runtime configuration file"
4569
4570.cindex "run time configuration"
4571.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4572.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4573.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4574.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4575.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4576Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4577binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4578because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4579control.
4580
4581If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4582writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4583The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4584errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4585not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4586actually alter the string.
4587
4588The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4589reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4590most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4591give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4592existing file in the list.
4593
4594.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4595.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4596.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4597.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4598.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4599.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4600The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4601specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4602configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4603group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4604CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4605
4606&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4607to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4608easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4609CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4610who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4611
4612Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4613be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4614since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4615compromise the Exim user account.
4616
4617A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4618is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4619defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4620configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4621CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4622&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4623configuration.
4624
4625
4626
4627.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4628.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4629A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4630option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4631&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4632unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4633CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4634is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4635is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4636installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4637specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4638
4639Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4640with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4641listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4642testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4643delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4644Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4645the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4646can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4647message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4648&%-M%&).
4649
4650If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4651prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4652start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4653There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4654name can be used with &%-C%&.
4655
4656One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4657option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4658configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4659non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4660If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4661completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4662
4663The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4664to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4665necessarily be discarded.
4666WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4667considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4668values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4669is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4670transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4671values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4672
4673Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4674share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4675If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4676looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4677and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4678file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4679each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4680
4681In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4682different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4683help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4684
4685
4686
4687.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4688.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4689.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4690Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4691option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4692are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4693is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4694optional parts are:
4695
4696.ilist
4697&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4698&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4699.next
4700.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4701&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4702are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4703.next
4704&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4705addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4706&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4707.next
4708&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4709define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4710&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4711.next
4712&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4713If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4714defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4715are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4716&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4717.next
4718&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4719when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4720chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4721.next
4722&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4723want to use this feature, you must set
4724.code
4725LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4726.endd
4727in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4728facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4729.endlist
4730
4731.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4732.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4733.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4734Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4735
4736Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4737leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4738# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4739and does not introduce a comment.
4740
4741Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4742the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4743backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4744lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4745appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4746
4747A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4748default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4749change settings as required.
4750
4751The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4752described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4753respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4754items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4755onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4756described.
4757
4758
4759
4760.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4761.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4762.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4763.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4764.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4765You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4766using this syntax:
4767.display
4768&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4769&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4770.endd
4771on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4772the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4773second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4774name is required.
4775
4776Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4777configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4778If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4779because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4780
4781The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4782comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4783for example:
4784.code
4785hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4786 .include /some/file
4787.endd
4788Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4789process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4790inclusion appears.
4791
4792
4793
4794.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4795.cindex "macro" "description of"
4796.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4797If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4798&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4799definition, and must be of the form
4800.display
4801<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4802.endd
4803The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4804in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4805continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4806space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4807a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4808
4809Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4810definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4811ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4812
4813.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4814Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4815files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4816scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4817replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4818for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4819the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4820define
4821.display
4822&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4823&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4824.endd
4825but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4826error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4827before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4828consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4829line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4830comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4831
4832
4833.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4834Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4835(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4836&'='&. For example:
4837.code
4838MAC = initial value
4839...
4840MAC == updated value
4841.endd
4842Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4843subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4844the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4845Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4846.code
4847MAC = initial value
4848...
4849MAC == MAC and something added
4850.endd
4851This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4852from a number of other files.
4853
4854.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4855The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4856&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4857used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4858using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4859file to be ignored.
4860
4861
4862
4863.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4864As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4865up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4866strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4867.code
4868ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4869 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4870.endd
4871This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4872.code
4873data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4874.endd
4875In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4876address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4877section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4878
4879
4880.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4881.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4882.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4883You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4884&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4885portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4886read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4887
4888The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4889be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4890that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4891line. Thus:
4892.code
4893.ifdef AAA
4894message_size_limit = 50M
4895.else
4896message_size_limit = 100M
4897.endif
4898.endd
4899sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4900otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4901is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4902obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4903
4904Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4905it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4906in this line"& will always be true.
4907
4908Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4909to clarify complicated nestings.
4910
4911
4912
4913.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4914.cindex "common option syntax"
4915.cindex "syntax of common options"
4916.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4917For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4918each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4919lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4920these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4921space) and then the value. For example:
4922.code
4923qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4924.endd
4925.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4926.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4927.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4928Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4929accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4930line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4931word &"hide"&. For example:
4932.code
4933hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4934.endd
4935For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4936.code
4937mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4938.endd
4939If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4940all instances of the same driver.
4941
4942The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4943that are found in option settings.
4944
4945
4946.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4947.cindex "format" "boolean"
4948.cindex "boolean configuration values"
4949.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4950.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4951Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4952different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4953the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4954if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4955boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4956&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4957the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4958.code
4959queue_only
4960queue_only = true
4961.endd
4962The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4963.code
4964no_queue_only
4965queue_only = false
4966.endd
4967You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4968
4969
4970
4971
4972.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4973.cindex "integer configuration values"
4974.cindex "format" "integer"
4975If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4976hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4977number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4978with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4979hexadecimal number.
4980
4981If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4982it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4983of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
49841024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4985and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4986used.
4987
4988
4989.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4990.cindex "integer format"
4991.cindex "format" "octal integer"
4992If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4993interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4994Such options are always output in octal.
4995
4996
4997.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4998.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4999.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5000If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5001integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5002
5003
5004
5005.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5006.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5007.cindex "format" "time interval"
5008A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5009the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5010
5011.table2 30pt
5012.irow &%s%& seconds
5013.irow &%m%& minutes
5014.irow &%h%& hours
5015.irow &%d%& days
5016.irow &%w%& weeks
5017.endtable
5018
5019For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5020intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5021is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5022
5023
5024
5025.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5026.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5027.cindex "format" "string"
5028If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5029or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5030consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5031the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5032removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5033Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5034appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5035therefore equivalent:
5036.code
5037trusted_users = uucp:mail
5038trusted_users = uucp:\
5039 # This comment line is ignored
5040 mail
5041.endd
5042.cindex "string" "quoted"
5043.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5044If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5045double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5046continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5047
5048.table2 100pt
5049.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5050.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5051.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5052.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5053.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5054.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5055 character"
5056.endtable
5057
5058If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5059character, that character replaces the pair.
5060
5061Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5062insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5063trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5064current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5065in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5066and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5067
5068
5069.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5070.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5071Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5072by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5073circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5074is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5075strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5076However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5077backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5078within a quoted configuration string.
5079
5080
5081.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5082.cindex "user name" "format of"
5083.cindex "format" "user name"
5084.cindex "groups" "name format"
5085.cindex "format" "group name"
5086User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5087above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5088either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5089&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5090
5091
5092.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5093.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5094.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5095.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5096The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5097default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5098the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5099&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5100are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5101particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5102&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5103
5104In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5105input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5106&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5107in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5108on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5109start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5110example, the list
5111.code
5112local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5113.endd
5114contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5115
5116&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5117list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5118colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5119be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5120
5121.section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5122.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5123.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5124Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5125introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5126with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5127character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5128above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5129.code
5130local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5131.endd
5132This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5133&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5134confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5135
5136.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5137.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5138It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5139code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5140must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5141are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5142sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5143interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5144generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5145.code
5146domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5147.endd
5148This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5149to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5150expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5151the value in quotes. For example:
5152.code
5153local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5154.endd
5155Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5156doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5157set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5158enclosing an empty list item.
5159
5160
5161
5162.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5163.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5164An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5165separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5166.code
5167senders = user@domain :
5168.endd
5169contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5170in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5171items, the second of which is empty:
5172.code
5173senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5174.endd
5175&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5176are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5177would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5178just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5179.code
5180senders = :
5181.endd
5182In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5183is at the end of the list.
5184
5185
5186
5187
5188.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5189.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5190There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5191and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5192instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5193a sequence of lines like this:
5194.display
5195<&'instance name'&>:
5196 <&'option'&>
5197 ...
5198 <&'option'&>
5199.endd
5200In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5201followed by three options settings:
5202.code
5203localuser:
5204 driver = accept
5205 check_local_user
5206 transport = local_delivery
5207.endd
5208For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5209setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5210settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5211deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5212a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5213described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5214
5215You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5216the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5217
5218The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5219passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5220transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5221authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5222them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5223server.
5224
5225.cindex "generic options"
5226.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5227Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5228and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5229same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5230&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5231.cindex "private options"
5232The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5233they all have default values.
5234
5235The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5236precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5237this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5238
5239Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5240elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5241with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5242a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5243instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5244confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5245configuration lines:
5246.code
5247remote_smtp:
5248 driver = smtp
5249.endd
5250create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5251&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5252different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5253instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5254thus:
5255.code
5256special_smtp:
5257 driver = smtp
5258 port = 1234
5259 command_timeout = 10s
5260.endd
5261The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5262these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5263lines.
5264
5265Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5266list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5267defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5268option.
5269
5270
5271
5272
5273
5274
5275. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5276. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5277
5278.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5279.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5280.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5281The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5282is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5283the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5284configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5285of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5286itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5287initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5288mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5289
5290
5291
5292.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5293The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5294file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5295the line
5296.code
5297# primary_hostname =
5298.endd
5299This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5300to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5301can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5302it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5303
5304The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5305.code
5306domainlist local_domains = @
5307domainlist relay_to_domains =
5308hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5309.endd
5310These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5311domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5312domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5313configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5314
5315The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5316later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5317on the local host.
5318
5319.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5320There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5321of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5322called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5323be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5324the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5325
5326The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5327list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5328controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5329domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5330domain is permitted.
5331
5332The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5333used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5334that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5335loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5336submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5337hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5338
5339Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5340we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5341and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5342
5343The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5344.code
5345acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5346acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5347.endd
5348These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5349during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5350command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5351respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5352&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5353section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5354accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5355to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5356contents of a message to be checked.
5357
5358Two commented-out option settings are next:
5359.code
5360# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5361# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5362.endd
5363These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5364content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5365scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5366details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5367
5368Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5369.code
5370# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5371# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5372# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5373.endd
5374These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5375support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5376first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5377connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5378other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5379key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5380More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5381
5382Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5383.code
5384# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5385# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5386.endd
5387.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5388.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5389.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5390.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5391.cindex "smtps protocol"
5392.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5393.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5394These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5395server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5396TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5397more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5398on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5399port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5400configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5401non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5402&<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5403
5404Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5405.code
5406# qualify_domain =
5407# qualify_recipient =
5408.endd
5409The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5410complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5411receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5412the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5413you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5414addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5415
5416.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5417The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5418addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5419(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5420.code
5421# allow_domain_literals
5422.endd
5423The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5424Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5425quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5426try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5427people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5428&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5429
5430The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5431.code
5432never_users = root
5433.endd
5434It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5435convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5436setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5437The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5438list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5439FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5440contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5441FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5442
5443When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5444Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5445line,
5446.code
5447host_lookup = *
5448.endd
5449specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5450in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5451information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5452or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5453Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5454because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5455unreachable.
5456
5457The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
54581413 (hence their names):
5459.code
5460rfc1413_hosts = *
5461rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5462.endd
5463These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5464You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5465that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5466Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5467messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5468result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5469delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5470
5471When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5472be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5473if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5474find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5475.code
5476# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5477# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5478.endd
5479show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5480and recipient addresses, respectively.
5481
5482The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5483.code
5484# percent_hack_domains =
5485.endd
5486It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5487This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5488anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5489
5490The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5491concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5492message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5493occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5494address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5495bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5496are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5497always bounce messages.
5498.code
5499ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5500timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5501.endd
5502The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5503discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5504message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5505after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5506bounce message ever lasts a week.
5507
5508
5509
5510.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5511.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5512.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5513In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5514It starts with the line
5515.code
5516begin acl
5517.endd
5518and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5519&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5520and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5521
5522.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5523The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5524RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5525are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5526rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5527result of the ACL processing.
5528.code
5529acl_check_rcpt:
5530.endd
5531This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5532ACL, and names it.
5533.code
5534accept hosts = :
5535.endd
5536This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5537But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5538names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5539list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5540host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5541important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5542
5543What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5544messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5545input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5546manner.
5547.code
5548deny message = Restricted characters in address
5549 domains = +local_domains
5550 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5551
5552deny message = Restricted characters in address
5553 domains = !+local_domains
5554 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5555.endd
5556These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5557characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5558Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5559&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5560in Internet mail addresses.
5561
5562The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5563addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5564option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5565in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5566programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5567at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5568characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5569policy of being as safe as possible.
5570
5571The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5572to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5573first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5574&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5575reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5576&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5577
5578The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5579block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5580or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5581have to modify this rule.
5582
5583Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5584allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5585common convention of local parts constructed as
5586&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5587the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5588with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5589file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5590that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5591is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5592
5593The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5594allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5595and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5596with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5597local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5598and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5599(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5600.code
5601accept local_parts = postmaster
5602 domains = +local_domains
5603.endd
5604This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5605local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5606&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5607reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5608&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5609
5610The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5611by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5612in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5613.code
5614require verify = sender
5615.endd
5616This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5617ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5618address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5619see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5620addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5621used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5622discusses the details of address verification.
5623.code
5624accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5625 control = submission
5626.endd
5627This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5628hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5629verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5630that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5631second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5632is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5633messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5634&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5635probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5636.code
5637accept authenticated = *
5638 control = submission
5639.endd
5640This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5641Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5642likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5643authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5644examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5645fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5646.code
5647require message = relay not permitted
5648 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5649.endd
5650This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5651one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5652.code
5653require verify = recipient
5654.endd
5655This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5656fails, the address is rejected.
5657.code
5658# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5659# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5660# $dnslist_text
5661# dnslists = black.list.example
5662#
5663# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5664# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5665# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5666# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5667.endd
5668These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5669sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5670from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5671line.
5672.code
5673# require verify = csa
5674.endd
5675This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5676authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5677records.
5678.code
5679accept
5680.endd
5681The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5682address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5683.code
5684acl_check_data:
5685.endd
5686This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5687of this ACL are commented out:
5688.code
5689# deny malware = *
5690# message = This message contains a virus \
5691# ($malware_name).
5692.endd
5693These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5694viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5695suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5696virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5697.code
5698# warn spam = nobody
5699# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5700# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5701# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5702# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5703.endd
5704These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5705SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5706and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5707&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5708series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5709whatever the spam score.
5710.code
5711accept
5712.endd
5713This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5714
5715
5716.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5717.cindex "default" "routers"
5718.cindex "routers" "default"
5719The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5720by the line
5721.code
5722begin routers
5723.endd
5724Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5725messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5726accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5727matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5728manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5729.code
5730# domain_literal:
5731# driver = ipliteral
5732# domains = !+local_domains
5733# transport = remote_smtp
5734.endd
5735.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5736This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5737support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5738you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5739&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5740.code
5741dnslookup:
5742 driver = dnslookup
5743 domains = ! +local_domains
5744 transport = remote_smtp
5745 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5746 no_more
5747.endd
5748The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5749domains. This is specified by the line
5750.code
5751domains = ! +local_domains
5752.endd
5753The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5754exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5755that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5756the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5757indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5758passed on to the following routers.
5759
5760The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5761and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5762the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5763instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5764one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5765
5766The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5767DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5768router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5769specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5770in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5771the address fails and is bounced.
5772
5773The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5774be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5775encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5776whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5777Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5778email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5779continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5780out.
5781.code
5782system_aliases:
5783 driver = redirect
5784 allow_fail
5785 allow_defer
5786 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5787# user = exim
5788 file_transport = address_file
5789 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5790.endd
5791Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5792domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5793alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5794data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5795the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5796the next router.
5797
5798&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5799often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5800file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5801&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5802.code
5803userforward:
5804 driver = redirect
5805 check_local_user
5806# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5807# local_part_suffix_optional
5808 file = $home/.forward
5809# allow_filter
5810 no_verify
5811 no_expn
5812 check_ancestor
5813 file_transport = address_file
5814 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5815 reply_transport = address_reply
5816.endd
5817This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5818redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5819individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5820local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5821router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5822namely:
5823.code
5824# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5825# local_part_suffix_optional
5826.endd
5827.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5828show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5829is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5830by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5831variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5832presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5833the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5834
5835When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5836home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5837declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5838redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5839
5840.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5841Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5842files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5843is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5844of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5845filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5846separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5847
5848The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5849verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5850There are two reasons for doing this:
5851
5852.olist
5853Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5854checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5855unnecessary work.
5856.next
5857More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5858command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5859The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5860It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5861this time.
5862.endlist
5863
5864The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5865address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5866works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5867forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5868
5869The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5870forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5871auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5872.code
5873a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5874.endd
5875the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5876transport.
5877.code
5878localuser:
5879 driver = accept
5880 check_local_user
5881# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5882# local_part_suffix_optional
5883 transport = local_delivery
5884.endd
5885The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5886part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5887the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5888routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5889same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5890
5891
5892.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5893.cindex "default" "transports"
5894.cindex "transports" "default"
5895Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5896only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5897not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5898.code
5899begin transports
5900.endd
5901One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5902.code
5903remote_smtp:
5904 driver = smtp
5905.endd
5906This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5907options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5908.code
5909local_delivery:
5910 driver = appendfile
5911 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5912 delivery_date_add
5913 envelope_to_add
5914 return_path_add
5915# group = mail
5916# mode = 0660
5917.endd
5918This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5919traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5920local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5921directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5922under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5923show how this can be done.
5924
5925Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5926&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5927similarly-named options above.
5928.code
5929address_pipe:
5930 driver = pipe
5931 return_output
5932.endd
5933This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5934redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5935option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5936sender.
5937.code
5938address_file:
5939 driver = appendfile
5940 delivery_date_add
5941 envelope_to_add
5942 return_path_add
5943.endd
5944This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5945redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5946&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5947.code
5948address_reply:
5949 driver = autoreply
5950.endd
5951This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5952filter files.
5953
5954
5955
5956.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5957.cindex "retry" "default rule"
5958.cindex "default" "retry rule"
5959The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5960Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5961introduced by the line
5962.code
5963begin retry
5964.endd
5965In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5966errors:
5967.code
5968* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5969.endd
5970This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
59712 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
59721.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5973is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5974
5975If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5976if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5977temporary errors into permanent errors.
5978
5979
5980.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5981The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5982.code
5983begin rewrite
5984.endd
5985contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5986rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5987
5988
5989
5990.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5991.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5992The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5993.code
5994begin authenticators
5995.endd
5996defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5997configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5998which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5999standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6000mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6001to support most MUA software.
6002
6003The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6004.code
6005#PLAIN:
6006# driver = plaintext
6007# server_set_id = $auth2
6008# server_prompts = :
6009# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6010# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6011.endd
6012And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6013.code
6014#LOGIN:
6015# driver = plaintext
6016# server_set_id = $auth1
6017# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6018# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6019# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
6020.endd
6021
6022The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6023in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6024&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6025that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6026i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6027when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6028when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6029need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6030
6031The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6032password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6033To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6034expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6035
6036Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6037usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
6038covers both.
6039
6040.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6041
6042
6043
6044. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6045. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6046
6047.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6048
6049.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6050.cindex "PCRE"
6051Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6052uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6053matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6054regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6055Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6056O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6057
6058The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6059are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6060description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6061the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6062the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6063case-insensitive.
6064
6065In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6066it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6067or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6068second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6069.code
6070domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6071.endd
6072The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6073precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6074of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6075regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6076backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6077normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6078matched.
6079
6080There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6081recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6082string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6083these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6084it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6085match anywhere in the subject string.
6086
6087In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6088you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6089.code
6090domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6091.endd
6092matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6093You need to use:
6094.code
6095domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6096.endd
6097if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6098$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6099
6100
6101
6102. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6103. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6104
6105.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6106.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6107.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6108.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6109Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6110messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6111
6112.olist
6113A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6114cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6115lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6116can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6117&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6118.next
6119Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6120way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6121returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6122succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6123chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6124.endlist
6125
6126String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6127that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6128involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6129if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6130time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6131chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6132
6133.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6134It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6135lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6136processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6137Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6138.code
6139domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6140domains = lsearch;/some/file
6141.endd
6142The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6143No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6144defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6145The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6146file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6147.code
6148192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6149192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6150.endd
6151When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6152possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6153
6154In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6155Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6156in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6157.code
6158domain1:
6159domain2:
6160.endd
6161Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6162matches the list item.
6163
6164It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6165Consider a file containing lines like this:
6166.code
6167192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6168.endd
6169If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6170first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6171causes a second lookup to occur.
6172
6173The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6174available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6175lookup is permitted.
6176
6177
6178.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6179.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6180.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6181Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6182
6183.ilist
6184The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6185and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6186lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6187.next
6188.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6189The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6190key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6191Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6192.endlist
6193
6194The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6195the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6196default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6197.code
6198LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6199LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6200.endd
6201which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6202For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6203libraries and header files before building Exim.
6204
6205
6206
6207
6208.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6209.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6210.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6211The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6212
6213.ilist
6214.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6215.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6216.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6217&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6218string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6219indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6220re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6221aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6222be found in several places:
6223.display
6224&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6225&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6226&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6227.endd
6228A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6229because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6230However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6231you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6232.next
6233.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6234.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6235.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6236&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6237DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6238zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6239&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6240
6241.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6242For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6243when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6244using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6245the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6246that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6247other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6248.new
6249.next
6250.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6251.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6252.cindex "sasldb2"
6253.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6254&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6255interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6256ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6257authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6258&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6259&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6260.wen
6261.next
6262.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6263.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6264.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6265.cindex "Courier"
6266.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6267.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6268&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6269is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6270if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6271other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6272use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6273calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6274utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6275by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6276.next
6277.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6278.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6279&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6280whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6281contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6282the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6283symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6284lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6285&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6286.next
6287.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6288.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6289&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6290terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6291file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6292IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6293being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6294.code
62951.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6296192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6297"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6298"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6299.endd
6300The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6301file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6302key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6303&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6304&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6305
6306&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6307&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6308lookup types support only literal keys.
6309
6310&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6311the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6312&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6313.next
6314.cindex "linear search"
6315.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6316.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6317.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6318&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6319line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6320end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6321letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6322in the file is used.
6323
6324White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6325line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6326continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6327space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6328junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6329colon, for example:
6330.code
6331baduser: :fail:
6332.endd
6333Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6334middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6335that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6336wildcarding of any kind.
6337
6338.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6339.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6340In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6341characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6342If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6343matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6344contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6345quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6346quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6347
6348.next
6349.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6350.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6351.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6352&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6353the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6354&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6355reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6356aliases; the full map names must be used.
6357
6358.next
6359.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6360.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6361.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6362.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6363&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6364&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6365the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6366that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6367used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6368
6369.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6370Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6371file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6372&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6373
6374. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6375. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6376
6377.olist
6378The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6379.code
6380 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6381 *fish data for anythingfish
6382.endd
6383.next
6384The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6385example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6386.code
6387 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6388.endd
6389Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6390expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6391string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6392.code
6393 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6394.endd
6395The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6396expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6397For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6398.code
6399 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6400.endd
6401
6402If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6403either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6404ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6405colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6406escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6407
6408&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6409match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6410is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6411takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6412&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6413
6414.next
6415Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6416is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6417lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6418example:
6419.code
6420 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6421.endd
6422The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6423.endlist olist
6424
6425Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6426continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6427be followed by optional colons.
6428
6429&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6430&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6431lookup types support only literal keys.
6432.endlist ilist
6433
6434
6435.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6436.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6437.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6438The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6439many of them are given in later sections.
6440
6441.ilist
6442.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6443.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6444&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6445are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6446records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6447.next
6448.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6449.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6450&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6451.next
6452.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6453.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6454&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6455returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6456that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6457called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6458any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6459.next
6460.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6461.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6462&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6463MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6464.next
6465.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6466.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6467&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6468the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6469.next
6470.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6471.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6472&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6473Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6474.next
6475.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6476.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6477.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6478&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6479lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6480success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6481lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6482password value. For example:
6483.code
6484*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6485.endd
6486.next
6487.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6488.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6489&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6490PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6491
6492.next
6493.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6494.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6495&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6496that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6497
6498.next
6499&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6500not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6501.next
6502.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6503.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6504&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6505allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6506address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6507obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6508at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6509superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6510&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6511.code
6512require condition = \
6513 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6514.endd
6515The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6516the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6517this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6518one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6519.endlist
6520
6521
6522
6523.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6524.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6525Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6526completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6527reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6528options such as a list of local domains.
6529
6530When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6531of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6532temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6533or may give up altogether.
6534
6535
6536
6537.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6538.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6539.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6540.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6541.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6542.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6543In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6544that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6545
6546&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6547lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6548specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6549
6550If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6551and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6552provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6553
6554.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6555.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6556.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6557Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6558&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6559character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6560by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6561that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6562take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6563For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6564.code
6565data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6566.endd
6567Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6568looks up these keys, in this order:
6569.code
6570jane@eyre.example
6571*@eyre.example
6572*
6573.endd
6574The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6575&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6576complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6577Exim move on to try the next key.
6578
6579
6580
6581.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6582.cindex "partial matching"
6583.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6584.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6585.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6586.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6587The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6588match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6589being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6590information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6591domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6592a key in a DBM file is
6593.code
6594*.dates.fict.example
6595.endd
6596then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6597&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6598by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6599file.
6600
6601&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6602also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6603&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6604
6605Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6606keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6607be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6608partial matching keys
6609beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6610Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6611unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6612
6613Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6614the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6615is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6616is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6617fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6618start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6619remains.
6620
6621A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6622by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6623&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6624modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6625subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6626up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6627.code
66282250.dates.fict.example
6629*.2250.dates.fict.example
6630*.dates.fict.example
6631*.fict.example
6632.endd
6633As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6634finishes.
6635
6636.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6637.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6638The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6639changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6640formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6641parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6642.code
6643domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6644.endd
6645In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6646&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6647components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6648other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6649.code
6650domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6651.endd
6652For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6653&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6654
6655If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6656just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6657down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6658
6659.ilist
6660If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6661.next
6662If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6663example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6664.next
6665Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6666remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6667for &"*"& on its own.
6668.next
6669Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6670.endlist
6671
6672
6673If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6674&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6675this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6676specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6677prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6678lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6679&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6680
6681The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6682in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6683dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6684in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6685subject key is always followed by a dot.
6686
6687
6688
6689
6690.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6691.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6692.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6693Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6694lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6695of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6696single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6697
6698For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6699another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6700many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6701the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6702closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6703own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6704
6705The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6706strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6707complete.
6708
6709
6710
6711
6712.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6713.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6714.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6715When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6716is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6717the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6718.code
6719[name=$local_part]
6720.endd
6721will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6722For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6723.code
6724[name="$local_part"]
6725.endd
6726but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6727NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6728rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6729of the following form is provided:
6730.code
6731${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6732.endd
6733For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6734.code
6735[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6736.endd
6737See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6738operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6739lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6740
6741
6742
6743
6744.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6745.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6746.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6747.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6748The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6749of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6750an expansion string could contain:
6751.code
6752${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6753.endd
6754If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6755is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6756&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6757&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6758
6759.new
6760The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6761and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6762configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6763the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6764&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6765.wen
6766.code
6767${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6768.endd
6769If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6770altered and nothing is added.
6771
6772.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6773.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6774For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6775each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6776port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6777
6778For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6779single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6780concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6781depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6782between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6783by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6784.code
6785${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6786.endd
6787It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6788white space is ignored.
6789
6790.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6791.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6792.new
6793For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6794unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6795character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6796items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6797default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6798.wen
6799.code
6800${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6801${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6802${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6803.endd
6804It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6805white space is ignored.
6806
6807.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6808.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6809By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6810each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6811the pseudo-type MXH:
6812.code
6813${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6814.endd
6815In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6816returned.
6817
6818.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6819Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6820records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6821component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6822records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6823error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6824but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6825top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6826.code
6827${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6828${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6829.endd
6830Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6831the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6832the name servers for &%edu%&.
6833
6834You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6835top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6836sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6837given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6838for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6839such a list.
6840
6841.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6842A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6843records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6844&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6845not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6846result of a successful lookup such as:
6847.code
6848${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6849.endd
6850has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6851The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6852authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6853
6854
6855.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6856In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6857However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6858&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6859the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6860.code
6861${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6862${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6863${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6864.endd
6865In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6866the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6867to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6868case, it does not treat it as a list.
6869
6870The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6871in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6872different separator can be specified, as described above.
6873
6874The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6875temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6876an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6877type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6878&"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6879whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6880ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6881With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6882error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6883succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6884.code
6885${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6886${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6887.endd
6888Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6889yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6890
6891
6892
6893
6894.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6895.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6896.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6897.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6898The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6899become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6900implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6901contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6902the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6903it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6904indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6905your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6906.code
6907LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6908LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6909LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6910LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6911LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6912.endd
6913If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6914same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6915
6916There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6917the way they handle the results of a query:
6918
6919.ilist
6920&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6921gives an error.
6922.next
6923&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6924Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6925.next
6926&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6927from all of them are returned.
6928.endlist
6929
6930
6931For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6932Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6933the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6934First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6935
6936
6937.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6938.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6939An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6940the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6941.code
6942data = ${lookup ldap \
6943 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6944 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6945.endd
6946.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6947The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6948secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6949encrypted TLS connection is used.
6950
6951With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
6952LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
6953See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
6954
6955
6956.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6957.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6958Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6959and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6960within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6961reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6962
6963The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6964filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6965the string:
6966.code
6967* => \2A
6968( => \28
6969) => \29
6970\ => \5C
6971.endd
6972in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6973to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6974.code
6975! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
6976.endd
6977are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6978.code
6979${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6980.endd
6981yields
6982.code
6983%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6984.endd
6985Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6986.code
6987a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6988.endd
6989The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6990base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6991by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6992.code
6993, + " \ < > ;
6994.endd
6995It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6996before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6997is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6998.code
6999${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7000.endd
7001yields
7002.code
7003%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7004.endd
7005Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7006.code
7007\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7008.endd
7009There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7010authentication below.
7011
7012
7013.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7014.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7015The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7016is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7017an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7018by starting it with
7019.code
7020ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7021.endd
7022If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7023used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7024taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7025colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7026handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7027returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7028are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7029Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7030failures, and timeouts.
7031
7032For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7033of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7034&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7035doubled. For example
7036.code
7037ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7038.endd
7039If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7040to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7041the local host) is used.
7042
7043If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7044a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7045&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7046to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7047not available.
7048
7049For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7050for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7051can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7052the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7053.code
7054ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7055.endd
7056When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7057&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7058.code
7059${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7060.endd
7061When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7062a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7063specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7064socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7065&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7066or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7067the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7068backup host.
7069
7070If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7071specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7072&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7073
7074.ilist
7075Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7076interface.
7077.next
7078Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7079.endlist
7080
7081
7082Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7083&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7084
7085
7086
7087.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7088.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7089The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7090information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7091be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7092spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7093when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7094them. The following names are recognized:
7095.display
7096&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7097&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7098&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7099&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7100&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7101&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7102&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7103.endd
7104The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7105&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7106must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7107library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7108
7109The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7110backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7111enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7112network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7113&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7114LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7115if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7116SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7117Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7118
7119The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7120set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7121
7122
7123Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7124values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7125.code
7126${lookup ldap
7127 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7128 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7129 {$value}fail}
7130.endd
7131The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7132any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7133which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7134non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7135
7136The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7137connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7138on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7139
7140When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7141removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7142some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7143quoting has two advantages:
7144
7145.ilist
7146It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7147DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7148.next
7149It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7150.endlist
7151
7152For example, a setting such as
7153.code
7154USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7155.endd
7156should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7157
7158Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7159expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7160field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7161does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7162.code
7163PASS=${quote:$3}
7164.endd
7165The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7166SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7167&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7168
7169
7170
7171.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7172.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7173The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7174as a sequence of values, for example
7175.code
7176cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7177.endd
7178The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7179search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7180the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7181values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7182you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7183directory.
7184
7185In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7186result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7187has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7188
7189If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7190strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7191quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7192backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7193Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7194output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7195same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7196
7197Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7198LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7199&%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7200.code
7201ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7202value1.1, value1.2
7203
7204ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7205value two
7206
7207ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7208attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7209
7210ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7211objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7212.endd
7213The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7214individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7215make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7216results of LDAP lookups.
7217
7218
7219
7220
7221.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7222.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7223.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7224NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7225and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7226contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7227of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7228values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7229.code
7230[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7231.endd
7232might return the string
7233.code
7234name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7235home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7236.endd
7237(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7238.code
7239[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7240.endd
7241would just return
7242.code
7243Martin Guerre
7244.endd
7245with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7246for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7247operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7248
7249
7250
7251.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7252.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7253.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7254.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7255.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7256.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7257.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7258.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7259.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7260.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7261Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7262databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7263might be
7264.code
7265${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7266 {$value}fail}
7267.endd
7268If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7269field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7270.code
7271${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7272 {$value}}
7273.endd
7274might be
7275.code
7276home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7277.endd
7278Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7279quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7280field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7281.code
7282Mister X
7283.endd
7284If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7285with a newline between the data for each row.
7286
7287
7288.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7289.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7290.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7291.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7292.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7293.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7294.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7295.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7296.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7297If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7298&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7299option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7300information.
7301(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7302queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7303&<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7304items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7305Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7306name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7307.code
7308hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7309.endd
7310Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7311&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7312option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7313.code
7314hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7315 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7316.endd
7317For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7318because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7319query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7320a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7321found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7322servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7323
7324The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7325convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7326respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7327itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7328addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7329for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7330characters are not special.
7331
7332.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7333For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7334it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7335done by starting the query with
7336.display
7337&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7338.endd
7339Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7340.olist
7341If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7342global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7343of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7344taken from there.
7345.next
7346If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7347.endlist
7348The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7349Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7350successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7351
7352This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7353are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7354master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7355like this:
7356.code
7357mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7358 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7359 master/db/name/pw
7360.endd
7361In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7362.code
7363${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7364.endd
7365That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7366the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7367option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7368.code
7369${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7370.endd
7371
7372
7373.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7374For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7375causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7376socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7377each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7378.display
7379<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7380 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7381.endd
7382Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7383the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7384
7385No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7386the queries.
7387
7388If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7389or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7390
7391&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7392anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7393is zero because no rows are affected.
7394
7395
7396.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7397PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7398This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7399However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7400database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7401looks like this:
7402.code
7403hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7404.endd
7405In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7406given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7407visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7408
7409If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7410update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7411affected.
7412
7413.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7414.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7415.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7416SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7417addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7418daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7419of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7420separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7421contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7422.code
7423${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7424 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7425.endd
7426In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7427.code
7428domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7429 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7430.endd
7431The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7432quote, which it doubles.
7433
7434The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7435internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7436update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7437are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7438waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7439to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7440option.
7441.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7442.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7443
7444
7445. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7446. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7447
7448.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7449 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7450 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7451.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7452A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7453email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7454contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7455are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7456arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7457
7458Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7459host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7460different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7461general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7462
7463
7464
7465.section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7466.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7467Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7468expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7469into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7470but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7471&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7472discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7473
7474
7475If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7476testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7477expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7478
7479If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7480other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7481misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7482the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7483expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7484.code
7485deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7486 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7487.endd
7488The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7489&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7490senders based on the receiving domain.
7491
7492
7493
7494
7495.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7496.cindex "list" "negation"
7497.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7498Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7499leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7500defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7501it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7502(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7503
7504The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7505subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7506subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7507subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7508was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7509.code
7510domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7511.endd
7512matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7513neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7514list is positive. However, if the setting were
7515.code
7516domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7517.endd
7518then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7519list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7520as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7521
7522Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7523the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7524item.
7525
7526
7527
7528.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7529.cindex "list" "file name in"
7530If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7531name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7532processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7533file names are not allowed,
7534and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7535Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7536lines:
7537
7538.ilist
7539For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7540file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7541.next
7542Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7543address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7544white space or the start of the line. For example:
7545.code
7546not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7547.endd
7548.endlist
7549
7550Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7551file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7552is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7553so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7554
7555If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7556within the file is inverted. For example, if
7557.code
7558hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7559.endd
7560and the file contains the lines
7561.code
7562!a.b.c
7563*.b.c
7564.endd
7565then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7566any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7567
7568
7569
7570.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7571As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7572to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7573confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7574an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7575sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7576non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7577always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7578
7579If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7580list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7581in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7582&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7583
7584
7585
7586
7587.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7588.cindex "named lists"
7589.cindex "list" "named"
7590A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7591which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7592particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7593places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7594the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7595a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7596locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7597.code
7598domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7599.endd
7600Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7601for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7602configured with the line
7603.code
7604domains = +local_domains
7605.endd
7606The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7607except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7608.code
7609dnslookup:
7610 driver = dnslookup
7611 domains = ! +local_domains
7612 transport = remote_smtp
7613 no_more
7614.endd
7615The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7616the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7617respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7618equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7619.code
7620hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7621addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7622.endd
7623A named list may refer to other named lists:
7624.code
7625domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7626domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7627domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7628.endd
7629&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7630effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7631out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7632.code
7633domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7634domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7635.endd
7636The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7637list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7638means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7639.code
7640domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7641.endd
7642where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7643referenced lists if you can.
7644
7645Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7646address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7647lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7648.code
7649domains = +local_domains
7650.endd
7651on several of your routers
7652or in several ACL statements,
7653the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7654if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7655references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7656the same each time they are referenced.
7657
7658By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7659extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7660is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7661hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7662
7663
7664
7665.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7666.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7667.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7668At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7669configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7670write
7671.code
7672ALIST = host1 : host2
7673auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7674.endd
7675it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7676.code
7677auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7678.endd
7679Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7680list, and write
7681.code
7682hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7683auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7684.endd
7685the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7686.code
7687auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7688.endd
7689
7690
7691.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7692.cindex "list" "caching of named"
7693.cindex "caching" "named lists"
7694While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7695it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7696the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7697that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7698an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7699message. For example:
7700.code
7701domainlist special_domains = \
7702 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7703.endd
7704This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7705address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7706in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7707cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7708same list each time.
7709
7710By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7711cache the result anyway. For example:
7712.code
7713domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7714.endd
7715If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7716the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7717
7718
7719
7720.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7721.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7722.cindex "list" "domain list"
7723Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7724The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7725
7726.ilist
7727.cindex "primary host name"
7728.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7729.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7730.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7731.cindex "@ in a domain list"
7732If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7733as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7734possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7735differ only in their names.
7736.next
7737.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7738.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7739.cindex "domain literal"
7740If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7741in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7742only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7743&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7744control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7745In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7746.next
7747.cindex "@mx_any"
7748.cindex "@mx_primary"
7749.cindex "@mx_secondary"
7750.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7751If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7752has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7753.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7754&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7755are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7756local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7757but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7758preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7759
7760The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7761performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7762example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7763resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7764options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7765
7766Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7767patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7768list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7769ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7770on a router). For example:
7771.code
7772domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7773.endd
7774This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7775the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7776
7777The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7778host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7779contain negative items.
7780
7781Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7782be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7783list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7784.code
7785domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7786 an.other.domain : ...
7787.endd
7788so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7789involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7790.code
7791domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7792 an.other.domain ? ...
7793.endd
7794.next
7795.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7796.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7797.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7798If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7799are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7800domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7801list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7802matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7803list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7804&'cipher.key.ex'&.
7805
7806.next
7807.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7808.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7809If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7810expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7811function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7812Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7813default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7814with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7815are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7816
7817&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7818must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7819use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7820it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7821expression by expansion, of course).
7822.next
7823.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7824.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7825If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7826semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7827must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7828&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7829.code
7830domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7831.endd
7832The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7833key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7834only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7835is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7836or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7837&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7838other statements in the same ACL.
7839
7840.next
7841Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7842&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7843.code
7844domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7845.endd
7846This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7847works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7848
7849.next
7850.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7851Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7852a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7853original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7854select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7855value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7856expansion variable.
7857.next
7858If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7859semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7860pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7861chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7862.code
7863hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7864 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7865.endd
7866In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7867example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7868whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7869&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7870variable and can be referred to in other options.
7871.next
7872.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7873If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7874between the pattern and the domain.
7875.endlist
7876
7877Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7878.code
7879domainlist funny_domains = \
7880 @ : \
7881 lib.unseen.edu : \
7882 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7883 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7884 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7885 nis;domains.byname : \
7886 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7887.endd
7888There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7889an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7890explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7891but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7892patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7893patterns earlier.
7894
7895
7896
7897.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7898.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7899.cindex "list" "host list"
7900Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7901example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7902may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7903two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7904pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7905You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7906involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7907
7908
7909.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7910.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7911.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7912If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7913involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7914process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7915not used.
7916
7917.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7918The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7919the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7920
7921
7922
7923.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7924.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7925If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7926the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7927&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7928list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7929systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7930concerns.)
7931
7932The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7933inspecting its IP address:
7934
7935.ilist
7936If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7937with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7938to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7939&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7940This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7941with the IP address of the subject host.
7942
7943If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7944lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7945ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7946temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7947what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7948
7949.next
7950.cindex "@ in a host list"
7951If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7952domain name, as just described.
7953
7954.next
7955If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7956subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7957IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7958be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7959separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7960without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7961IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7962that can never match a client host.
7963
7964.next
7965.cindex "@[] in a host list"
7966If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7967the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7968interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7969.code
7970accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7971accept hosts = @[]
7972.endd
7973.next
7974.cindex "CIDR notation"
7975If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7976example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7977host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7978included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7979specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7980significant end of the address.
7981
7982&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7983of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7984address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7985addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7986.code
7987192.168.23.236/31
7988.endd
7989matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
799032 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7991matches.
7992
7993Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7994.code
7995recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7996 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7997.endd
7998The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7999appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8000For example:
8001.code
8002recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8003.endd
8004could make use of a file containing
8005.code
8006172.16.0.0/12
80073ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8008.endd
8009to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8010addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8011changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8012.code
8013recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8014 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8015.endd
8016The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8017list.
8018.endlist
8019
8020
8021
8022.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8023 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8024.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8025When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8026address, the pattern takes this form:
8027.display
8028&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8029.endd
8030For example:
8031.code
8032hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8033.endd
8034The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8035IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8036letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8037&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8038quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8039returned by the lookup is not used.
8040
8041.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8042.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8043Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8044patterns of this form:
8045.display
8046&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8047.endd
8048For example:
8049.code
8050net24-dbm;/networks.db
8051.endd
8052The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8053length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8054mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8055is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8056&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8057
8058When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8059of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8060terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8061to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8062recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8063(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8064For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8065converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8066addresses are always used.
8067
8068Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8069colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8070However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8071configurations.
8072
8073&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8074IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8075the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8076case the IP address is used on its own.
8077
8078
8079
8080.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8081.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8082.cindex "unknown host name"
8083.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8084There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8085remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8086complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8087address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8088above.)
8089
8090If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8091patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8092Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8093DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8094Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8095effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8096Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8097
8098Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8099against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8100
8101By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8102if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8103&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8104are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8105security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8106for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8107Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8108discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8109found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8110
8111There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8112found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8113
8114.cindex "host" "alias for"
8115.cindex "alias for host"
8116As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8117of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8118
8119.ilist
8120.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8121If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8122the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8123&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8124requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8125expression.
8126.next
8127.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8128.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8129If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8130matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8131expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8132case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8133syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8134example,
8135.code
8136^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8137.endd
8138is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8139&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8140that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8141string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8142part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8143.code
8144sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8145.endd
8146&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8147&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8148example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8149required.
8150.endlist
8151
8152
8153
8154
8155.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8156.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8157While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8158name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8159from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8160behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8161
8162&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8163apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8164
8165.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8166.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8167By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8168always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8169items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8170top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8171
8172.ilist
8173If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8174cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8175.code
8176host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8177.endd
8178rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8179any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8180
8181.next
8182If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8183be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8184example:
8185.code
8186accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8187 192.168.4.5
8188.endd
8189accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8190whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8191name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8192.endlist
8193
8194Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8195list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8196list.
8197
8198
8199.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8200 "SECTtemdnserr"
8201.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8202.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8203.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8204A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8205&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8206host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8207&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8208section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8209host lists such as whitelists.
8210
8211
8212
8213.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8214 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8215.cindex "unknown host name"
8216.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8217If a pattern is of the form
8218.display
8219<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8220.endd
8221for example
8222.code
8223dbm;/host/accept/list
8224.endd
8225a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8226lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8227is not used.
8228
8229&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8230keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8231addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8232&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8233two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8234lookup, both using the same file.
8235
8236
8237
8238.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8239If a pattern is of the form
8240.display
8241<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8242.endd
8243the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8244data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8245&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8246.code
8247hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8248 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8249.endd
8250The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8251can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8252use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8253operator.
8254
8255If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8256looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8257&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8258
8259Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8260host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8261&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8262still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8263effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8264See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8265
8266
8267
8268.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8269 "SECTmixwilhos"
8270.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8271If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8272host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8273ACL you could have:
8274.code
8275accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8276.endd
8277The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8278It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8279item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8280compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8281&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8282IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8283
8284If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8285address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8286.code
8287accept hosts = *.friend.example
8288accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8289.endd
8290If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8291&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8292
8293
8294
8295
8296
8297.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8298.cindex "list" "address list"
8299.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8300.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8301Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8302is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8303always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8304list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8305using this option setting:
8306.code
8307senders = :
8308.endd
8309The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8310data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8311detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8312and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8313
8314Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8315example:
8316.code
8317senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8318.endd
8319A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8320character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8321semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8322subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8323with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8324the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8325wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8326.code
8327deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8328 *@+hostile_domains:\
8329 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8330 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8331.endd
8332.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8333.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8334If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8335specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8336treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8337
8338If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8339contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8340address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8341domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8342is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8343.code
8344deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8345.endd
8346
8347The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8348address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8349senders:
8350
8351.ilist
8352.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8353.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8354If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8355done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8356You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8357as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8358to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8359.code
8360deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8361 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8362.endd
8363The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8364start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8365
8366.next
8367.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8368Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8369lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8370example:
8371.code
8372deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8373 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8374 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8375.endd
8376Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8377lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8378not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8379always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8380
8381Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8382cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8383panic log.
8384.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8385However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8386&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8387default. For example, with this lookup:
8388.code
8389accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8390.endd
8391the file could contains lines like this:
8392.code
8393user1@domain1.example
8394*@domain2.example
8395.endd
8396and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8397that are tried is:
8398.code
8399nimrod@jaeger.example
8400*@jaeger.example
8401*
8402.endd
8403&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8404would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8405
8406&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8407.code
8408deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8409deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8410.endd
8411The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8412because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8413domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8414.endlist
8415
8416
8417The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8418If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8419always fails.
8420
8421
8422.ilist
8423.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8424.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8425.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8426If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8427(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8428split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8429it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8430from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8431of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8432
8433.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8434The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8435keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8436patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8437even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8438with
8439.code
8440deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8441.endd
8442the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8443.code
8444baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8445.endd
8446to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8447
8448.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8449If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8450has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8451may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8452but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8453surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8454.code
8455aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8456spammer3 : spammer4
8457.endd
8458As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8459doubling.
8460
8461If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8462of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8463list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8464might have entries like
8465.code
8466aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8467xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8468*: ^\d{8}$
8469.endd
8470in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8471local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8472each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8473chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8474
8475.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8476It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8477them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8478
8479.next
8480The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8481lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8482can only return a single list of local parts.
8483.endlist
8484
8485&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8486in these two examples:
8487.code
8488senders = +my_list
8489senders = *@+my_list
8490.endd
8491In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8492example it is a named domain list.
8493
8494
8495
8496
8497.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8498.cindex "case of local parts"
8499.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8500.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8501Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8502case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8503Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8504Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8505blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8506lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8507default.
8508
8509The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8510address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8511comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8512the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8513that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8514keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8515works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8516case-independent.
8517
8518.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8519To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8520an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8521part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8522longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8523lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8524performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8525become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8526
8527
8528
8529.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8530.cindex "list" "local part list"
8531.cindex "local part" "list"
8532Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8533lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8534setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8535set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8536case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8537matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8538&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8539option is case-sensitive from the start.
8540
8541If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8542comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8543only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8544Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8545that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8546&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8547Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8548types.
8549.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8550
8551
8552
8553
8554. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8555. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8556
8557.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8558.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8559Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8560them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8561
8562When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8563when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8564start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8565below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8566escape character, as described in the following section.
8567
8568Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8569dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8570options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8571the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8572conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8573reasons.
8574
8575
8576
8577.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8578.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8579An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8580backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8581character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8582If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8583required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8584the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8585
8586.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8587A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8588two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8589expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8590.code
8591deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8592.endd
8593On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8594without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8595string.
8596
8597
8598
8599.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8600.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8601A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8602expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8603carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8604octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8605backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8606encoding.
8607
8608These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8609in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8610and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8611
8612
8613.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8614.cindex "expansion" "testing"
8615.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8616.oindex "&%-be%&"
8617Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8618takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8619arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8620to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8621since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8622value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8623database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8624and &%nhash%&.
8625
8626Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8627instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8628using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8629
8630.oindex "&%-bem%&"
8631If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8632from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8633option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8634read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8635.code
8636exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8637.endd
8638The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8639Exim message identifier. For example:
8640.code
8641exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8642.endd
8643This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8644is therefore restricted to admin users.
8645
8646
8647.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8648.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8649A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8650alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8651(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8652used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8653instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8654the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8655that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8656its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8657from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8658taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8659being expanded.
8660
8661
8662
8663
8664.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8665The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8666between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8667outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8668white space is significant.
8669
8670.vlist
8671.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8672.cindex "expansion" "variables"
8673Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8674.code
8675$local_part
8676${domain}
8677.endd
8678The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8679characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8680&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8681section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8682given, the expansion fails.
8683
8684.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8685.cindex "expansion" "operators"
8686The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8687<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8688.code
8689${lc:$local_part}
8690.endd
8691The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8692leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8693below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8694one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8695string easier to understand.
8696
8697.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8698This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8699expansion item below.
8700
8701.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8702 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8703.cindex &%dlfunc%&
8704This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8705This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8706.code
8707EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8708.endd
8709set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8710object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8711(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8712
8713There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8714a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8715included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8716are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8717must have the following type:
8718.code
8719int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8720.endd
8721Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8722function should return one of the following values:
8723
8724&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8725into the expanded string that is being built.
8726
8727&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8728from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8729
8730&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8731taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8732
8733&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8734
8735When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8736you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8737configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8738
8739.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8740 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8741.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8742.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8743The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8744white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8745must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8746form:
8747.display
8748<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8749.endd
8750.vindex "&$value$&"
8751where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8752values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8753values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8754described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8755for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8756the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8757otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8758variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8759is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8760
8761If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8762key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8763extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8764yield &"2001"&:
8765.code
8766${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8767${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8768.endd
8769Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8770appear, for example:
8771.code
8772${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8773.endd
8774This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8775{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8776
8777
8778.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8779 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8780.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8781.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8782The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8783apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8784This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8785behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8786extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8787argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8788<&'string3'&> as before.
8789
8790The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8791separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8792The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8793counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8794number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8795number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8796expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8797provided. For example:
8798.code
8799${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8800.endd
8801yields &"42"&, and
8802.code
8803${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8804.endd
8805yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8806empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8807
8808
8809.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8810.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8811.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8812.vindex "&$item$&"
8813After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8814default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8815in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8816evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8817item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8818separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8819input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8820.code
8821${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8822.endd
8823yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8824to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8825
8826
8827.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8828.cindex "hash function" "textual"
8829.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8830This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8831early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8832(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8833
8834The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8835<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8836<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8837use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8838.code
8839${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8840.endd
8841The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8842or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8843Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8844function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8845first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8846.code
8847abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8848.endd
8849If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8850letters appear. For example:
8851.display
8852&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8853&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8854&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8855.endd
8856
8857.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8858 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8859 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8860 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8861 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8862 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8863.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8864.vindex "&$header_$&"
8865.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8866.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8867.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8868.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8869.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8870Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8871.code
8872$header_reply-to:
8873.endd
8874The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8875internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8876lines) may be present.
8877
8878The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8879the data in the header line is interpreted.
8880
8881.ilist
8882.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8883&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8884processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8885
8886.next
8887.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8888&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8889or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8890character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8891&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8892.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8893produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8894what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8895
8896.next
8897&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8898standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8899be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8900returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8901&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8902a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8903.endlist ilist
8904
8905In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8906command of the following form:
8907.code
8908headers charset "UTF-8"
8909.endd
8910This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8911subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8912character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8913option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8914value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8915ISO-8859-1.
8916
8917Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8918any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8919&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8920if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8921
8922Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8923this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8924message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8925filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8926router or transport are not accessible.
8927
8928For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8929before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8930message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8931are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8932point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8933by earlier ACLs are visible.
8934
8935Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8936following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8937this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8938white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8939If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8940replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8941&<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8942
8943If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8944to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8945&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8946each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8947newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8948newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8949those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8950junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8951
8952
8953.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8954.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8955.cindex &%hmac%&
8956This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8957shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8958RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8959&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8960cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8961or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8962present. For example:
8963.code
8964${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8965.endd
8966For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8967produces:
8968.code
8969dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8970.endd
8971As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8972an Exim configuration:
8973.code
8974SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8975.endd
8976In a router or a transport you could then have:
8977.code
8978headers_add = \
8979 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8980 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8981 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8982.endd
8983Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8984&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8985this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8986host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8987using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8988&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8989
8990
8991.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8992.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8993.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8994If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8995item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8996in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8997.code
8998${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8999.endd
9000The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9001true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9002be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9003case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9004&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9005
9006If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9007is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9008cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9009.code
9010condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9011.endd
9012you can use
9013.code
9014condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9015.endd
9016
9017.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9018.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9019.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9020The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9021strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9022you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9023change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9024some of the braces:
9025.code
9026${length_<n>:<string>}
9027.endd
9028The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9029of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9030&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9031
9032
9033.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9034 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9035This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9036described in the next item.
9037
9038.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9039 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9040.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9041.cindex "file" "lookups"
9042.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9043The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9044discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9045lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9046<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9047
9048If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9049a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9050other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9051in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9052out by the system administrator.
9053
9054.vindex "&$value$&"
9055If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9056During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9057lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9058level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9059the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9060string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9061lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9062original lookup fails.
9063
9064If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9065data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9066expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9067the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9068appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9069to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9070{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9071successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9072
9073For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9074search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9075type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9076&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9077
9078.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9079If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9080and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9081They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9082
9083This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9084.code
9085${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9086.endd
9087This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9088the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9089.code
9090${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9091 {$value}fail}
9092.endd
9093
9094
9095.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9096.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9097.vindex "&$item$&"
9098After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9099default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9100in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9101expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9102for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9103setting is not included in the output. For example:
9104.code
9105${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9106.endd
9107expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9108value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9109and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9110
9111.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9112.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9113.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9114The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9115<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9116if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9117can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9118.code
9119${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9120.endd
9121The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9122the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9123processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9124slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9125example,
9126.code
9127${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9128.endd
9129returns the string &"6/33"&.
9130
9131
9132
9133.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9134.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9135.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9136This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9137interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9138expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9139additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9140name of the subroutine, is nine.
9141
9142The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9143the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9144way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9145Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9146return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9147not its contents.
9148
9149If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9150with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9151Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9152
9153The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9154out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9155
9156
9157.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9158.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9159The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9160keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9161it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9162to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9163as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9164and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9165
9166.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9167 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9168.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9169This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9170checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9171yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9172empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9173prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9174version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9175variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9176
9177These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9178retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9179against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9180which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9181
9182The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9183string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9184result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9185whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9186is the expansion of the third argument.
9187
9188All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9189However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9190For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9191
9192.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9193.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9194.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9195.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9196The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9197then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9198the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9199newlines are left in the string.
9200String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9201you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9202the string expansion fails.
9203
9204The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9205locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9206
9207
9208
9209.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9210 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9211.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9212.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9213.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9214This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9215string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9216examples:
9217.code
9218${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9219${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9220.endd
9221For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9222For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9223a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9224number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9225optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9226example:
9227.code
9228${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9229.endd
9230Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9231one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9232both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9233(unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9234is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9235extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9236.code
9237${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9238.endd
9239A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9240that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9241turns them into spaces:
9242.code
9243${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9244.endd
9245As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9246happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9247addition, the following errors can occur:
9248
9249.ilist
9250Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9251.next
9252Failure to connect the socket;
9253.next
9254Failure to write the request string;
9255.next
9256Timeout on reading from the socket.
9257.endlist
9258
9259By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9260you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9261errors occurs. For example:
9262.code
9263${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9264 {socket failure}}
9265.endd
9266You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9267expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9268and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9269if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9270non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9271
9272The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9273locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9274
9275
9276.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9277.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9278.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9279.vindex "&$value$&"
9280.vindex "&$item$&"
9281This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9282<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9283separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9284assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9285list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9286them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9287iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9288added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9289number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9290.code
9291${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9292.endd
9293The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9294can be found:
9295.code
9296${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9297.endd
9298At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9299restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9300expansion items.
9301
9302.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9303This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9304expansion item above.
9305
9306.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9307 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9308.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9309.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9310The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9311command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9312other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9313a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9314
9315The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9316and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9317.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9318.vindex "&$value$&"
9319If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9320and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9321from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9322<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9323expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9324&$value$&.
9325
9326If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9327can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9328command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9329of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9330
9331.vindex "&$runrc$&"
9332The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9333remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9334.code
9335if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9336 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9337 ...
9338endif
9339.endd
9340If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9341the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9342commands.
9343
9344&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9345option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9346testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9347by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9348
9349The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9350out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9351
9352
9353.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9354.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9355.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9356This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9357option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9358modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9359into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9360a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9361.code
9362${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9363.endd
9364yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9365if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9366substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9367.code
9368${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9369.endd
9370yields &"defabc"&, and
9371.code
9372${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9373.endd
9374yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9375the regular expression from string expansion.
9376
9377
9378
9379.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9380.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9381.cindex "substring extraction"
9382.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9383The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9384<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9385if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9386can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9387.code
9388${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9389.endd
9390The second number is optional (in both notations).
9391If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9392omitted.
9393
9394The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9395&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9396length required. For example
9397.code
9398${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9399.endd
9400If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9401null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9402length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9403given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9404
9405The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9406from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9407second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9408.code
9409${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9410.endd
9411yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9412length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9413the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9414.code
9415${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9416.endd
9417yields an empty string, but
9418.code
9419${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9420.endd
9421yields &"1"&.
9422
9423When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9424is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9425string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9426no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9427.code
9428${substr_-1:abcde}
9429${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9430.endd
9431yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9432
9433
9434
9435.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9436 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9437.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9438.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9439This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9440argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9441matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9442replacement list. For example
9443.code
9444${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9445.endd
9446yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9447last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9448last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9449place.
9450.endlist
9451
9452
9453
9454.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9455.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9456For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9457the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9458The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9459following operations can be performed:
9460
9461.vlist
9462.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9463.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9464.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9465The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9466header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9467not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9468
9469
9470.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9471.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9472.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9473The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
94742822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9475operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9476result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9477doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9478Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9479
9480It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9481separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9482character. For example:
9483.code
9484${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9485.endd
9486expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9487expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9488address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9489processing lists.
9490
9491
9492.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9493.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9494.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9495The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9496base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9497the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9498its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9499names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9500be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9501
9502.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9503.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9504.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9505The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9506environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9507identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9508string.
9509
9510.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9511.cindex "domain" "extraction"
9512.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9513The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9514from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9515
9516
9517.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9518.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9519.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9520If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9521escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9522significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9523is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9524
9525
9526.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9527.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9528.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9529.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9530These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9531expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9532arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9533logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9534integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9535C programming language):
9536.table2 70pt 300pt
9537.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9538.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9539.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9540.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9541.irow "" "and (&&)"
9542.irow "" "xor (^)"
9543.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9544.endtable
9545Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9546space is permitted before or after operators.
9547
9548For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9549hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9550decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9551permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9552times, which often do have leading zeros.
9553
9554A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9555or 1024*1024*1024,
9556respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9557a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9558
9559.display
9560&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9561&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9562&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9563&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9564&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9565&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9566&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9567&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9568&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9569&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9570&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9571.endd
9572
9573As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9574.code
9575deny message = Too many bad recipients
9576 condition = \
9577 ${if and { \
9578 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9579 { \
9580 < \
9581 {$recipients_count} \
9582 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9583 } \
9584 }{yes}{no}}
9585.endd
9586The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9587fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9588
9589
9590.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9591.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9592The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9593example,
9594.code
9595${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9596.endd
9597first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9598and then re-expands what it has found.
9599
9600
9601.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9602.cindex "Unicode"
9603.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9604.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9605.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9606The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9607email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9608to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9609UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9610converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9611the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9612
9613Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9614ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9615For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9616way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9617characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9618single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9619translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9620
9621
9622.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9623.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9624.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9625The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9626be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9627change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9628.code
9629${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9630.endd
9631See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9632abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9633
9634
9635
9636.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9637.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9638.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9639.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9640This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9641be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9642
9643
9644.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9645.cindex "case forcing in strings"
9646.cindex "string" "case forcing"
9647.cindex "lower casing"
9648.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9649.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9650This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9651.code
9652${lc:$local_part}
9653.endd
9654
9655.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9656.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9657.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9658The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9659can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9660changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9661.code
9662${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9663.endd
9664See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9665&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9666when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9667
9668
9669.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9670.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9671.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9672The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9673extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9674empty.
9675
9676
9677.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9678.cindex "masked IP address"
9679.cindex "IP address" "masking"
9680.cindex "CIDR notation"
9681.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9682.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9683If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9684slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9685expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9686masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9687the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9688.code
9689${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9690.endd
9691returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9692be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9693address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9694terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9695.code
9696${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9697.endd
9698returns the string
9699.code
97003ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9701.endd
9702Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9703
9704
9705.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9706.cindex "MD5 hash"
9707.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9708.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9709The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9710as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9711
9712
9713.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9714.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9715.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9716The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9717that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9718strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9719.code
9720${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9721.endd
9722See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9723
9724
9725.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9726.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9727.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9728.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9729The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9730is an empty string or
9731contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9732Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9733Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9734respectively For example,
9735.code
9736${quote:ab"*"cd}
9737.endd
9738becomes
9739.code
9740"ab\"*\"cd"
9741.endd
9742The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9743variable or a message header.
9744
9745.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9746.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9747This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9748required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9749example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9750If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9751(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9752
9753
9754.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9755.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9756This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9757query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9758the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9759.code
9760${quote_ldap:two * two}
9761.endd
9762returns
9763.code
9764two%20%5C2A%20two
9765.endd
9766For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9767yields an unchanged string.
9768
9769
9770.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9771.cindex "random number"
9772This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9773supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9774on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9775If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9776.new
9777If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
9778for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
9779.wen
9780Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9781srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9782random().
9783
9784
9785.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9786.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9787This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9788dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9789dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9790for DNS. For example,
9791.code
9792${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
9793${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9794.endd
9795returns
9796.code
97974.2.0.192
97983.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9799.endd
9800
9801
9802.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9803.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9804.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9805.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9806This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9807encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9808assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9809&%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9810contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9811characters
9812.code
9813? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9814.endd
9815it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9816string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9817characters.
9818
9819
9820.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9821.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9822.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9823.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9824This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9825bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9826character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9827not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9828
9829&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9830access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9831to use this operator as well.
9832
9833
9834
9835.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9836.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9837.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9838.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9839The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9840characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9841variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9842
9843
9844.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9845.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9846.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9847.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9848The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9849it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9850
9851
9852.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9853.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9854.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9855.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9856The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9857function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9858expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9859series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9860except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9861a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
986210-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9863&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9864can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9865
9866The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9867the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9868systems for files larger than 2GB.
9869
9870.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9871.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9872.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9873.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9874This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9875
9876
9877
9878.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9879.cindex "expansion" "string length"
9880.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9881.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9882The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9883decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9884
9885
9886.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9887.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9888.cindex "substring extraction"
9889.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9890The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9891can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9892that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9893.code
9894${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9895.endd
9896See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9897abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9898
9899.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9900.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9901.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9902This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9903seconds.
9904
9905.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9906.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9907.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9908The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9909represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9910number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9911&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
9912
9913.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9914.cindex "case forcing in strings"
9915.cindex "string" "case forcing"
9916.cindex "upper casing"
9917.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9918.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9919This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9920.endlist
9921
9922
9923
9924
9925
9926
9927.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9928.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9929The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9930while expanding strings:
9931
9932.vlist
9933.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9934.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9935.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9936Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9937condition.
9938
9939.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9940.cindex "numeric comparison"
9941.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9942There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9943are:
9944.display
9945&`= `& equal
9946&`== `& equal
9947&`> `& greater
9948&`>= `& greater or equal
9949&`< `& less
9950&`<= `& less or equal
9951.endd
9952For example:
9953.code
9954${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9955.endd
9956Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9957two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9958optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9959lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9960As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9961zero.
9962
9963In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
9964<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
996510M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
9966
9967
9968.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9969.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9970.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9971This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9972a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9973(case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9974false if zero.
9975An empty string is treated as false.
9976Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
9977thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
9978All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9979
9980When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9981make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9982For example:
9983.code
9984${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9985.endd
9986
9987
9988.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9989.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9990.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
9991Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
9992where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
9993loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
9994and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
9995true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9996
9997Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
9998
9999.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10000.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10001.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10002.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10003This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10004authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10005necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10006included in the binary.
10007
10008The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10009compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10010be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10011encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10012does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10013&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10014Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10015string in LDAP form is:
10016.code
10017{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10018.endd
10019If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10020be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10021.code
10022${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10023.endd
10024The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10025supported:
10026
10027.ilist
10028.cindex "MD5 hash"
10029.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10030&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10031printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10032length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10033(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10034hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10035comparison fails.
10036
10037.next
10038.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10039&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10040printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10041length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10042If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10043SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10044
10045.next
10046.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10047&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10048only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10049systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10050whatever its length.
10051
10052.next
10053.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10054&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10055use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10056modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10057.endlist
10058Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10059&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10060HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10061operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10062the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10063support &[crypt16()]&.
10064
10065Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10066it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10067turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10068&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10069algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10070
10071However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10072functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10073Exim is seen as very low priority.
10074
10075If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10076comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10077determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10078default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10079function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10080
10081.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10082.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10083.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10084The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10085variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10086variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10087.code
10088${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10089.endd
10090Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10091variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10092
10093.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10094 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10095.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10096This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10097exists in the message. For example,
10098.code
10099${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10100.endd
10101&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10102the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10103
10104.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10105 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10106.cindex "string" "comparison"
10107.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10108.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10109.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10110The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10111resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10112letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10113
10114.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10115.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10116.cindex "file" "existence test"
10117.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10118The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10119condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10120is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10121users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10122
10123.vitem &*first_delivery*&
10124.cindex "delivery" "first"
10125.cindex "first delivery"
10126.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10127.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10128This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10129attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10130
10131
10132.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10133 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10134.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10135.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10136.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10137.vindex "&$item$&"
10138These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10139the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10140the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10141be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10142condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10143.ilist
10144For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10145the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10146items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10147.next
10148For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10149and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10150all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10151.endlist
10152Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10153items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10154that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10155list separator is changed to a comma:
10156.code
10157${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10158.endd
10159The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10160being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10161
10162
10163.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10164 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10165.cindex "string" "comparison"
10166.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10167.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10168.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10169The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10170string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10171comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10172case-independent.
10173
10174.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10175 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10176.cindex "string" "comparison"
10177.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10178.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10179.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10180The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10181string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10182includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10183case-independent.
10184
10185.new
10186.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10187 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10188.cindex "string" "comparison"
10189.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10190Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10191strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10192is true.
10193
10194These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10195Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10196.code
10197${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10198 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10199${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10200 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10201.endd
10202.wen
10203
10204.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10205 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10206 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10207.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10208.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10209.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10210.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10211.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10212The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10213an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10214&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10215
10216For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10217which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10218colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10219hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10220component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10221
10222&*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10223values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10224check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10225host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10226.code
10227${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10228.endd
10229to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10230
10231.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10232.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10233.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10234.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10235This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10236&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10237queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10238query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10239password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10240server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10241with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10242will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10243of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10244this can be used.
10245
10246
10247.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10248 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10249.cindex "string" "comparison"
10250.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10251.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10252.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10253The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10254string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10255comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10256case-independent.
10257
10258.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10259 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10260.cindex "string" "comparison"
10261.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10262.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10263.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10264The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10265string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10266includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10267case-independent.
10268
10269
10270.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10271.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10272.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10273.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10274The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10275expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10276regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10277escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10278(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10279premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10280&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10281For example,
10282.code
10283${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10284.endd
10285If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10286backslashes is also required.
10287
10288The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10289The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10290metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10291and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10292the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10293metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10294
10295.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10296At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10297substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10298succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10299will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10300of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10301combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10302variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10303
10304.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10305.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10306See &*match_local_part*&.
10307
10308.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10309.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10310See &*match_local_part*&.
10311
10312.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10313.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10314.new
10315This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10316be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10317address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10318list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10319.wen
10320.code
10321${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10322.endd
10323The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10324
10325.ilist
10326An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10327.next
10328A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10329.next
10330An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10331useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10332in a single test such as
10333. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10334. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10335. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10336. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10337.code
10338 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10339.endd
10340where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10341.next
10342The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10343.next
10344Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10345even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10346address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10347&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10348masks. For example:
10349.code
10350 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10351.endd
10352It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10353do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10354address mask, for example:
10355.code
10356 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10357.endd
10358However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10359just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10360.code
10361 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10362.endd
10363.endlist ilist
10364
10365.new
10366Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10367Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10368.wen
10369
10370Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10371
10372.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10373.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10374.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10375.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10376.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10377This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10378possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10379condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10380example is:
10381.code
10382${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10383.endd
10384In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10385list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10386expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10387Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10388.code
10389${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10390.endd
10391.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10392For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10393item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10394have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10395caselessly.
10396
10397.new
10398Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10399Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10400.wen
10401
10402&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10403hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10404how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10405matched using &%match_ip%&.
10406
10407.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10408.cindex "PAM authentication"
10409.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10410.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10411.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10412.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10413&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10414(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10415available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10416distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10417the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10418.code
10419SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10420.endd
10421in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10422in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10423
10424The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10425colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10426The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10427taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10428The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10429from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10430request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10431
10432There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10433characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10434separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10435item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10436of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10437.code
10438server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10439.endd
10440For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10441.code
10442server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10443.endd
10444In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10445running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10446messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10447A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10448Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10449The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10450to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10451group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10452
10453
10454.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10455.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10456.cindex "Cyrus"
10457.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10458.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10459This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10460This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10461that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10462deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10463
10464The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10465the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10466building Exim. For example:
10467.code
10468CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10469.endd
10470You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10471the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10472from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10473access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10474
10475The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10476password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10477configuration, you might have this:
10478.code
10479server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10480.endd
10481Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10482.code
10483server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10484.endd
10485.vitem &*queue_running*&
10486.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10487.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10488.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10489This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10490initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10491
10492
10493.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10494.cindex "Radius"
10495.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10496.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10497Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10498set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10499the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10500support.
10501
10502With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10503library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10504this library, you need to set
10505.code
10506RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10507.endd
10508in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10509&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10510.code
10511RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10512.endd
10513in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10514You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10515Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10516
10517The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10518Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10519the authentication is successful. For example:
10520.code
10521server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10522.endd
10523
10524
10525.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10526 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10527.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10528.cindex "Cyrus"
10529.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10530.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10531This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10532daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10533Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10534by a process that is not running as root.
10535
10536The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10537the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10538building Exim. For example:
10539.code
10540CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10541.endd
10542You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10543the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10544from the Cyrus SASL library.
10545
10546Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10547two are mandatory. For example:
10548.code
10549server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10550.endd
10551The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10552in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10553realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10554.endlist vlist
10555
10556
10557
10558.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10559.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10560Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10561and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10562conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10563sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10564the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10565
10566
10567.vlist
10568.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10569.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10570.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10571The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10572any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10573For example,
10574.code
10575${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10576.endd
10577When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10578evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10579numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10580
10581.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10582.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10583.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10584The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10585all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10586sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10587the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10588parsed but not evaluated.
10589.endlist
10590.ecindex IIDexpcond
10591
10592
10593
10594
10595.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10596.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10597This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10598of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10599support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10600
10601.vlist
10602.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10603.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10604When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10605captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10606processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10607However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10608values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10609variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10610precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10611Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10612matching condition.
10613
10614.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10615Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10616can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10617long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10618example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10619variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10620used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10621same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10622with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10623during subsequent delivery.
10624
10625.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10626These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10627are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10628received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10629message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10630also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10631message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10632and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10633delivery.
10634
10635.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10636.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10637After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10638message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10639be preserved by coding like this:
10640.code
10641warn !verify = sender
10642 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10643.endd
10644You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10645&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10646failure.
10647
10648.vitem &$address_data$&
10649.vindex "&$address_data$&"
10650This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10651value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10652and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10653the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10654for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10655user filter files.
10656
10657If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10658a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10659conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10660to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10661of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10662from the child's routing.
10663
10664If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10665sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10666&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10667address.
10668
10669In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10670after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10671these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10672
10673.vitem &$address_file$&
10674.vindex "&$address_file$&"
10675When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10676to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10677is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10678default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10679.code
10680/home/r2d2/savemail
10681.endd
10682then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10683contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10684.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10685For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10686then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10687to the relevant file.
10688
10689.vitem &$address_pipe$&
10690.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10691When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10692this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10693
10694.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10695.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10696These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10697&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10698
10699.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10700.cindex "authentication" "id"
10701.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10702When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10703preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10704&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10705user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10706in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10707&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10708When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10709the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10710process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10711command line option.
10712
10713
10714
10715
10716.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10717.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10718.cindex "authentication" "sender"
10719.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10720.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10721When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10722SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10723described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10724&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10725available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10726sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10727
10728.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10729When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10730value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10731name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10732can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10733
10734
10735.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10736.cindex "authentication" "failure"
10737.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10738This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10739command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10740possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10741(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10742&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10743is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10744negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10745an undefined mechanism.
10746
10747.new
10748.vitem &$av_failed$&
10749.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10750This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10751extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10752problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10753the ACL malware condition.
10754.wen
10755
10756.vitem &$body_linecount$&
10757.cindex "message body" "line count"
10758.cindex "body of message" "line count"
10759.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10760When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10761number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10762
10763.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10764.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10765.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10766.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10767.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10768When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10769number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10770
10771.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10772.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10773This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10774it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10775chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10776
10777.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10778.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10779This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10780up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10781file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10782
10783.vitem &$caller_gid$&
10784.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10785.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10786The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10787not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10788&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10789incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10790
10791.vitem &$caller_uid$&
10792.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10793.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10794The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10795not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10796&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10797incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10798
10799.vitem &$compile_date$&
10800.vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10801The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10802
10803.vitem &$compile_number$&
10804.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10805The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10806of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10807compilations of the same version of the program.
10808
10809.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10810.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10811This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10812the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10813details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10814
10815.vitem &$demime_reason$&
10816.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10817This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10818content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10819see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10820
10821.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10822 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10823 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10824 &$dnslist_value$&
10825.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10826.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10827.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10828.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10829.cindex "black list (DNS)"
10830When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10831the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10832looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10833main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10834
10835.vitem &$domain$&
10836.vindex "&$domain$&"
10837When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10838contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10839case for &$domain$&.
10840
10841Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10842&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10843is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10844message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10845
10846When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10847RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10848have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10849at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10850the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10851which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10852
10853.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10854At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10855set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10856
10857The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10858
10859.ilist
10860When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10861the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10862&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10863normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10864is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10865&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10866the &(smtp)& transport.
10867
10868.next
10869When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10870&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10871it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10872rewrite domains by file lookup.
10873
10874.next
10875With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10876&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10877a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10878is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10879that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10880recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10881
10882.next
10883.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10884.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10885When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10886the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10887.endlist
10888
10889
10890.vitem &$domain_data$&
10891.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10892When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10893means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10894of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10895address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10896transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10897used.
10898
10899&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10900domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10901the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10902to nothing.
10903
10904.vitem &$exim_gid$&
10905.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10906This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10907
10908.vitem &$exim_path$&
10909.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10910This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10911
10912.vitem &$exim_uid$&
10913.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10914This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10915
10916.vitem &$found_extension$&
10917.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10918This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10919content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10920see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10921
10922.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10923This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10924inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10925be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10926characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10927
10928.vitem &$home$&
10929.vindex "&$home$&"
10930When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10931directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10932means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10933explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10934by a setting on the transport itself.
10935
10936When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10937of the environment variable HOME.
10938
10939.vitem &$host$&
10940.vindex "&$host$&"
10941If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10942list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10943to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10944to local and remote transports.
10945
10946.cindex "transport" "filter"
10947.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10948For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10949&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10950particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10951using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10952&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10953is connected.
10954
10955When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10956&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10957client is connected.
10958
10959
10960.vitem &$host_address$&
10961.vindex "&$host_address$&"
10962This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10963for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10964when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10965
10966.vitem &$host_data$&
10967.vindex "&$host_data$&"
10968If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10969result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10970allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10971.code
10972deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10973message = $host_data
10974.endd
10975.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10976.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10977.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10978This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10979message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10980name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10981variables is set to &"1"&.
10982
10983.ilist
10984If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10985succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10986
10987.next
10988If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10989tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10990lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10991.endlist ilist
10992
10993Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10994single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10995names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10996is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10997&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10998IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10999sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11000lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11001the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11002&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11003
11004.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11005.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11006See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11007
11008
11009.vitem &$inode$&
11010.vindex "&$inode$&"
11011The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11012option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11013of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11014a unique name for the file.
11015
11016.vitem &$interface_address$&
11017.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11018This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11019
11020.vitem &$interface_port$&
11021.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11022This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11023
11024.vitem &$item$&
11025.vindex "&$item$&"
11026This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11027conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11028&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11029empty.
11030
11031.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11032.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11033This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11034contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11035lookup.
11036
11037.vitem &$load_average$&
11038.vindex "&$load_average$&"
11039This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11040is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11041variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11042
11043.vitem &$local_part$&
11044.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11045When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11046variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11047delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11048session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11049
11050Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11051&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11052&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11053because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11054once.
11055
11056.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11057.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11058If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11059value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11060any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11061&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11062
11063When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11064result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11065the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11066&$address_pipe$&).
11067
11068When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11069local part of the recipient address.
11070
11071When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11072&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11073it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11074
11075In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11076the addresses
11077.code
11078"abc:xyz"@test.example
11079abc\:xyz@test.example
11080.endd
11081the value of &$local_part$& is
11082.code
11083abc:xyz
11084.endd
11085If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11086inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11087have:
11088.code
11089data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11090.endd
11091&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11092to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11093&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11094
11095.vitem &$local_part_data$&
11096.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11097When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11098lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11099router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11100to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11101handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11102
11103&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11104matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11105available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11106variable expands to nothing.
11107
11108.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11109.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11110When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11111specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11112variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11113
11114.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11115.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11116When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11117specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11118variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11119
11120.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11121.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11122This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11123a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11124
11125.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11126.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11127See &$local_user_uid$&.
11128
11129.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11130.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11131This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11132&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11133are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11134and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11135router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11136are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11137
11138.vitem &$localhost_number$&
11139.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11140This contains the expanded value of the
11141&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11142been read.
11143
11144.vitem &$log_inodes$&
11145.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11146The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11147log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11148referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11149the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11150
11151.vitem &$log_space$&
11152.vindex "&$log_space$&"
11153The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11154partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11155whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11156ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11157the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11158
11159
11160.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11161.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11162This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11163&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11164&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11165contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11166without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11167variable is empty.
11168
11169.vitem &$malware_name$&
11170.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11171This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11172content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11173when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11174
11175.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11176.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11177.cindex "maximum" "line length"
11178.cindex "line length" "maximum"
11179This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11180received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11181character(s).
11182
11183.vitem &$message_age$&
11184.cindex "message" "age of"
11185.vindex "&$message_age$&"
11186This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11187of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11188delivery attempt.
11189
11190.vitem &$message_body$&
11191.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11192.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11193.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11194.vindex "&$message_body$&"
11195.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11196This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11197being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11198number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11199&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11200
11201.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11202By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11203easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11204this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11205zeros are always converted into spaces.
11206
11207.vitem &$message_body_end$&
11208.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11209.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11210.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11211This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11212body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11213&$message_body$&.
11214
11215.vitem &$message_body_size$&
11216.cindex "body of message" "size"
11217.cindex "message body" "size"
11218.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11219When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11220in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11221separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11222also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11223
11224.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11225.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11226When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11227unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11228An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11229received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11230line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11231&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11232
11233.vitem &$message_headers$&
11234.vindex &$message_headers$&
11235This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11236is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11237lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11238same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11239
11240.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11241.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11242This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11243contents of header lines is done.
11244
11245.vitem &$message_id$&
11246This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11247
11248.vitem &$message_linecount$&
11249.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11250This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11251message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11252During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11253number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11254routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11255&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11256lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11257from the body is not counted.
11258
11259As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11260appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11261&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11262file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11263header and the body).
11264
11265Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11266.code
11267deny message = Too many lines in message header
11268 condition = \
11269 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11270.endd
11271In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11272message has not yet been received.
11273
11274.vitem &$message_size$&
11275.cindex "size" "of message"
11276.cindex "message" "size"
11277.vindex "&$message_size$&"
11278When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11279most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11280message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11281deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11282expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11283doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11284precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11285&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11286
11287.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11288While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11289contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11290value may not, of course, be truthful.
11291
11292.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11293A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11294available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11295details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11296
11297.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11298These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11299of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11300
11301.vitem &$original_domain$&
11302.vindex "&$domain$&"
11303.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11304When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11305same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11306generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11307variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11308differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11309aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11310single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11311
11312If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11313filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11314part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11315
11316.vitem &$original_local_part$&
11317.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11318.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11319When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11320same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11321local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11322part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11323filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11324the original address.
11325
11326If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11327case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11328This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11329one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11330delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11331
11332If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11333filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11334part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11335
11336.vitem &$originator_gid$&
11337.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11338.cindex "sender" "gid"
11339.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11340.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11341This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11342message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11343gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11344normally the gid of the Exim user.
11345
11346.vitem &$originator_uid$&
11347.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11348.cindex "sender" "uid"
11349.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11350.vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11351The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11352messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11353For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11354user.
11355
11356.vitem &$parent_domain$&
11357.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11358This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11359above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11360
11361.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11362.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11363This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11364(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11365
11366.vitem &$pid$&
11367.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11368.vindex "&$pid$&"
11369This variable contains the current process id.
11370
11371.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11372.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11373.cindex "transport" "filter"
11374.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11375This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11376&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11377&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11378(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11379It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11380variable"& error if encountered.
11381
11382.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11383.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11384This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11385configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11386a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11387&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11388qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11389
11390
11391.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11392This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11393which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11394&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11395
11396.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11397This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11398which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11399&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11400
11401.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11402This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11403which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11404&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11405
11406.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11407.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11408The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11409
11410.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11411.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11412The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11413or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11414
11415.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11416.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11417When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11418RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11419RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11420
11421.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11422.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11423.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11424When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11425RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11426temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11427
11428.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11429.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11430When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11431RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11432permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11433
11434.vitem &$received_count$&
11435.vindex "&$received_count$&"
11436This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11437including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11438is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11439delivering.
11440
11441.vitem &$received_for$&
11442.vindex "&$received_for$&"
11443If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11444variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11445built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11446the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11447
11448.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11449.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11450As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11451variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11452is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11453&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11454the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11455option.
11456
11457As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11458could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11459on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11460values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11461messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11462time.
11463
11464&*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11465the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11466&(smtp)& transport).
11467
11468.vitem &$received_port$&
11469.vindex "&$received_port$&"
11470See &$received_ip_address$&.
11471
11472.vitem &$received_protocol$&
11473.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11474When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11475protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11476by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11477&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11478(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11479is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11480connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11481
11482Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11483automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11484&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11485encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11486where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11487STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11488
11489The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11490messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11491identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11492
11493.vitem &$received_time$&
11494.vindex "&$received_time$&"
11495This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11496as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11497
11498.vitem &$recipient_data$&
11499.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11500This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11501condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11502until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11503.display
11504&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11505&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11506.endd
11507&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11508method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11509The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11510expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11511
11512.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11513.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11514In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11515information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11516
11517.ilist
11518&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11519was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11520
11521.next
11522&"route"&: Routing failed.
11523
11524.next
11525&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11526or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11527MAIL).
11528
11529.next
11530&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11531.next
11532
11533&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11534.endlist
11535
11536The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11537rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11538
11539.vitem &$recipients$&
11540.vindex "&$recipients$&"
11541This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11542a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11543is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11544unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11545cases:
11546
11547.olist
11548In a system filter file.
11549.next
11550In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11551is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11552&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11553&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11554.next
11555From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11556.endlist
11557
11558
11559.vitem &$recipients_count$&
11560.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11561When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11562envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11563from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11564increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11565
11566
11567.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11568.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11569This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11570&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11571
11572
11573.vitem &$reply_address$&
11574.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11575When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11576&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11577contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11578white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11579decoding or character code translation takes place.
11580
11581.vitem &$return_path$&
11582.vindex "&$return_path$&"
11583When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11584the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11585in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11586same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11587mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11588for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11589address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11590that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11591the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11592envelope sender.
11593
11594.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11595.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11596This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11597
11598.vitem &$runrc$&
11599.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11600.vindex "&$runrc$&"
11601This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11602&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11603assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11604preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11605reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11606another.
11607
11608.vitem &$self_hostname$&
11609.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11610.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11611When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11612local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11613One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11614happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11615original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11616
11617.vitem &$sender_address$&
11618.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11619When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11620that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11621is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11622value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11623
11624.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11625.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11626.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11627If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11628sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11629distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11630after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11631longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11632
11633.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11634.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11635The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11636
11637.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11638.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11639The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11640
11641.vitem &$sender_data$&
11642.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11643This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11644in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11645value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11646this:
11647.display
11648&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11649&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11650.endd
11651&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11652method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11653The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11654expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11655
11656.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11657.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11658When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11659name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11660brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11661enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11662issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11663looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11664&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11665start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11666verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11667the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11668the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11669
11670.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11671.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11672When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11673command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11674set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11675the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11676
11677.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11678.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11679When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11680host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11681
11682.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11683.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11684This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11685driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11686received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11687&$authenticated_id$&.
11688
11689.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11690.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11691When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11692host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11693other means, this variable is empty.
11694
11695.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11696If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11697&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11698A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11699via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11700any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11701&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11702
11703.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11704However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11705DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11706&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11707
11708Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11709host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11710in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11711is set to &"1"&.
11712
11713Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11714maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11715these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11716following are true:
11717
11718.ilist
11719A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11720.next
11721The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11722configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11723to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11724.next
11725Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11726that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11727&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11728.next
11729The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11730In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11731EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11732.next
11733The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11734domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11735. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11736. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11737.code
11738 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11739.endd
11740which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11741IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11742.endlist
11743
11744
11745.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11746.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11747When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11748number that was used on the remote host.
11749
11750.vitem &$sender_ident$&
11751.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11752When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11753identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11754been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11755called Exim.
11756
11757.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11758A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11759&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11760&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11761
11762.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11763.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11764.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11765.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11766This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11767either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11768there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11769there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11770the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11771followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11772first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11773the parentheses.
11774
11775There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11776was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11777address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11778all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11779into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11780
11781.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11782.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11783In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11784about the failure. The details are the same as for
11785&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11786
11787.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11788.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11789This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11790been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11791used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11792on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11793connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11794
11795.vitem &$sending_port$&
11796.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11797This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11798been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11799connections, see &$received_port$&.
11800
11801.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11802.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11803During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11804host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11805&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11806value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11807
11808.vitem &$smtp_command$&
11809.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11810During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11811entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11812the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11813.code
11814MAIL FROM:<>
11815MAIL FROM: <>
11816.endd
11817For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11818command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11819rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11820the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11821
11822.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11823.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11824.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11825While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11826argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11827space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11828somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11829
11830.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11831.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11832This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11833daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11834in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11835connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11836the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11837never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11838there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11839single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11840daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11841
11842.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11843These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11844that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11845filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11846example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11847message is junk mail.
11848
11849.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11850A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11851is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11852&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11853
11854
11855.vitem &$spool_directory$&
11856.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11857The name of Exim's spool directory.
11858
11859.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11860.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11861The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11862being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11863If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11864is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11865
11866.vitem &$spool_space$&
11867.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11868The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11869Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11870variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11871find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11872value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11873megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11874.code
11875condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11876.endd
11877See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11878
11879
11880.vitem &$thisaddress$&
11881.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11882This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11883command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11884command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11885interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11886
11887.new
11888.vitem &$tls_bits$&
11889.vindex "&$tls_bits$&"
11890Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength; the meaning of
11891this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
11892If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
11893The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
11894when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
11895.wen
11896
11897.vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11898.vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11899This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11900message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11901
11902.vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11903.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11904When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11905connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11906example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11907received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11908&$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11909non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11910
11911The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11912when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11913case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11914and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11915&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11916details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11917
11918.vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11919.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11920When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11921connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11922the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11923&$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11924value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11925deliveries.
11926
11927.new
11928.vitem &$tls_sni$&
11929.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
11930.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
11931When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
11932Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
11933If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
11934some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
11935will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
11936a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
11937used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
11938
11939The value will be retained for the lifetime of the message. During outbound
11940SMTP deliveries, it reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
11941the transport.
11942.wen
11943
11944.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11945.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11946The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11947files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11948
11949.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11950.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11951The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11952
11953.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
11954.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
11955The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11956
11957.vitem &$tod_full$&
11958.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11959A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11960+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11961positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11962values for those that are behind (west).
11963
11964.vitem &$tod_log$&
11965.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11966The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
119671995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11968
11969.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11970.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11971This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11972is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11973flag.
11974
11975.vitem &$tod_zone$&
11976.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11977This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11978-0500.
11979
11980.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11981.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11982This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11983by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11984
11985.vitem &$value$&
11986.vindex "&$value$&"
11987This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11988or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11989&*reduce*& expansion.
11990
11991.vitem &$version_number$&
11992.vindex "&$version_number$&"
11993The version number of Exim.
11994
11995.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11996.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11997This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11998delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11999
12000.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12001.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12002This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12003delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12004.endlist
12005.ecindex IIDstrexp
12006
12007
12008
12009. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12010. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12011
12012.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12013.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12014Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12015Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12016use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12017your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12018the line
12019.code
12020EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12021.endd
12022in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12023
12024
12025.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12026.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12027Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12028&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12029no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12030interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12031the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12032option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12033a newly created Perl interpreter.
12034
12035The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12036need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12037should usually be something like
12038.code
12039perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12040.endd
12041where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12042use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12043soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12044the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12045its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12046fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12047necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12048the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12049two ways:
12050
12051.ilist
12052.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12053Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12054a startup when Exim is entered.
12055.next
12056The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12057overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12058.endlist
12059
12060There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12061initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12062
12063
12064.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12065When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12066of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12067by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12068forms:
12069.code
12070${perl{foo}}
12071${perl{foo}{argument}}
12072${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12073.endd
12074which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12075arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12076with an error message of the form
12077.code
12078Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12079.endd
12080The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12081it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12082return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12083an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12084by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12085that was passed to &%die%&.
12086
12087
12088.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12089Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12090is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12091the Perl code
12092.code
12093my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12094.endd
12095makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12096Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12097&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12098
12099If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12100&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12101expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12102an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12103
12104.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12105.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12106Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12107&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12108debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12109&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12110timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12111
12112
12113.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12114.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12115You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12116Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12117before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12118SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12119is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12120error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12121avoided, but the output is lost.
12122
12123.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12124The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12125Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12126you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12127output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12128change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12129For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12130.code
12131$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12132.endd
12133Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12134example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12135include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12136as the first subroutine argument.
12137.ecindex IIDperl
12138
12139
12140. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12141. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12142
12143.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12144 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12145 "Starting the daemon"
12146.cindex "daemon" "starting"
12147.cindex "interface" "listening"
12148.cindex "network interface"
12149.cindex "interface" "network"
12150.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12151.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12152.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12153.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12154A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12155hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12156or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12157works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12158In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12159IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12160knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12161
12162.olist
12163When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12164and ports to listen on.
12165.next
12166When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12167are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12168processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12169same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12170when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12171local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12172option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12173as an error situation.
12174.next
12175When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12176for the outgoing connection.
12177.endlist
12178
12179
12180Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12181of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12182addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12183standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12184rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12185
12186In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12187interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12188options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12189chapter describes how they operate.
12190
12191When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12192actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12193
12194
12195
12196.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12197When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12198option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12199following options:
12200
12201.ilist
12202&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12203compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12204.next
12205&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12206listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12207.endlist
12208
12209The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12210described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12211it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12212colons. For example:
12213.code
12214local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12215 192.168.23.65 ; \
12216 ::1 ; \
12217 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12218.endd
12219There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12220in &%local_interfaces%&:
12221
12222.olist
12223The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12224on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12225.code
12226local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12227 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12228.endd
12229.next
12230The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12231with a colon separator, for example:
12232.code
12233local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12234 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12235.endd
12236.endlist
12237
12238When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12239default setting contains just one port:
12240.code
12241daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12242.endd
12243If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12244specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12245&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12246&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12247IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12248
12249
12250
12251.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12252The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12253as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12254case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12255instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12256default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12257.code
12258local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12259.endd
12260when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12261.code
12262local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12263.endd
12264Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12265
12266
12267
12268.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12269The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12270&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12271instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12272option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12273the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12274exim.
12275
12276The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12277changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12278contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12279&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12280items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12281replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12282.code
12283-oX 1225
12284.endd
12285overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12286whereas
12287.code
12288-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12289.endd
12290overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12291(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12292value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12293
12294
12295
12296.section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12297.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12298.cindex "smtps protocol"
12299.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12300.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12301Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12302before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12303still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12304list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12305common use of this option is expected to be
12306.code
12307tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12308.endd
12309because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12310a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12311this way when a daemon is started.
12312
12313&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12314daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12315&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12316because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12317connections via the daemon.)
12318
12319
12320
12321
12322.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12323.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12324IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12325can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12326interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12327address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12328percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12329adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12330.code
12331fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12332.endd
12333To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12334allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12335to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12336percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12337address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12338&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12339.code
12340IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12341.endd
12342is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12343Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12344instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12345function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12346&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12347
12348.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12349.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12350Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12351run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12352using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12353connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12354.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12355&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12356activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12357that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12358etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12359to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12360
12361On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12362disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12363option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12364and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12365IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12366
12367
12368
12369.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12370The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12371.code
12372daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12373local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12374.endd
12375This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12376Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12377the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12378read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12379
12380To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12381.code
12382daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12383.endd
12384(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12385.code
12386local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12387 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12388.endd
12389To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12390IPv4 loopback address only:
12391.code
12392local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12393.endd
12394To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12395.code
12396local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12397.endd
12398&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12399
12400
12401
12402.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12403The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12404whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12405addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12406treated as local.
12407
12408For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12409the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12410available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12411(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12412
12413Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12414many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12415email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12416interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12417&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12418&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12419used for listening. Consider this example:
12420.code
12421local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12422 192.168.53.235 ; \
12423 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12424
12425extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12426.endd
12427The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12428address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12429Exim is routing.
12430
12431In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12432address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12433desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12434these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12435This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12436during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12437host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12438addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12439
12440
12441
12442.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12443Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12444allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12445there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12446&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12447description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12448details.
12449
12450
12451
12452
12453. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12454. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12455
12456.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12457.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12458.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12459The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12460
12461.ilist
12462Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12463&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12464.next
12465Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12466&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12467section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12468.next
12469Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12470(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12471&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12472only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12473settings.
12474.endlist
12475
12476This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12477types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12478in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12479are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12480an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12481listed in more than one group.
12482
12483.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12484.table2
12485.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12486.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12487.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12488.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12489.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12490.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12491.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12492.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12493.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12494.endtable
12495
12496
12497.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12498.table2
12499.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12500.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12501.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12502.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12503.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12504.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12505.endtable
12506
12507
12508
12509.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12510.table2
12511.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12512.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12513.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12514.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12515.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12516.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12517.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12518.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12519.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12520.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12521.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12522.endtable
12523
12524
12525
12526.section "Logging" "SECID99"
12527.table2
12528.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12529.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12530.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12531.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12532.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12533.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12534.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12535.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12536.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12537.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12538.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12539.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12540.endtable
12541
12542
12543
12544.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12545.table2
12546.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12547.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12548.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12549.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12550.endtable
12551
12552
12553
12554.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12555.table2
12556.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12557.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12558.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12559.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12560.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12561.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12562.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12563.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12564.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12565.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12566.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12567.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12568.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12569.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12570.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12571.endtable
12572
12573
12574
12575.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12576.table2
12577.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12578.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12579.endtable
12580
12581
12582
12583.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12584.table2
12585.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12586.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12587.endtable
12588
12589
12590
12591.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12592.table2
12593.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12594.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12595.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12596.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12597.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12598.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12599.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12600.endtable
12601
12602
12603
12604.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12605.table2
12606.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12607.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12608.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12609.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12610.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12611.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12612.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12613.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12614.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12615.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12616.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12617.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12618.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12619.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12620.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12621.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12622 connection"
12623.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12624.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12625.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12626.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12627.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12628.endtable
12629
12630
12631
12632.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12633.table2
12634.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12635.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12636.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12637.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12638.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12639.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12640.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12641.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12642.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12643.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12644.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12645.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12646.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12647.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12648.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12649.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12650.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12651.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12652.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12653.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12654 words""&"
12655.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12656.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12657.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12658.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12659.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12660.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12661.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12662.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12663.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12664.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12665.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12666.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12667.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12668.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12669.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12670.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12671.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12672.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12673.endtable
12674
12675
12676
12677.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12678.table2
12679.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12680 item"
12681.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12682 item"
12683.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12684.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12685.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12686.endtable
12687
12688
12689
12690.section "TLS" "SECID108"
12691.table2
12692.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12693.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12694.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12695.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12696.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12697.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
12698.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12699.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12700.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12701.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12702.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12703.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12704.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12705.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12706.endtable
12707
12708
12709
12710.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12711.table2
12712.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12713.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12714.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12715.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12716.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12717.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12718.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12719.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12720.endtable
12721
12722
12723
12724.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12725.table2
12726.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12727.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12728.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12729.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12730.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12731.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12732.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12733.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12734.endtable
12735
12736
12737
12738
12739.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12740.table2
12741.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12742.endtable
12743
12744
12745
12746
12747
12748.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12749See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12750
12751.table2
12752.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12753.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12754.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12755.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12756.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12757.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12758.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12759.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12760.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12761.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12762.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12763.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12764.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12765.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12766 connection"
12767.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12768.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12769.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12770.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12771.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12772.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12773.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12774.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12775.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12776.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12777.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12778.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12779.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12780.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12781.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12782.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12783.endtable
12784
12785
12786
12787.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12788.table2
12789.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12790.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12791.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12792.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12793.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12794.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12795.endtable
12796
12797
12798
12799.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12800.table2
12801.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12802.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12803.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12804.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12805 words""&"
12806.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12807.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12808.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12809.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12810.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12811.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12812.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12813.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12814.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12815.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12816.endtable
12817
12818
12819
12820.section "System filter" "SECID115"
12821.table2
12822.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12823.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12824 directory"
12825.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12826.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12827.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12828.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12829.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12830.endtable
12831
12832
12833
12834.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12835.table2
12836.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12837.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12838.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12839.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12840.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12841.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12842.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
12843.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12844.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12845.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12846.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12847.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12848.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12849.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12850.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12851.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12852.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12853.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12854.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12855.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12856.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12857.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12858.endtable
12859
12860
12861
12862.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12863.table2
12864.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12865.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12866.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12867.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12868.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12869.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12870.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12871.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12872.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12873.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12874.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12875.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12876.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12877.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12878.endtable
12879
12880
12881
12882.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12883Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12884&dagger;.
12885
12886.new
12887.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
12888.cindex "8BITMIME"
12889.cindex "8-bit characters"
12890This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12891EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12892However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12893takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12894
12895Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
12896feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
12897It now defaults to true.
12898A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
12899.display
12900&url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
12901.endd
12902.wen
12903
12904.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12905.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12906.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12907This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12908read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12909further details.
12910
12911.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12912This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12913messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12914SMTP messages.
12915
12916.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12917.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12918.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12919This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12920non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12921
12922.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12923.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12924.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12925This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12926received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12927
12928.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12929.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12930This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12931See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12932
12933.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12934.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12935This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12936processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12937acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12938
12939.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12940.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12941This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12942received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12943
12944.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12945.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12946This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12947received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12948
12949.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12950.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12951.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12952This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12953command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12954
12955
12956.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12957.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12958This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12959received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12960
12961.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12962.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12963This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12964a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12965&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12966
12967.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12968.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12969This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12970extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12971section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12972
12973.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12974This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12975received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12976further details.
12977
12978.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12979.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12980This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12981received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12982
12983.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12984.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12985This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12986received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12987
12988.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12989.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12990This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12991received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12992
12993.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12994.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12995This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12996received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12997
12998.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12999.cindex "admin user"
13000This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13001current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13002colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13003programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13004admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13005not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13006To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13007
13008.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13009.cindex "domain literal"
13010If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13011email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13012format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13013has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13014
13015Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13016format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13017addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13018&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13019domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13020configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13021the local host's IP addresses.
13022
13023
13024.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13025.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13026It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13027and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13028MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13029that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13030practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13031&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13032recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13033
13034.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13035.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13036.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13037Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13038camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13039that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13040experiment if they wish.
13041
13042If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13043UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13044letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13045enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13046adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13047suitable setting is:
13048.code
13049dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13050 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13051.endd
13052Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13053.code
13054dns_check_names_pattern =
13055.endd
13056That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13057
13058
13059.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13060.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13061.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13062If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13063response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13064Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13065Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13066advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13067authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13068&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13069authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13070
13071Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13072and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13073not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13074authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13075to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13076which Exim advertises AUTH.
13077
13078.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13079If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13080is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13081option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13082.code
13083auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13084.endd
13085.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13086If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13087the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13088expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13089
13090
13091.option auto_thaw main time 0s
13092.cindex "thawing messages"
13093.cindex "unfreezing messages"
13094If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13095new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13096this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13097being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13098saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13099
13100&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13101&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13102thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13103
13104
13105.option av_scanner main string "see below"
13106This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13107It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13108.code
13109sophie:/var/run/sophie
13110.endd
13111If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13112before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13113
13114
13115.option bi_command main string unset
13116.oindex "&%-bi%&"
13117This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13118the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13119just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13120required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13121
13122
13123.option bounce_message_file main string unset
13124.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13125.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13126This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13127for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13128chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13129
13130
13131.option bounce_message_text main string unset
13132When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13133message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13134delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13135
13136.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13137.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13138This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13139bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13140causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13141value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13142message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13143error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13144point at which the error was detected are returned.
13145.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13146
13147.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13148If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13149bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13150&%bounce_return_body%&.
13151
13152
13153.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13154.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13155.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13156.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13157This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13158senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13159limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13160any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13161that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13162
13163When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13164greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13165added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13166to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13167size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13168messages.
13169
13170.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13171.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13172.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13173.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13174This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13175bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13176connection. A typical setting might be:
13177.code
13178bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13179.endd
13180which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13181.code
13182MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13183.endd
13184The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13185address.
13186
13187.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13188.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13189.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13190This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13191domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13192section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13193
13194
13195.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13196This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13197domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13198section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13199
13200
13201.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13202This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13203address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13204section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13205
13206
13207.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13208This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13209address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13210section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13211
13212
13213.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13214This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13215callout verification. The default value is
13216.code
13217$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13218.endd
13219See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13220
13221
13222.option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13223See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13224
13225
13226.option check_log_space main integer 0
13227See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13228
13229.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13230.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13231.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13232RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13233system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13234word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13235multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13236exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13237of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13238set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13239
13240
13241.option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13242See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13243
13244
13245.option check_spool_space main integer 0
13246.cindex "checking disk space"
13247.cindex "disk space, checking"
13248.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13249The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13250message is accepted.
13251
13252.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13253.vindex "&$log_space$&"
13254.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13255.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13256When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13257want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13258testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13259&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13260
13261
13262&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13263either value is greater than zero, for example:
13264.code
13265check_spool_space = 10M
13266check_spool_inodes = 100
13267.endd
13268The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13269SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13270transit.
13271
13272&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13273files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13274&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13275
13276If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13277incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13278error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13279SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13280&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13281&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13282
13283The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13284number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13285
13286For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13287failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13288it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13289
13290.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13291.cindex "port" "for daemon"
13292.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13293This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13294listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13295backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13296
13297.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13298.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13299This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13300the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13301(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13302defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13303&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13304
13305.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13306See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13307
13308.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13309.cindex "warning of delay"
13310.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13311When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13312intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13313after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13314string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13315message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13316between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13317with
13318.code
13319delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13320.endd
13321the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13322the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13323because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13324just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13325.code
13326delay_warning = 6h
13327.endd
13328messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13329a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13330.code
13331delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13332.endd
13333
13334.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13335.vindex "&$domain$&"
13336The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13337deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13338expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13339forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13340&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13341not sent. The default is:
13342.code
13343delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13344 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13345 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13346 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13347 } {no}{yes}}
13348.endd
13349This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13350&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13351&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13352&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13353
13354.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13355.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13356.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13357If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13358delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13359the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13360of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13361chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13362
13363.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13364.cindex "load average"
13365.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13366When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13367becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13368ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13369See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13370
13371
13372.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13373.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13374Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13375message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13376handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13377should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13378removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13379occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13380
13381.option disable_fsync main boolean false
13382.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13383This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13384ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13385a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13386build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13387really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13388distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13389
13390When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13391updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13392such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13393Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13394
13395
13396.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13397.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13398If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13399activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13400that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13401etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13402to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13403
13404
13405.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13406.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13407DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13408&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13409keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13410incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13411may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13412anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13413This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13414by a setting such as this:
13415.code
13416dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13417.endd
13418This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13419&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13420since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13421&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13422when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13423options are applied after this global option.
13424
13425.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13426.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13427When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13428names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13429the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13430contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13431a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13432done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13433value of this option. The default pattern is
13434.code
13435dns_check_names_pattern = \
13436 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13437.endd
13438which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13439they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13440permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13441accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13442&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13443empty string.
13444
13445.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13446This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13447DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13448
13449.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13450This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13451reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13452section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13453
13454.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13455.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13456.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13457When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13458looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13459(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13460domain matches this list.
13461
13462This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13463not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13464servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13465
13466
13467.option dns_retrans main time 0s
13468.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13469The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13470retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13471defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13472time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13473totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13474take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13475parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13476but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13477to set in them.
13478
13479
13480.option dns_retry main integer 0
13481See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13482
13483
13484.new
13485.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13486.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13487.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13488If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13489DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13490the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13491on.
13492
13493If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13494.wen
13495
13496
13497.option drop_cr main boolean false
13498This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13499handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13500described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13501
13502.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13503.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13504.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13505This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13506bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13507Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13508.code
13509dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13510.endd
13511The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13512panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13513
13514.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13515.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13516Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13517message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13518handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13519messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13520be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13521the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13522delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13523
13524
13525.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13526.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13527.cindex "copy of bounce message"
13528Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13529generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13530coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13531items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13532a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13533must be enclosed in double quotes.
13534
13535Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13536(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13537the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13538items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13539are examined. For example:
13540.code
13541errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13542 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13543 postmaster@mydomain.example
13544.endd
13545.vindex "&$domain$&"
13546.vindex "&$local_part$&"
13547The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13548and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13549there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13550.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13551variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13552
13553
13554.option errors_reply_to main string unset
13555.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13556By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13557.display
13558&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13559.endd
13560.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13561where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13562A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13563&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13564overrides the default.
13565
13566Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13567&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13568and warning messages. For example:
13569.code
13570errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13571.endd
13572The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13573address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13574&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13575own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13576not used.
13577
13578
13579.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13580.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13581.cindex "Exim group"
13582This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13583privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13584option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13585of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13586configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13587security issues.
13588
13589
13590.option exim_path main string "see below"
13591.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13592This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13593needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13594the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13595is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13596other place.
13597&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13598you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13599where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13600settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13601
13602
13603.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13604.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13605.cindex "Exim user"
13606This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13607privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13608time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13609options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13610
13611Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13612&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13613not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13614used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13615
13616
13617.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13618This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13619routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13620&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13621
13622
13623. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13624. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13625
13626.option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13627 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13628.oindex "&%-t%&"
13629.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13630.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13631According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13632are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13633envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13634line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13635behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13636command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13637&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13638argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13639addresses.
13640
13641
13642.option finduser_retries main integer 0
13643.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13644On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13645distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13646related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13647Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13648errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13649many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13650retries.
13651
13652.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13653You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13654a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13655search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13656
13657
13658
13659.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13660.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13661On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13662ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13663delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13664&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13665feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13666warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13667freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13668is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13669supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13670message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13671freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13672log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13673logging that you require.
13674
13675
13676.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13677.cindex "HP-UX"
13678.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13679Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13680password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13681looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13682headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13683of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13684it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13685upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13686
13687When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13688expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13689login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13690user's name.
13691
13692.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13693Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13694pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13695name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13696.code
13697gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13698gecos_name = $1
13699.endd
13700
13701.option gecos_pattern main string unset
13702See &%gecos_name%& above.
13703
13704
13705.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13706This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13707server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13708implementations of TLS.
13709
13710.option headers_charset main string "see below"
13711This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13712&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13713default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13714ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13715insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13716
13717
13718
13719.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13720.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13721.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13722This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13723section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13724&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13725sections are rejected.
13726
13727
13728.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13729.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13730.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13731This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13732all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13733header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13734zero means &"no limit"&.
13735
13736
13737
13738
13739.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13740.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13741.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13742Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13743mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13744some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13745this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13746if you want to do semantic checking.
13747See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13748set.
13749
13750
13751.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13752.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13753.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13754.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13755This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13756all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13757hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13758.code
13759helo_allow_chars = _
13760.endd
13761Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13762
13763
13764.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13765.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13766.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13767If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13768list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13769default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13770its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13771do.
13772
13773
13774.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13775.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13776.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13777By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13778&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13779to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13780condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13781Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13782to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13783necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13784encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13785Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13786
13787When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13788&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13789EHLO command either:
13790
13791.ilist
13792is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13793.next
13794.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13795.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13796matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13797calling host address, or
13798.next
13799when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13800available) yields the calling host address.
13801.endlist
13802
13803However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13804fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13805be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13806
13807.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13808.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13809.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13810Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13811backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13812name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13813&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13814rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13815If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13816error.
13817
13818.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13819.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13820.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13821This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13822manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13823&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13824verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13825item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13826it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13827
13828This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13829delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13830configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13831domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13832&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13833
13834A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13835messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13836time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13837retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13838
13839
13840.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13841.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13842Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13843is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13844&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13845option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13846default configuration file contains
13847.code
13848host_lookup = *
13849.endd
13850which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13851is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13852
13853After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13854has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13855this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13856
13857.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13858.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13859After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13860unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13861&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13862&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13863
13864
13865.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13866This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13867to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13868first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13869if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13870if you want.
13871
13872&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13873multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13874&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13875case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13876
13877
13878
13879.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13880.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13881If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13882as soon as the connection is made.
13883This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13884nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13885connections immediately.
13886
13887The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13888ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13889sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13890incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13891chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13892
13893
13894.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13895.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13896This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13897happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13898you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13899127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13900the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13901list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13902local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13903.code
13904hosts_connection_nolog = :
13905.endd
13906If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13907
13908
13909
13910.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13911.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13912.cindex "host" "treated as local"
13913If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13914if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13915records
13916or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13917host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13918
13919This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13920&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13921section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13922&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13923that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13924chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13925interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13926
13927
13928.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13929.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13930This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13931to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13932The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13933
13934
13935
13936.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13937.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13938.cindex "discarding bounce message"
13939This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13940that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13941suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13942
13943After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13944because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13945message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13946the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13947again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13948bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13949for frozen messages. For example,
13950.code
13951ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13952.endd
13953retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13954failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13955failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13956value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13957dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13958&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13959
13960
13961.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13962.cindex "&""From""& line"
13963.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13964Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13965the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13966message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13967such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13968match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13969process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13970&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13971
13972
13973.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13974See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13975
13976
13977.option keep_malformed main time 4d
13978This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13979have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13980next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13981logged.
13982
13983
13984.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
13985.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
13986This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
13987a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
13988While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
13989Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
13990and constrained to be a directory.
13991
13992
13993.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
13994.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
13995This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
13996a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
13997While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
13998Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
13999and constrained to be a file.
14000
14001
14002.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14003.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14004This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14005Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14006Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14007
14008
14009.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14010.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14011This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14012to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14013Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14014identity to be proven.
14015
14016
14017.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14018.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14019This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14020the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14021cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14022
14023
14024.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14025.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14026This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14027LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14028details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14029with LDAP support.
14030
14031
14032.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14033.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14034This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14035A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14036See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14037Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14038to hard/demand.
14039
14040
14041.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14042.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14043If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14044connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14045"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14046of SSL-on-connect.
14047In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14048by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14049
14050
14051.option ldap_version main integer unset
14052.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14053This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14054LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14055-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14056the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14057has been built with LDAP support.
14058
14059
14060
14061.option local_from_check main boolean true
14062.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14063.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14064When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14065an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14066checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14067the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14068
14069&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14070locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14071&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14072
14073You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14074on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14075&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14076and the default qualify domain.
14077
14078If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14079and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14080&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14081&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14082
14083.cindex "envelope sender"
14084These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14085is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14086&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14087
14088For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14089request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14090has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14091
14092
14093
14094
14095.option local_from_prefix main string unset
14096When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14097matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14098ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14099done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14100appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14101&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14102example, if
14103.code
14104local_from_prefix = *-
14105.endd
14106is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14107.code
14108From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14109.endd
14110will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14111matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14112qualify domain.
14113
14114
14115.option local_from_suffix main string unset
14116See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14117
14118
14119.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14120This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14121listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14122&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14123options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14124&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14125&%local_interfaces%& is
14126.code
14127local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14128.endd
14129when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14130.code
14131local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14132.endd
14133
14134.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14135.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14136.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14137This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14138&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14139the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14140message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14141non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14142
14143
14144
14145.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14146.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14147When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14148an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14149do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14150also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14151See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14152&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14153
14154
14155
14156
14157.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14158.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14159.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14160.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14161Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14162uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14163value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14164after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14165host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14166range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14167systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14168&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14169characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14170time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14171section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14172
14173
14174
14175.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14176.cindex "log" "file path for"
14177This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14178files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14179when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14180name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14181are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14182Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14183section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14184used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14185variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14186configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14187&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14188early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14189
14190
14191.option log_selector main string unset
14192.cindex "log" "selectors"
14193This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14194writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14195minus characters. For example:
14196.code
14197log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14198.endd
14199A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14200logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14201
14202
14203.option log_timezone main boolean false
14204.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14205.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14206.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14207By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14208timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14209in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14210avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14211&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14212timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14213of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14214&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14215another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14216
14217
14218.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14219.cindex "too many open files"
14220.cindex "open files, too many"
14221.cindex "file" "too many open"
14222.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14223.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14224This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14225lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14226Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14227file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14228recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14229actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14230as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14231open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14232&%lookup_open_max%&.
14233
14234
14235.option max_username_length main integer 0
14236.cindex "length of login name"
14237.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14238.cindex "limit" "user name length"
14239Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14240&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14241this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14242an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14243
14244
14245.option message_body_newlines main bool false
14246.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14247.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14248.vindex "&$message_body$&"
14249.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14250By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14251the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14252option is set true, this no longer happens.
14253
14254
14255.option message_body_visible main integer 500
14256.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14257.cindex "message body" "visible size"
14258.vindex "&$message_body$&"
14259.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14260This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14261&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14262
14263
14264.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14265.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14266If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14267(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14268locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14269means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14270Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14271Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14272replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14273empty string, the option is ignored.
14274
14275
14276.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14277If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14278the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14279message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14280take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14281the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14282it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14283yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14284before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14285that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14286means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14287colons will become hyphens.
14288
14289
14290.option message_logs main boolean true
14291.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14292.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14293If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14294&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14295Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14296minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14297per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14298which is not affected by this option.
14299
14300
14301.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14302.cindex "message" "size limit"
14303.cindex "limit" "message size"
14304.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14305This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14306value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14307to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14308TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14309optionally followed by K or M.
14310
14311&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14312other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14313the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14314error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14315&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14316
14317Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14318exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14319failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14320an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14321the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14322message that an individual transport can process.
14323
14324If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14325maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14326failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14327virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14328probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14329default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14330some problems may result.
14331
14332A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14333SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14334SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14335
14336
14337.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14338.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14339This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14340.code
14341SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14342.endd
14343in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14344moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14345and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14346standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14347lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14348
14349
14350.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14351Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14352it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14353contains a full description of this facility.
14354
14355
14356
14357.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14358.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14359This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14360be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14361option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14362
14363
14364.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14365This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14366message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14367recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14368It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14369safety precaution.
14370
14371When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14372list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14373the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14374contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14375can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14376
14377If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14378&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14379example is
14380.code
14381never_users = root:daemon:bin
14382.endd
14383Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14384harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14385transport driver.
14386
14387
14388.option openssl_options main "string list" unset
14389.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14390This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14391by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14392each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14393
14394This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14395available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14396The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14397the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14398list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14399&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14400names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14401
14402Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14403SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14404yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14405adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14406invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14407
14408.new
14409Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14410"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14411with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14412some now infamous attacks.
14413.wen
14414
14415An example:
14416.code
14417# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14418openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14419 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14420.endd
14421
14422Possible options may include:
14423.ilist
14424&`all`&
14425.next
14426&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14427.next
14428&`cipher_server_preference`&
14429.next
14430&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14431.next
14432&`ephemeral_rsa`&
14433.next
14434&`legacy_server_connect`&
14435.next
14436&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14437.next
14438&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14439.next
14440&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14441.next
14442&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14443.next
14444&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14445.next
14446&`no_compression`&
14447.next
14448&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14449.next
14450&`no_sslv2`&
14451.next
14452&`no_sslv3`&
14453.next
14454&`no_ticket`&
14455.next
14456&`no_tlsv1`&
14457.next
14458&`no_tlsv1_1`&
14459.next
14460&`no_tlsv1_2`&
14461.next
14462&`single_dh_use`&
14463.next
14464&`single_ecdh_use`&
14465.next
14466&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14467.next
14468&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14469.next
14470&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14471.next
14472&`tls_d5_bug`&
14473.next
14474&`tls_rollback_bug`&
14475.endlist
14476
14477
14478.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14479.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14480This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14481to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14482The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14483
14484
14485.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14486.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14487.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14488.cindex "address" "source-routed"
14489The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14490percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14491replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14492also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14493option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14494but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14495an ACL.
14496
14497&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14498trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14499if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14500implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14501routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14502a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14503local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14504
14505
14506.option perl_at_start main boolean false
14507This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14508interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14509
14510
14511.option perl_startup main string unset
14512This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14513interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14514
14515
14516.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14517.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14518This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14519data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14520&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14521PostgreSQL support.
14522
14523
14524.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14525.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14526.cindex "pid file, path for"
14527This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14528process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14529to the host name:
14530.code
14531pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14532.endd
14533If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14534spool directory.
14535The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14536option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14537of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14538
14539
14540.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14541.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14542This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14543PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14544control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14545&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14546for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14547that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14548not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14549
14550
14551.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14552.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14553If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14554completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14555called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14556purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14557volume of mail. Use with care!
14558
14559
14560.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14561.cindex "name" "of local host"
14562.cindex "host" "name of local"
14563.cindex "local host" "name of"
14564.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14565This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14566HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14567option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14568The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14569server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14570
14571If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14572name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14573contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14574&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14575version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14576explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14577
14578
14579.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14580.cindex "printing characters"
14581.cindex "8-bit characters"
14582By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1458332&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14584when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14585sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14586is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14587characters.
14588
14589This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14590&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14591the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14592described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14593Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14594standards.
14595
14596
14597.option process_log_path main string unset
14598.cindex "process log path"
14599.cindex "log" "process log"
14600.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14601This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14602&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14603utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14604in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14605can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14606different spool directories.
14607
14608
14609.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14610.oindex "&%-M%&"
14611.oindex "&%-R%&"
14612.oindex "&%-q%&"
14613The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14614admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14615&%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14616
14617
14618.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14619.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14620.cindex "address" "qualification"
14621This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14622addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14623recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14624are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14625also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14626locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14627
14628Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14629unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14630&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14631addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14632necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14633addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14634&%primary_hostname%& value.
14635
14636
14637.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14638This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14639addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14640
14641
14642
14643.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14644.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14645.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14646.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14647This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14648A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14649domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14650next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14651
14652
14653.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14654.oindex "&%-bp%&"
14655The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14656queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14657&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14658
14659
14660.option queue_only main boolean false
14661.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14662.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14663If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14664whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14665next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14666delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14667
14668The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14669and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14670&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14671&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14672
14673
14674.option queue_only_file main string unset
14675.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14676.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14677This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14678one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14679it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14680each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14681For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14682&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14683.code
14684queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14685.endd
14686causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14687&_/some/file_& exists.
14688
14689
14690.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14691.cindex "load average"
14692.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14693.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14694If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14695all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14696happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14697the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14698the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14699false.
14700
14701Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14702option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14703determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14704&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14705
14706
14707.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14708.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14709When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14710because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14711all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14712This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14713threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14714connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14715circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14716where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14717should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14718re-evaluated for each message.
14719
14720
14721.option queue_only_override main boolean true
14722.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14723When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14724setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14725&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14726to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14727
14728
14729.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14730.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14731If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14732in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14733must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14734single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14735and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14736single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14737the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14738avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14739&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14740when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14741large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14742
14743
14744
14745.option queue_run_max main integer 5
14746.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14747This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14748can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14749but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14750start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14751very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14752however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14753started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14754
14755Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14756the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14757run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14758the daemon's command line.
14759
14760.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14761.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14762.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14763When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14764received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14765However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14766&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14767message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14768has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14769when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14770over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14771SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14772&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14773&%queue_domains%&.
14774
14775
14776.option receive_timeout main time 0s
14777.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14778This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14779maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14780the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14781&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14782controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14783
14784.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14785.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14786.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14787This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14788added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14789on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14790used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14791added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14792&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14793header lines. The default setting is:
14794
14795.code
14796received_header_text = Received: \
14797 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14798 {${if def:sender_ident \
14799 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14800 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14801 by $primary_hostname \
14802 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14803 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14804 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14805 ${if def:sender_address \
14806 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14807 id $message_exim_id\
14808 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14809.endd
14810
14811The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14812support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14813locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14814header lines such as the following:
14815.code
14816Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14817by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14818(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14819id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14820for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14821Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14822id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14823.endd
14824Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14825the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14826checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14827message was accepted.
14828
14829
14830.option received_headers_max main integer 30
14831.cindex "loop" "prevention"
14832.cindex "mail loop prevention"
14833.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14834When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14835counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14836have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14837This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14838
14839
14840.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14841.cindex "unqualified addresses"
14842.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14843This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14844recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14845qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14846affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14847addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14848host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14849or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14850option was not set.
14851
14852
14853.option recipients_max main integer 0
14854.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14855.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14856If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14857original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14858by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14859all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14860Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14861done.
14862
14863.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14864&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14865RCPT commands in a single message.
14866
14867
14868.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14869If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14870recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14871error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14872error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14873initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14874for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14875
14876
14877.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14878.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14879This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14880hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14881does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14882message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14883have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14884deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14885deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14886each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14887same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14888&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14889with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14890tagged with its process id.
14891
14892This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14893message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14894manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14895deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14896is received.
14897
14898.cindex "number of deliveries"
14899.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14900If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14901need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14902are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14903daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14904fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14905runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14906delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14907then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14908&%remote_max_parallel%&.
14909
14910If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14911&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14912doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14913host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14914
14915
14916.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14917.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14918.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14919When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14920domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14921.code
14922remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14923.endd
14924would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14925then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14926
14927
14928.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14929.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14930This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14931database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14932host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14933past failures.
14934
14935
14936.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14937.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14938.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14939Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14940intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14941straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14942retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14943the default value.
14944
14945
14946.option return_path_remove main boolean true
14947.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14948RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14949&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14950The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14951MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14952in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14953&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14954received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14955the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14956
14957
14958.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14959This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14960
14961
14962.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14963.cindex "RFC 1413"
14964.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14965RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14966in the list.
14967
14968.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14969.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14970.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14971This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14972no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14973
14974
14975.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14976.cindex "unqualified addresses"
14977.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14978This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14979sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14980&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14981not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14982it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14983&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14984using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14985
14986
14987.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14988.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14989This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14990TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14991connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14992other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14993still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14994this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14995connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14996tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14997hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14998
14999
15000
15001.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15002.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15003.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15004.cindex "inetd"
15005This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15006that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15007control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15008value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15009non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15010set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15011
15012A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15013has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15014that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15015and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15016
15017
15018.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15019.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15020.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15021Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15022the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15023check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15024client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15025client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15026
15027When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15028allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15029but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15030or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15031starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15032counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15033following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15034MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15035
15036
15037.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15038You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15039check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15040changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15041live with.
15042
15043
15044. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15045. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15046
15047.option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15048 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15049.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15050.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15051The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15052prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15053results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15054response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15055precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15056seen).
15057
15058
15059.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15060.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15061.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15062This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15063host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15064expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15065reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15066connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15067is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15068of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15069required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15070
15071&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15072constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15073happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15074without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15075could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15076doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15077
15078
15079
15080.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15081.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15082.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15083.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15084If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15085listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15086on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15087fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15088subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15089to all messages received in the same connection.
15090
15091A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15092if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15093also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15094various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15095
15096
15097. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15098. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15099
15100.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
15101 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15102.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15103.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15104This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15105automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15106the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15107and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15108number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15109are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15110restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15111systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15112dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15113
15114
15115.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15116.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15117.cindex "host" "reserved"
15118When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15119number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15120that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15121&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15122restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15123of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15124of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15125the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15126individual host.
15127
15128For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15129set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15130connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15131provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15132
15133
15134.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15135.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15136.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15137.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15138This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15139several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15140is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15141responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15142incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15143
15144.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15145The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15146is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15147in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15148
15149If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15150expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15151used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15152panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15153value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15154For example:
15155.code
15156smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15157 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15158.endd
15159
15160Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15161messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15162verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15163&%helo_data%& value.
15164
15165.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15166.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15167.cindex "banner for SMTP"
15168.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15169.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15170This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15171positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15172.code
15173smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15174 $version_number $tod_full
15175.endd
15176Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15177multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15178appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15179in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15180multiline response).
15181
15182
15183.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15184.cindex "checking disk space"
15185.cindex "disk space, checking"
15186.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15187When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15188option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15189spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15190leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15191is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15192
15193
15194.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15195.cindex "connection backlog"
15196.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15197.cindex "backlog of connections"
15198This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15199this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15200of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15201attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15202say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15203out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15204value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15205attacks by SYN flooding.
15206
15207
15208.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15209.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15210.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15211The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15212the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15213synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15214fewer, but they still exist.
15215
15216Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15217for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15218client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15219SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15220for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15221input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15222does detect many instances.
15223
15224The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15225If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15226hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15227(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15228
15229
15230
15231.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15232.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15233.vindex "&$domain$&"
15234If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15235command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15236chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15237are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15238argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15239example:
15240.code
15241smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15242 $sender_host_address
15243.endd
15244A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15245complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15246run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15247a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15248receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15249the command.
15250
15251
15252.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15253.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15254When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15255one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15256section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15257
15258
15259.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15260.cindex "load average"
15261If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15262accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15263If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15264the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15265systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15266&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15267
15268
15269
15270.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15271.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15272.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15273Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15274particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15275.code
15276RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15277.endd
15278causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15279(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15280example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15281too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15282dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15283
15284.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15285When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15286&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15287Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15288&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15289not count towards the limit.
15290
15291
15292
15293.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15294.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15295.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15296If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15297Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15298that subvert web
15299clients
15300into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15301non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15302
15303
15304
15305.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15306.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15307.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15308.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15309Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15310can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15311recipients.
15312
15313Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15314facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15315&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15316&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15317
15318When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15319&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15320rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15321respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15322values:
15323
15324.ilist
15325A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15326.next
15327An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15328fractional parts are allowed here.
15329.next
15330A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15331.next
15332A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15333because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15334.endlist
15335
15336For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15337first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15338.code
15339smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15340smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15341.endd
15342The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15343two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15344seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15345delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15346
15347
15348.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15349See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15350
15351
15352.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15353See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15354
15355
15356.option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15357.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15358.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15359This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15360input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15361data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15362the message is abandoned.
15363A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15364.code
15365SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15366SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15367.endd
15368The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15369means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15370
15371
15372.oindex "&%-os%&"
15373The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15374&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15375this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15376of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15377timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15378
15379
15380.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15381This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15382&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15383
15384
15385.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15386.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15387.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15388In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15389&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15390reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15391to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15392policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15393&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15394example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15395.code
15396550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15397550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15398.endd
15399
15400.option spamd_address main string "see below"
15401This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15402extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15403The default value is
15404.code
15405127.0.0.1 783
15406.endd
15407See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15408
15409
15410
15411.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15412.cindex "multiple spool directories"
15413.cindex "spool directory" "split"
15414.cindex "directories, multiple"
15415If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15416subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15417sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15418subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15419arrival of the message.
15420
15421Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15422where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15423directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15424directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15425are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15426
15427It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15428changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15429&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15430after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15431automatically deleted.
15432
15433When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15434changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15435trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15436sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15437sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15438spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15439particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15440if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15441entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15442
15443
15444.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15445.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15446This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15447it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15448configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15449string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15450&$primary_hostname$&.
15451
15452If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15453that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15454log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15455Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15456as failures in the configuration file.
15457
15458By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15459tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15460
15461.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15462.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15463This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15464access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15465
15466.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15467.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15468This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15469variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15470is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15471&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15472
15473.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15474.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15475If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15476items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15477treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15478passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15479option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15480
15481
15482.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15483.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15484.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15485If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15486ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15487MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15488domain causes a syntax error.
15489However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15490syntax checking.
15491
15492
15493.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15494.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15495When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15496separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15497be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15498separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15499nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15500particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15501both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15502containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15503Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15504the LOG_ALERT priority.
15505
15506
15507.option syslog_facility main string unset
15508.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15509This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15510syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15511&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15512If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15513details of Exim's logging.
15514
15515
15516
15517.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15518.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15519This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15520syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15521&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15522
15523
15524
15525.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15526.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15527If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15528omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15529details of Exim's logging.
15530
15531
15532.option system_filter main string&!! unset
15533.cindex "filter" "system filter"
15534.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15535.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15536This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15537the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15538must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15539generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15540appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15541which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15542&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15543
15544
15545.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15546.vindex "&$address_file$&"
15547This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15548&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15549implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15550During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15551
15552
15553.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15554.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15555This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15556command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15557the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15558
15559.option system_filter_group main string unset
15560.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15561This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15562gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15563with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15564
15565.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15566.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15567.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15568This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15569is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15570contains the pipe command.
15571
15572
15573.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15574.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15575This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15576is used in a system filter.
15577
15578
15579.option system_filter_user main string unset
15580.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15581If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15582delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15583process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15584Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15585is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15586configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15587specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15588&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15589
15590If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15591under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15592transport option overrides.
15593
15594
15595.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15596.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15597.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15598.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15599If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15600TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15601turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15602performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15603should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15604However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15605this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15606daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15607TCP_NODELAY.
15608
15609
15610.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15611.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15612.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15613If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15614message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15615is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15616bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15617sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15618If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15619frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15620
15621&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15622frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15623messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15624
15625
15626.option timezone main string unset
15627.cindex "timezone, setting"
15628The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15629running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15630created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15631to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15632.code
15633timezone = UTC
15634.endd
15635The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15636or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15637is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15638time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15639runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15640unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15641
15642
15643.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15644.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15645.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15646.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15647When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15648of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15649response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15650chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15651
15652
15653.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15654.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15655.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15656The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15657file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15658assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15659&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15660
15661&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15662receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15663use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15664option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15665
15666.new
15667If the option contains &$tls_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
15668if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
15669Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
15670&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
15671.wen
15672
15673.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15674.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15675.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15676This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15677be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15678
15679.new
15680See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15681.wen
15682
15683
15684.new
15685.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
15686.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
15687The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
15688the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
15689interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
15690suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
15691
15692The value must be at least 1024.
15693
15694The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
15695hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
15696by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
15697
15698If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
15699number.
15700.wen
15701
15702
15703.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15704.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15705The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15706a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15707This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15708ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15709
15710.new
15711If the DH bit-count from loading the file is greater than tls_dh_max_bits then
15712it will be ignored.
15713.wen
15714
15715
15716.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15717This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15718operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15719set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15720further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15721
15722
15723
15724.option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15725.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15726The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15727file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15728the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15729key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15730&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15731
15732.new
15733See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15734.wen
15735
15736
15737.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15738.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15739.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15740If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15741&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15742support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15743TLS session.
15744
15745
15746.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15747.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15748.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15749This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15750The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15751connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15752different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15753permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15754in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15755preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15756&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15757
15758
15759.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15760.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15761.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15762See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15763
15764
15765.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15766.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15767.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15768The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15769a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15770match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15771are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15772directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15773option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15774
15775These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
15776than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
15777the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
15778connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
15779Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
15780use OpenSSL with a directory.
15781
15782.new
15783See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15784.wen
15785
15786
15787.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15788.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15789.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15790This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15791certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15792&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15793either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15794&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15795
15796Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15797&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15798present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15799aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15800the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15801connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15802ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15803
15804A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15805matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15806certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15807abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15808state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15809such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15810but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15811certificate"&.
15812
15813Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15814certificates.
15815
15816
15817.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15818.cindex "trusted groups"
15819.cindex "groups" "trusted"
15820This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15821option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15822which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15823specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15824details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15825&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15826are trusted.
15827
15828.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15829.cindex "trusted users"
15830.cindex "user" "trusted"
15831This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15832option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15833trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15834&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15835If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15836Exim user are trusted.
15837
15838.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15839.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15840.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15841This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15842the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15843gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15844used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15845can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15846is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15847&%-F%& option.
15848
15849.option unknown_username main string unset
15850See &%unknown_login%&.
15851
15852.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15853.cindex "trusted users"
15854.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15855.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15856.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15857.cindex "envelope sender"
15858When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15859normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15860default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15861senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15862is used) is ignored.
15863
15864However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15865to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15866.code
15867exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15868.endd
15869.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15870The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15871other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15872users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15873patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15874identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15875users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15876followed by a hyphen
15877by a setting like this:
15878.code
15879untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15880.endd
15881If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15882restriction, you can use
15883.code
15884untrusted_set_sender = *
15885.endd
15886The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15887only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15888to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15889parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15890&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15891necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15892overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15893described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15894
15895The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15896&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15897&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15898envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15899sender address.
15900
15901
15902.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15903.cindex "&""From""& line"
15904.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15905Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15906an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15907particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15908of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15909matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15910&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15911default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15912.code
15913From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15914From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15915.endd
15916The pattern can be seen by running
15917.code
15918exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15919.endd
15920It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15921year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15922regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15923&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15924(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15925&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15926
15927
15928.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15929See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15930
15931
15932.option warn_message_file main string unset
15933.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15934.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15935This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15936for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15937been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15938&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15939&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15940
15941
15942.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15943.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15944If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15945See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15946.ecindex IIDconfima
15947.ecindex IIDmaiconf
15948
15949
15950
15951
15952. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15953. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15954
15955.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15956.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15957.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15958This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15959Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
15960
15961For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15962&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15963which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15964provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15965&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15966
15967
15968
15969.option address_data routers string&!! unset
15970.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15971The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15972precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15973router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15974&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15975delivery of the address to be deferred.
15976
15977.vindex "&$address_data$&"
15978When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15979accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15980routers, and the eventual transport.
15981
15982&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15983that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15984in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15985either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15986put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15987
15988Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15989with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15990on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15991&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15992&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15993
15994The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15995for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15996you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15997.code
15998uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15999.endd
16000In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16001.code
16002file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16003.endd
16004This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16005lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16006
16007.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16008.vindex "&$address_data$&"
16009The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16010from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16011&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16012ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16013verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16014
16015
16016
16017.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16018.oindex "&%-bt%&"
16019.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16020If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16021by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16022your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16023having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16024routing.
16025
16026
16027
16028.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16029.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16030.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16031This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16032routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16033&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16034&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16035value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16036includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16037well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16038you could put:
16039.code
16040cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16041.endd
16042on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16043and
16044.code
16045cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16046.endd
16047on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16048this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16049explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16050logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16051
16052
16053.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16054.cindex "case of local parts"
16055.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16056By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16057manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16058If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16059this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16060part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16061turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16062more details.
16063
16064.vindex "&$local_part$&"
16065.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16066.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16067The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16068router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16069an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16070is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16071addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16072and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16073
16074This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16075recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16076modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16077(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16078
16079
16080
16081.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16082.cindex "local user, checking in router"
16083.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16084.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16085.vindex "&$home$&"
16086When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16087address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16088local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16089than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16090holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16091user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16092preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16093given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16094overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16095the router is skipped.
16096
16097If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16098or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16099setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16100two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16101setting to achieve this. For example:
16102.code
16103local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16104.endd
16105Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16106up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16107&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16108
16109
16110
16111.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16112.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16113This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16114router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16115evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16116result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16117&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16118router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16119
16120If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16121precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16122
16123This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16124All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16125
16126The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16127running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16128the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16129.code
16130condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16131.endd
16132Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16133.code
16134condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16135.endd
16136
16137A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16138.code
16139condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16140condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16141condition = foobar
16142.endd
16143
16144If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16145of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16146be specified using &%condition%&.
16147
16148
16149.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16150.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16151If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16152option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16153If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16154output, and Exim carries on processing.
16155This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16156so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16157option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16158variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16159&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16160are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16161
16162
16163
16164.option disable_logging routers boolean false
16165If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16166or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16167unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16168transport option of the same name.
16169
16170
16171.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16172.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16173.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16174If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16175the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16176lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16177expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16178a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16179
16180
16181
16182.option driver routers string unset
16183This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16184to be used.
16185
16186
16187
16188.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16189.cindex "envelope sender"
16190.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16191If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16192transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16193there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16194message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16195provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16196expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16197
16198The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16199subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16200settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16201setting.
16202
16203If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16204the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16205address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16206expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16207
16208If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16209SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16210any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16211sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16212settings:
16213.code
16214errors_to =
16215errors_to = ""
16216.endd
16217An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16218this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16219no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16220address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16221overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16222
16223.vindex "&$address_data$&"
16224If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16225MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16226path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16227setting &%return_path%&.
16228
16229The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16230manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16231implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16232
16233
16234
16235.option expn routers&!? boolean true
16236.cindex "address" "testing"
16237.cindex "testing" "addresses"
16238.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16239.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16240If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16241as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16242want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16243on for the system alias file.
16244See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16245are evaluated.
16246
16247The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16248&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16249an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16250
16251
16252
16253.option fail_verify routers boolean false
16254.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16255Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16256&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16257
16258
16259
16260.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16261If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16262verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16263
16264
16265
16266.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16267If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16268verifying a sender, verification fails.
16269
16270
16271
16272.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16273.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16274.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16275String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16276colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16277changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16278each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16279defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16280&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16281
16282If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16283associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16284list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16285randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16286transport for further details.
16287
16288
16289.option group routers string&!! "see below"
16290.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16291.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16292.cindex "transport" "local"
16293.cindex "router" "setting group"
16294When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16295specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16296process.
16297The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16298error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16299The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16300is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16301and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16302
16303
16304
16305.option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16306.cindex "header lines" "adding"
16307.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16308This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16309associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16310option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16311the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16312&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16313message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16314header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16315&"see"& the added header lines.
16316
16317The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16318&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16319the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16320failures are treated as configuration errors.
16321
16322&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16323router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16324
16325.cindex "duplicate addresses"
16326.oindex "&%unseen%&"
16327&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16328additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16329For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16330address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16331modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16332circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16333which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16334avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16335
16336
16337
16338.option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16339.cindex "header lines" "removing"
16340.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16341This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16342associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16343option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16344the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16345section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16346the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16347to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16348&"see"& the original header lines.
16349
16350The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16351&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16352the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16353errors.
16354
16355&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16356router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16357
16358&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16359removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16360routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16361warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16362
16363
16364.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16365.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16366.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16367Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16368entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16369IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16370address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16371like
16372.code
16373remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16374.endd
16375by setting
16376.code
16377ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16378.endd
16379on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16380discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16381attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16382domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16383Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16384router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16385
16386You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16387means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16388.code
16389ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16390ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16391.endd
16392The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16393in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16394
16395This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16396addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16397is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16398domain that is being routed.
16399
16400.vindex "&$host_address$&"
16401During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16402checked.
16403
16404.option initgroups routers boolean false
16405.cindex "additional groups"
16406.cindex "groups" "additional"
16407.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16408.cindex "transport" "local"
16409If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16410the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16411&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16412any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16413and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16414
16415
16416
16417.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16418.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16419.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16420If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16421one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16422section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16423evaluated.
16424
16425The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16426used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16427asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16428the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16429some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16430.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16431.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16432Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16433section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16434
16435.vindex "&$local_part$&"
16436.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16437During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16438running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16439expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16440the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16441a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16442command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16443This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16444the relevant transport.
16445
16446When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16447behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16448means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16449callout.
16450
16451The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16452&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16453&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16454to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16455immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16456.code
16457real_localuser:
16458 driver = accept
16459 local_part_prefix = real-
16460 check_local_user
16461 transport = local_delivery
16462.endd
16463For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16464router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16465.code
16466 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16467 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16468.endd
16469
16470If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16471both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16472are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16473separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16474
16475
16476.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16477See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16478
16479
16480
16481.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16482.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16483.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16484This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16485local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16486&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16487mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16488character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16489parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16490&%username-foo%&.
16491
16492
16493.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16494See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16495
16496
16497
16498.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16499.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16500.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16501The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16502See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16503are evaluated, and
16504section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16505string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16506example:
16507.code
16508local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16509.endd
16510.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16511If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16512for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16513expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16514example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16515send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16516each virtual domain:
16517.code
16518postmaster:
16519 driver = redirect
16520 local_parts = postmaster
16521 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16522.endd
16523
16524
16525.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16526.cindex "log" "delivery line"
16527.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16528Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16529deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16530recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16531this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16532router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16533router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16534redirect addresses.
16535
16536
16537
16538.option more routers boolean&!! true
16539The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16540that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16541result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16542fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16543delivery to be deferred.
16544
16545If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16546further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16547.oindex "&%self%&"
16548However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16549means of the setting
16550.code
16551self = pass
16552.endd
16553or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16554does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16555case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16556
16557Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16558expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16559controls what happens next.
16560
16561
16562.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16563.cindex "timeout" "of router"
16564.cindex "router" "timeout"
16565If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16566address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16567router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16568intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16569host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16570
16571There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16572lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16573applies to all of them.
16574
16575
16576
16577.option pass_router routers string unset
16578.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16579Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16580&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16581routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16582these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16583router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16584of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16585be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16586to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16587&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16588
16589
16590
16591.option redirect_router routers string unset
16592.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16593Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16594generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16595example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16596point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16597
16598The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16599It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16600instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16601which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16602
16603
16604
16605.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16606.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16607.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16608This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16609router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16610Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16611through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16612
16613Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16614be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16615If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16616failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16617
16618If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16619below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16620&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16621existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16622preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16623
16624.cindex "NFS"
16625If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16626the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16627unavailable.
16628
16629This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16630options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16631look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16632full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16633these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16634to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16635that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16636transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16637
16638During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16639facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16640This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16641operates as follows:
16642
16643If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16644characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16645comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16646but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16647used. For example:
16648.code
16649require_files = mail:/some/file
16650require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16651.endd
16652If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16653&%require_files%& condition fails.
16654
16655Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16656checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16657directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16658access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16659
16660&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16661incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16662may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16663may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16664user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16665
16666&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16667&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16668without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16669is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16670check again in that process.
16671
16672The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16673be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16674existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16675circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16676not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16677name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16678as if the file did not exist. For example:
16679.code
16680require_files = +/some/file
16681.endd
16682If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16683handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16684option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16685
16686
16687
16688.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16689.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16690.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16691When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16692in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16693domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16694other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16695Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16696latter kind.
16697
16698This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16699hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16700router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16701set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16702for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16703same name.
16704
16705The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16706appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16707independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16708
16709
16710
16711.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16712.cindex "router" "home directory for"
16713.cindex "home directory" "for router"
16714.vindex "&$home$&"
16715This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16716&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16717transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16718sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16719forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16720cause the router to defer.
16721
16722Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16723&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16724place.
16725(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16726are evaluated.)
16727While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16728&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16729
16730When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16731the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16732delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16733of these values that is set:
16734
16735.ilist
16736The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16737.next
16738The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16739.next
16740The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16741.next
16742The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16743.endlist
16744
16745In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16746router, but not for the transport.
16747
16748
16749
16750.option self routers string freeze
16751.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16752.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16753This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16754list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16755and &(manualroute)& routers.
16756Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16757of remote hosts.
16758Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16759&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16760host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16761The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16762&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16763
16764Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16765example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16766error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16767reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16768freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16769cases:
16770
16771.vlist
16772.vitem &%defer%&
16773Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16774
16775.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16776The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16777be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16778behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16779
16780.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16781The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16782reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16783rewritten.
16784
16785.vitem &%pass%&
16786.oindex "&%more%&"
16787.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16788The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16789&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16790subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16791name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16792distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16793combination
16794.code
16795self = pass
16796no_more
16797.endd
16798ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16799Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16800be passed to the next router.
16801
16802.vitem &%fail%&
16803Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16804
16805.vitem &%send%&
16806.cindex "local host" "sending to"
16807The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16808setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16809makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16810is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16811different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16812.endlist
16813
16814
16815
16816.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16817.cindex "router" "checking senders"
16818If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16819address matches something on the list.
16820See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16821are evaluated.
16822
16823There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16824dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16825setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16826to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16827set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16828verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16829SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16830matters.
16831
16832
16833.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16834.cindex "IP address" "translating"
16835.cindex "packet radio"
16836.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16837There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16838it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16839mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16840routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16841is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16842code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16843SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16844
16845.vindex "&$host_address$&"
16846The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16847by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16848expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16849For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16850If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16851address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16852up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16853produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16854addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16855.code
16856translate_ip_address = \
16857 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16858 {$value}fail}}
16859.endd
16860The file would contain lines like
16861.code
1686210.2.3.128/26 some.host
1686310.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16864.endd
16865You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16866are doing.
16867
16868
16869
16870.option transport routers string&!! unset
16871This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16872and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16873only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16874after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16875and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16876delivery is deferred.
16877
16878The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16879have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16880(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16881
16882
16883
16884.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16885.cindex "current directory for local transport"
16886This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16887to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16888explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16889file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16890option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16891overridden by a setting on the transport.
16892If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16893logged, and delivery is deferred.
16894See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16895environment.
16896
16897
16898
16899
16900.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16901.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16902This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16903local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16904configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16905pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16906string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16907setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16908If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16909logged, and delivery is deferred.
16910
16911If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16912&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16913the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16914the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16915is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16916
16917See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16918environment.
16919
16920
16921
16922
16923.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16924.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16925The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16926that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16927result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16928fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16929delivery to be deferred.
16930
16931When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16932address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16933overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16934&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16935the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16936sometimes true and sometimes false).
16937
16938.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16939Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16940qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16941delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16942In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16943&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16944to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16945&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16946
16947&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16948this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16949only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16950no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16951a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16952duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16953duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16954&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16955so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16956&%redirect%& router may be of help.
16957
16958Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16959&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16960subsequent routers.
16961
16962
16963.option user routers string&!! "see below"
16964.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16965.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16966.cindex "transport" "local"
16967.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16968.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16969When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16970specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16971The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16972error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16973This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16974The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16975the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16976a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16977See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16978&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16979
16980
16981
16982.option verify routers&!? boolean true
16983Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16984&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16985
16986
16987.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16988.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16989.oindex "&%-bv%&"
16990.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16991If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16992testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16993with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16994restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16995&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16996
16997&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16998SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16999accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17000user or group.
17001
17002
17003.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17004If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17005addresses
17006or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17007See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17008are evaluated.
17009
17010
17011.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17012If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17013or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17014See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17015are evaluated.
17016.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17017.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17018
17019
17020
17021
17022
17023
17024. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17025. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17026
17027.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17028.cindex "&(accept)& router"
17029.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17030The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17031used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17032be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17033specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17034it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17035up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17036.code
17037localusers:
17038 driver = accept
17039 domains = mydomain.example
17040 check_local_user
17041 transport = local_delivery
17042.endd
17043The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17044&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17045When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17046address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17047
17048
17049
17050
17051
17052
17053. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17054. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17055
17056.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17057.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17058.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17059The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17060recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17061unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17062
17063If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17064SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17065MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17066However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17067records.
17068
17069MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17070looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17071When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17072except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17073IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17074generic option, the router declines.
17075
17076Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17077to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17078are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17079
17080.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17081.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17082.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17083If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17084address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17085happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17086
17087
17088.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17089There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17090Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17091SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17092MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17093problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17094
17095For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17096&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17097&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17098an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17099domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17100such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17101proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17102look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17103case routing fails.
17104
17105
17106.new
17107.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17108.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17109There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17110an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17111domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17112
17113Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17114.ilist
17115The domain does not exist in DNS
17116.next
17117The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17118convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17119for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17120.next
17121Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17122.next
17123MX record points to a non-existent host.
17124.next
17125MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17126&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17127.next
17128MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17129addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17130.next
17131The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17132&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17133.next
17134&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17135not be found in the MX records (see below)
17136.endlist
17137.wen
17138
17139
17140
17141
17142.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17143.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17144The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17145
17146.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17147.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17148If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17149(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17150process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17151differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17152the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17153
17154
17155.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17156.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17157The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17158addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17159enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17160required. For example,
17161.code
17162check_srv = smtp
17163.endd
17164looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17165expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17166to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17167submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17168option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17169normal way.
17170
17171When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17172the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17173host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17174this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17175SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17176according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17177
17178When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17179the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17180records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17181this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17182defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17183and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17184have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17185trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17186
17187See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17188when there is a DNS lookup error.
17189
17190
17191
17192.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17193.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17194.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17195A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17196record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17197For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17198records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17199setting:
17200.code
17201mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17202.endd
17203This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17204has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17205the address record.
17206
17207
17208.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17209If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17210DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17211&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17212
17213
17214
17215
17216.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17217.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17218.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17219When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17220lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17221single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17222called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17223&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17224resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17225&'resolv.conf'&.
17226
17227
17228
17229.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17230.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17231.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17232If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17233qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17234an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17235expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17236occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17237&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17238any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17239header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17240
17241This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17242ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17243sense.
17244
17245When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17246servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17247making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17248some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17249name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17250header rewriting.
17251
17252
17253.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17254.cindex "address" "copying routing"
17255Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17256to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17257options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17258default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17259servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17260any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17261
17262If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17263domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17264local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17265lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17266routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17267message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17268without processing them independently,
17269provided the following conditions are met:
17270
17271.ilist
17272No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17273&%headers_remove%&.
17274.next
17275The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17276the domain.
17277.endlist
17278
17279
17280
17281
17282.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17283.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17284When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17285lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17286applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17287the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17288domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17289up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17290&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17291actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17292
17293Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17294record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17295local wildcard.
17296
17297
17298
17299.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17300If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17301DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17302&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17303
17304
17305
17306
17307.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17308.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17309If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17310added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17311if
17312.code
17313widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17314.endd
17315is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17316&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17317&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17318and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17319the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17320when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17321
17322
17323.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17324When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17325of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17326corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17327is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17328
17329These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17330for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17331such as that implied by
17332.code
17333domains = @mx_any
17334.endd
17335that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17336entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17337.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17338.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17339
17340
17341
17342
17343
17344
17345
17346
17347
17348. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17349. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17350
17351.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17352.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17353.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17354.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17355This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17356verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17357generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17358takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17359router handles the address
17360.code
17361root@[192.168.1.1]
17362.endd
17363by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17364consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17365are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17366.code
17367postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17368.endd
17369Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17370grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17371
17372.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17373If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17374declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17375&%self%& option determines what happens.
17376
17377The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17378controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17379also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17380Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17381
17382
17383
17384. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17385. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17386
17387.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17388.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17389.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17390The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17391Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17392not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17393must set
17394.code
17395ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17396.endd
17397in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17398
17399The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17400connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17401a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17402message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17403this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17404can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17405must not be specified for it.
17406
17407.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17408.option hosts iplookup string unset
17409This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17410names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17411(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17412and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17413happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17414
17415
17416.option optional iplookup boolean false
17417If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17418is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17419delivery to the address is deferred.
17420
17421
17422.option port iplookup integer 0
17423.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17424This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17425call.
17426
17427
17428.option protocol iplookup string udp
17429This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17430protocols is to be used.
17431
17432
17433.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17434This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17435default value is:
17436.code
17437$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17438.endd
17439The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17440query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17441
17442
17443.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17444If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17445returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17446string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17447in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17448&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17449whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17450up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17451
17452
17453.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17454This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17455returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17456router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17457response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17458check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17459address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17460the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17461following could be used:
17462.code
17463response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17464reroute = $local_part@$1
17465.endd
17466
17467.option timeout iplookup time 5s
17468This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17469machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17470call. It does not apply to UDP.
17471
17472
17473
17474
17475. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17476. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17477
17478.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17479.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17480.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17481.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17482The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17483routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17484route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17485normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17486route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17487messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17488
17489The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17490it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17491has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17492include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17493&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17494generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17495being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17496
17497.vindex "&$host$&"
17498In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17499router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17500an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17501transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17502with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17503passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17504host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17505text string.
17506
17507The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17508&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17509or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17510any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17511below, following the list of private options.
17512
17513
17514.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17515
17516.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17517The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17518
17519.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17520See &%host_find_failed%&.
17521
17522.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17523This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17524address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17525of the following values:
17526.code
17527decline
17528defer
17529fail
17530freeze
17531ignore
17532pass
17533.endd
17534The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17535error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17536forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17537&%pass_router%&),
17538.oindex "&%more%&"
17539overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17540router only if &%more%& is true.
17541
17542The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17543cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17544controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17545as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17546
17547The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17548state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17549generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17550
17551
17552.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17553.cindex "randomized host list"
17554.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17555If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17556is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17557overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17558crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17559same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17560(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17561deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17562
17563When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17564into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17565set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17566item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17567.code
17568route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17569.endd
17570The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17571randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17572If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17573randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17574&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17575
17576
17577.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17578If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17579Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17580example:
17581.code
17582route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17583.endd
17584If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17585router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17586deferred.
17587
17588
17589.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17590This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17591unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17592that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17593
17594
17595.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17596.cindex "address" "copying routing"
17597Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17598router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17599router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17600default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17601servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17602any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17603
17604If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17605domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17606local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17607lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17608&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17609addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17610same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17611if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17612
17613
17614
17615
17616.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17617The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17618rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17619entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17620described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17621Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17622.display
17623<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17624.endd
17625The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17626no options:
17627.code
17628route_list = \
17629 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17630 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17631.endd
17632The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17633list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17634usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17635single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17636pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17637&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17638except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17639That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17640lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17641in a &%route_list%&).
17642
17643The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17644matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17645then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17646&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17647
17648
17649
17650.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17651The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17652routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17653hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17654The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17655Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17656expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17657like this:
17658.code
17659dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17660thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17661.endd
17662This data can be accessed by setting
17663.code
17664route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17665.endd
17666Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17667decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17668requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17669possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17670be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17671
17672
17673
17674
17675.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17676A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17677always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17678declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17679and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17680in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17681as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17682
17683If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17684variables are set during its expansion:
17685
17686.ilist
17687.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17688If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17689&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17690.code
17691route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17692.endd
17693.next
17694&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17695.next
17696&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17697
17698.next
17699.vindex "&$value$&"
17700If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17701looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17702.code
17703route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17704.endd
17705.endlist
17706
17707Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17708semicolon is the default route list separator.
17709
17710
17711
17712.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17713Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17714optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17715is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17716specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17717by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17718
17719.ilist
17720Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17721the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17722be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17723.code
17724route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17725route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17726.endd
17727.next
17728When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17729colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17730enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17731number follows. For example:
17732.code
17733route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17734.endd
17735.endlist
17736
17737.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17738When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17739the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17740delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17741option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17742transport.
17743
17744Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17745hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17746interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17747records in the DNS. For example:
17748.code
17749route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17750.endd
17751If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17752example:
17753.code
17754route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17755.endd
17756If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17757randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17758that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17759be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17760Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17761happens is controlled by the
17762.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17763&%self%& option of the router.
17764
17765A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17766hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17767lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17768below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17769preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17770randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17771defined by MX preferences.
17772
17773If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17774not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17775preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17776
17777If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17778depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17779is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17780Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17781
17782If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17783most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17784router.
17785
17786DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17787failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17788&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17789
17790The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17791whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17792
17793
17794
17795.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17796The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17797present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17798&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17799other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17800per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17801routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17802
17803.ilist
17804&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17805setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17806.next
17807&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17808overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17809.next
17810&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17811find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17812also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17813.next
17814&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17815no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17816timeout), delivery is deferred.
17817.endlist
17818
17819For example:
17820.code
17821route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17822 domain2 host4:host5
17823.endd
17824If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17825DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17826result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17827or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17828call.
17829
17830&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17831called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17832instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17833lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17834function called.
17835
17836
17837
17838If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17839&%host_find_failed%& option.
17840
17841.vindex "&$host$&"
17842When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17843The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17844
17845
17846
17847.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17848In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17849transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17850
17851.ilist
17852.cindex "smart host" "example router"
17853The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17854&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17855named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17856.code
17857domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17858.endd
17859You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17860your first router something like this:
17861.code
17862smart_route:
17863 driver = manualroute
17864 domains = !+local_domains
17865 transport = remote_smtp
17866 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17867.endd
17868This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17869&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17870they are tried in order
17871(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17872Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17873.code
17874smart_route:
17875 driver = manualroute
17876 transport = remote_smtp
17877 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17878.endd
17879There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17880However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17881example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17882precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17883always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17884would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17885always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17886&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17887
17888.next
17889.cindex "mail hub example"
17890A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17891records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17892the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17893machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17894&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17895to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17896using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17897lookup is easier to manage.
17898
17899If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17900to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17901example:
17902.code
17903hub_route:
17904 driver = manualroute
17905 transport = remote_smtp
17906 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17907.endd
17908This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17909whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17910if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17911that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17912domain can be used to find the host:
17913.code
17914through_firewall:
17915 driver = manualroute
17916 transport = remote_smtp
17917 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17918.endd
17919The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17920hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17921data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17922next router.
17923
17924.next
17925.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17926.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17927You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17928SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17929storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17930can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17931.code
17932save_in_file:
17933 driver = manualroute
17934 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17935 route_list = saved.domain.example
17936.endd
17937though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17938several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17939different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17940.code
17941save_in_file:
17942 driver = manualroute
17943 route_list = \
17944 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17945 *.saved.domain2.example \
17946 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17947 batch_pipe
17948.endd
17949.vindex "&$domain$&"
17950.vindex "&$host$&"
17951The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17952doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17953file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17954the address if the lookup fails.
17955
17956.next
17957.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17958Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17959&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17960one way it can be done:
17961.code
17962# Transport
17963uucp:
17964 driver = pipe
17965 user = nobody
17966 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17967 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17968 return_fail_output = true
17969
17970# Router
17971uucphost:
17972 transport = uucp
17973 driver = manualroute
17974 route_data = \
17975 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17976.endd
17977The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17978.code
17979darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17980.endd
17981It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17982makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17983&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17984.endlist
17985.ecindex IIDmanrou1
17986.ecindex IIDmanrou2
17987
17988
17989
17990
17991
17992
17993
17994
17995. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17996. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17997
17998.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17999.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18000.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18001.cindex "routing" "by external program"
18002The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18003and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18004mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18005However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18006&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18007be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18008options:
18009.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18010
18011.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18012This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18013command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18014expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18015&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18016
18017
18018.option command_group queryprogram string unset
18019.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18020This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18021address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18022uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18023gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18024
18025
18026.option command_user queryprogram string unset
18027.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18028This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18029command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18030it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18031using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18032not set, a value for the gid also.
18033
18034&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18035root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18036However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18037usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18038is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18039the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18040gid.
18041
18042
18043.option current_directory queryprogram string /
18044This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18045before running the command.
18046
18047
18048.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18049If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18050is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18051timeout.
18052
18053
18054The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18055the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18056containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18057the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18058field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18059
18060.ilist
18061&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18062below).
18063.next
18064&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18065&%no_more%& is set.
18066.next
18067&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18068subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18069of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18070included in the SMTP response.
18071.next
18072&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18073subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18074included in any SMTP response.
18075.next
18076&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18077.next
18078&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18079&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18080.next
18081&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18082new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18083or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18084.endlist
18085
18086When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18087number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18088the page):
18089.code
18090ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18091LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18092.endd
18093The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18094is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18095used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18096an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18097
18098The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18099As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18100in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18101&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18102(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18103
18104If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18105find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18106anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18107goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18108result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18109
18110.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18111If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18112variable. For example, this return line
18113.code
18114accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18115.endd
18116routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18117the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18118.ecindex IIDquerou1
18119.ecindex IIDquerou2
18120
18121
18122
18123
18124. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18125. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18126
18127.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18128.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18129.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18130.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18131.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18132The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18133common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18134(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18135files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18136redirected in several different ways:
18137
18138.ilist
18139It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18140independently.
18141.next
18142It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18143.next
18144It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18145.next
18146It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18147.next
18148It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18149.next
18150It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18151.next
18152It can be discarded.
18153.endlist
18154
18155The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18156However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18157files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18158&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18159
18160
18161
18162.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18163The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18164expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18165contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18166options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18167aliases, in a configuration like this:
18168.code
18169system_aliases:
18170 driver = redirect
18171 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18172.endd
18173If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18174expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18175expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18176cause delivery to be deferred.
18177
18178A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18179&_.forward_& files, like this:
18180.code
18181userforward:
18182 driver = redirect
18183 check_local_user
18184 file = $home/.forward
18185 no_verify
18186.endd
18187If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18188empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18189is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18190yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18191comments.
18192
18193
18194
18195.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18196.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18197It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18198&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18199
18200.ilist
18201When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18202running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18203the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18204practice the router may not be able to operate.
18205.next
18206However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18207is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18208local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18209saves some resources.
18210.endlist
18211
18212
18213
18214
18215
18216
18217.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18218.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18219.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18220The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18221can be interpreted in two different ways:
18222
18223.ilist
18224If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18225&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18226&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18227respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18228in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18229document is intended for use by end users.
18230.next
18231Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18232described in the next section.
18233.endlist
18234
18235When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18236in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18237generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18238configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18239for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18240
18241
18242
18243.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18244.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18245When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18246comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18247addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18248&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18249disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18250depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18251commas or newlines.
18252If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18253quotes.
18254
18255Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18256also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18257next newline character is ignored.
18258
18259If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18260double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18261(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18262&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18263removed.
18264
18265.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18266&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18267and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18268of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18269special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18270&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18271setting:
18272.code
18273data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18274.endd
18275
18276
18277.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18278.cindex "routing" "loops in"
18279.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18280.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18281A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18282consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18283automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18284is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18285Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18286as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18287complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18288
18289.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18290Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18291filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18292mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18293&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18294.code
18295cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18296.endd
18297.cindex "backslash in alias file"
18298.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18299For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18300preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18301it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18302synonymously.
18303
18304If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
183052822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18306domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18307addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18308force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18309
18310Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18311Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18312contains:
18313.code
18314Sam.Reman: spqr
18315.endd
18316Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18317messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18318this forward file:
18319.code
18320Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18321.endd
18322With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18323&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18324second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18325and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18326should really contain
18327.code
18328spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18329.endd
18330but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18331below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18332&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18333
18334
18335
18336.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18337In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18338lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18339
18340.ilist
18341.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18342.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18343An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18344as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18345command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18346Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18347which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18348
18349Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18350the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18351the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18352in double quotes, for example:
18353.code
18354"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18355.endd
18356since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18357quote just the command. An item such as
18358.code
18359|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18360.endd
18361is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18362
18363.next
18364.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18365.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18366An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18367parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18368.code
18369/home/world/minbari
18370.endd
18371is treated as a file name, but
18372.code
18373/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18374.endd
18375is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18376the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18377forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18378file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18379
18380Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18381which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18382
18383.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18384However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18385bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18386instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18387
18388.next
18389.cindex "included address list"
18390.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18391If an item is of the form
18392.code
18393:include:<path name>
18394.endd
18395a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18396point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18397out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18398by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18399item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18400the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18401.code
18402list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18403.endd
18404It must be given as
18405.code
18406list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18407.endd
18408.next
18409.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18410Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18411&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18412the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18413.cindex "black hole"
18414.cindex "abandoning mail"
18415&':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18416done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18417&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18418
18419&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18420delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18421are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18422database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18423&_/dev/null_&.
18424
18425.next
18426.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18427.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18428.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18429.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18430.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18431An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18432redirection items of the form
18433.code
18434:defer:
18435:fail:
18436.endd
18437respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18438to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18439text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18440associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18441.code
18442X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18443.endd
18444In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18445of a
18446.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18447VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18448default.
18449.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18450The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18451the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18452
18453.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18454By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18455&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18456space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18457followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18458code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18459incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18460suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18461&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18462ignored.
18463
18464.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18465In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18466default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18467therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18468
18469Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18470not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18471normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18472as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18473lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18474
18475During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18476containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18477whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18478subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18479deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18480rules still apply.
18481
18482.next
18483.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18484Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18485chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18486for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18487&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18488router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18489results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18490.endlist
18491
18492
18493.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18494.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18495.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18496.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18497Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18498to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18499routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18500aliasing scheme of the type
18501.code
18502pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18503localpart1: pipe
18504localpart2: pipe
18505.endd
18506does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18507when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18508discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18509such as
18510.code
18511localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18512localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18513.endd
18514does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18515the pipes are distinct.
18516
18517
18518
18519.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18520.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18521.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18522When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18523leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18524afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18525delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18526members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18527can be used to avoid this.
18528
18529
18530.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18531.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18532If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18533error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18534for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18535detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18536deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18537
18538
18539
18540.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18541
18542.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18543The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18544
18545
18546.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18547Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18548data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18549
18550
18551.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18552.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18553If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18554and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18555
18556
18557.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18558.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18559.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18560Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18561&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18562are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18563lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18564
18565It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18566the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18567
18568
18569The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18570&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18571&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18572files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18573true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18574
18575
18576
18577.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18578.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18579Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18580This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18581default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18582let ordinary users do.
18583
18584
18585
18586.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18587This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18588as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18589Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18590configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18591for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18592
18593When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18594is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18595the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18596and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18597domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18598&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18599.code
18600\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18601.endd
18602Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18603&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18604originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18605(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18606&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18607&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18608file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18609original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18610
18611
18612.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18613When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18614when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18615&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18616&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18617deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18618is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18619&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18620
18621
18622
18623.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18624When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18625this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18626permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18627option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18628&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18629
18630
18631.option data redirect string&!! unset
18632This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18633set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18634list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18635expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18636has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18637
18638When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18639filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18640terminated with newline characters. For example:
18641.code
18642data = #Exim filter\n\
18643 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18644.endd
18645If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18646you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18647choice into a newline.
18648
18649
18650.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18651A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18652ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18653specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18654configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18655
18656
18657.option file redirect string&!! unset
18658This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18659is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18660use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18661failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18662must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18663data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18664entirely of comments), the router declines.
18665
18666.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18667If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18668runs a check on the containing directory,
18669unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18670If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18671happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18672is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18673not, the router declines.
18674
18675
18676.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18677.vindex "&$address_file$&"
18678A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18679ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18680specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18681configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18682it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18683
18684
18685.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18686When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18687relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18688relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18689relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18690
18691
18692.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18693If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18694redirection list.
18695
18696
18697.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18698If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18699&%allow_filter%& is true.
18700
18701
18702
18703
18704.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18705.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18706.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18707.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18708If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18709specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18710conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18711set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18712locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18713
18714
18715.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18716.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18717If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18718make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18719functions.
18720
18721.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18722.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18723If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18724make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18725
18726.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18727If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18728permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18729under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18730&_.forward_& files).
18731
18732
18733.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18734If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18735to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18736
18737
18738.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18739This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18740it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18741of the embedded Perl support.
18742
18743
18744.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18745If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18746to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18747
18748
18749.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18750If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18751to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18752
18753
18754.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18755If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18756message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18757files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18758&%one_time%& is set.
18759
18760
18761.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18762If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18763to make use of &%run%& items.
18764
18765
18766.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18767If this option is true, items of the form
18768.code
18769:include:<path name>
18770.endd
18771are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18772
18773
18774.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18775.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18776If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18777specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18778forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18779
18780
18781.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18782If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18783&%allow_filter%& is true.
18784
18785
18786.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18787.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18788If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18789of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18790the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18791
18792
18793
18794
18795.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18796.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18797If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18798generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18799generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18800bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18801bounce may well quote the generated address.
18802
18803
18804.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18805.cindex "EACCES"
18806If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18807EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18808file did not exist.
18809
18810
18811.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18812.cindex "ENOTDIR"
18813If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18814ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18815router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18816
18817Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18818router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18819(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18820against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18821is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18822is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18823a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18824that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18825
18826
18827
18828.option include_directory redirect string unset
18829If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18830redirection list must start with this directory.
18831
18832
18833.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18834This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18835&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18836
18837
18838.option one_time redirect boolean false
18839.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18840.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18841.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18842.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18843.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18844Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18845files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18846of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18847is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18848but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18849message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18850lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18851before they subscribed.
18852
18853If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18854deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18855&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18856&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18857attempt.
18858
18859&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18860router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18861reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18862permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18863
18864&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18865to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18866and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18867
18868&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18869&%one_time%&.
18870
18871The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18872addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18873addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18874&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18875typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18876expansion.
18877
18878
18879.option owners redirect "string list" unset
18880.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18881.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18882.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18883.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18884This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18885This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18886See &%check_owner%& above.
18887
18888
18889.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18890This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18891The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18892&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18893
18894
18895.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18896.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18897A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18898starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18899transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18900name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18901When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18902
18903
18904.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18905.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18906If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18907generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18908in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18909expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18910to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18911&$qualify_recipient$&.
18912
18913This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18914but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18915not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18916addresses.
18917
18918.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18919.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18920.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18921.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18922If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18923set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18924without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18925address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18926&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18927this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18928
18929
18930.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18931If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18932any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18933the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18934only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18935&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18936
18937
18938.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18939A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18940&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18941by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18942transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18943are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18944
18945
18946.option rewrite redirect boolean true
18947.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18948If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18949subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18950and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18951
18952
18953.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18954The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18955:subaddress part of an address.
18956
18957.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18958The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18959of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18960(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18961
18962
18963.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18964.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18965To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18966&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18967(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18968&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18969needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18970
18971
18972
18973.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18974.cindex "forward file" "broken"
18975.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18976.cindex "alias file" "broken"
18977.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18978.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18979.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18980.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18981If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18982non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18983&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18984giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18985are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18986&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18987be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18988&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18989
18990If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18991errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18992the following routers.
18993
18994If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18995error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18996taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18997so it is passed to the following routers.
18998
18999.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19000Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19001action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19002&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19003
19004&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19005lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19006option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19007notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19008.code
19009userforward:
19010 driver = redirect
19011 allow_filter
19012 check_local_user
19013 file = $home/.forward
19014 file_transport = address_file
19015 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19016 reply_transport = address_reply
19017 no_verify
19018 skip_syntax_errors
19019 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19020 syntax_errors_text = \
19021 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19022 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19023 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19024 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19025 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19026 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19027 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19028 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19029 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19030 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19031.endd
19032You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19033&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19034put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19035.code
19036real_localuser:
19037 driver = accept
19038 check_local_user
19039 local_part_prefix = real-
19040 transport = local_delivery
19041.endd
19042For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19043router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19044.code
19045 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19046 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19047.endd
19048
19049
19050.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19051See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19052
19053
19054.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19055See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19056.ecindex IIDredrou1
19057.ecindex IIDredrou2
19058
19059
19060
19061
19062
19063
19064. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19065. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19066
19067.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19068 "Environment for local transports"
19069.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19070.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19071.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19072Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19073transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19074in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19075mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19076
19077Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19078some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19079transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19080&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19081
19082The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19083different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19084settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19085or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19086configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19087
19088
19089
19090.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19091.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19092.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19093If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19094simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19095the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19096rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19097time.
19098
19099However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19100locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19101.code
19102my_transport:
19103 driver = pipe
19104 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19105.endd
19106This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19107messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19108&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19109file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19110
19111
19112
19113
19114.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19115.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19116.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19117All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19118overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19119set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19120delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19121group (set by the transport). For example:
19122.code
19123# Routers ...
19124# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19125local_users:
19126 driver = accept
19127 check_local_user
19128 transport = group_delivery
19129
19130# Transports ...
19131# This transport overrides the group
19132group_delivery:
19133 driver = appendfile
19134 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19135 group = mail
19136.endd
19137If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19138address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19139gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19140set.
19141
19142.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19143When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19144function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19145&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19146by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19147for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19148
19149.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19150The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19151is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19152receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19153original gid is also used.
19154
19155This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19156following that is set is used:
19157
19158.ilist
19159A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19160.next
19161A &%group%& setting of the router;
19162.next
19163A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19164&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19165.next
19166The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19167.next
19168In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19169the uid is the creator's uid;
19170.next
19171The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19172.endlist
19173
19174If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19175no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19176This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19177The first of the following that is set is used:
19178
19179.ilist
19180A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19181.next
19182In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19183.next
19184A &%user%& setting of the router;
19185.next
19186A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19187.next
19188The Exim uid.
19189.endlist
19190
19191Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19192&%never_users%& list.
19193
19194
19195
19196
19197
19198.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19199.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19200.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19201.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19202.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19203Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19204the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19205However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19206are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19207for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19208
19209.ilist
19210The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19211.next
19212The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19213.next
19214The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19215.next
19216The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19217.endlist
19218
19219The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19220
19221.ilist
19222The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19223.next
19224The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19225.endlist
19226
19227
19228If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19229value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19230directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19231
19232
19233
19234.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19235.vindex "&$domain$&"
19236.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19237.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19238Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19239variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19240deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19241at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19242other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19243never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19244and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19245.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19246.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19247.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19248
19249
19250
19251
19252
19253
19254
19255. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19256. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19257
19258.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19259.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19260.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19261.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19262The following generic options apply to all transports:
19263
19264
19265.option body_only transports boolean false
19266.cindex "transport" "body only"
19267.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19268.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19269If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19270mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19271or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19272&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19273automatically suppress them.
19274
19275
19276.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19277.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19278This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19279transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19280If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19281logged, and delivery is deferred.
19282
19283
19284.option disable_logging transports boolean false
19285If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19286deliveries by the transport or for any
19287transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19288what you are doing.
19289
19290
19291.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19292.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19293If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19294option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19295transport is run.
19296If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19297output, and Exim carries on processing.
19298This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19299so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19300option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19301variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19302one.
19303
19304
19305.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19306.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19307If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19308This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19309header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19310requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19311safely be resent to other recipients.
19312
19313
19314.option driver transports string unset
19315This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19316There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19317
19318
19319.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19320.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19321If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19322This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19323delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19324configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19325address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19326header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19327its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19328resent to other recipients.
19329
19330
19331.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19332.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19333This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19334value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19335&%user%& (see below).
19336
19337
19338.option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19339.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19340.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19341This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19342portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19343&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19344routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19345is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19346errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19347
19348
19349
19350.option headers_only transports boolean false
19351.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19352.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19353.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19354If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19355exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19356transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19357checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19358
19359
19360.option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19361.cindex "header lines" "removing"
19362.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19363This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19364these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19365in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19366routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19367is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19368errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19369
19370
19371
19372.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19373.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19374.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19375This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19376that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19377option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19378the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19379message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19380example,
19381.code
19382headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19383 x@y w@z
19384.endd
19385changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19386&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19387header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19388only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19389the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19390filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19391affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19392envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19393change envelope recipients at this time.
19394
19395
19396.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19397.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19398.vindex "&$home$&"
19399This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19400overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19401placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19402used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19403&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19404&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19405for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19406deferred.
19407
19408
19409.option initgroups transports boolean false
19410.cindex "additional groups"
19411.cindex "groups" "additional"
19412.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19413If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19414transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19415to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19416
19417
19418.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19419.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19420.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19421.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19422This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19423expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19424digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19425including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19426delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19427message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19428the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19429ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19430&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19431delivered.
19432
19433
19434
19435.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19436.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19437.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19438.cindex "local part" "prefix"
19439.cindex "local part" "suffix"
19440When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19441affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19442form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19443that contains
19444.code
19445local_part_prefix = *-
19446.endd
19447routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19448is delivered with
19449.code
19450RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19451.endd
19452This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19453recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19454whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19455deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19456&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19457
19458
19459.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19460.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19461When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19462in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19463is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19464deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19465part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19466temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19467deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19468
19469However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19470as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19471(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19472this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19473
19474For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19475the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19476on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19477
19478
19479.option return_path transports string&!! unset
19480.cindex "envelope sender"
19481.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19482.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19483If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19484the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19485that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19486designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19487SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19488only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19489header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19490
19491&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19492&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19493
19494.vindex "&$return_path$&"
19495The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19496either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19497&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19498replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19499option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19500section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19501
19502&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19503remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19504the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19505This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19506&%errors_to%& in a router.
19507
19508
19509
19510.option return_path_add transports boolean false
19511.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19512If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19513Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19514mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19515have easy access to it.
19516
19517RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19518the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19519header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19520option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19521incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19522recipients.
19523
19524
19525.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19526See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19527
19528
19529.option shadow_transport transports string unset
19530.cindex "shadow transport"
19531.cindex "transport" "shadow"
19532A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19533another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19534
19535Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19536&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19537string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19538passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19539expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19540cause a log line to be written.
19541
19542The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19543subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19544provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19545is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19546ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19547of the form
19548.code
19549ST=<shadow transport name>
19550.endd
19551If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19552parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19553purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19554provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19555headers that some sites insist on.
19556
19557
19558.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19559.cindex "transport" "filter"
19560.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19561This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19562at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19563individual users or via a system filter.
19564
19565When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19566&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19567the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19568input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19569command must be specified as an absolute path.
19570
19571The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19572terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19573SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19574lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19575settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19576&(pipe)& transports.
19577
19578The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19579standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19580destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19581filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19582are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19583
19584The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19585care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19586test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19587SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19588
19589.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19590A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19591at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19592message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19593a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19594not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19595
19596.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19597A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19598being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19599support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19600at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19601more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19602the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19603additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19604
19605.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19606The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19607the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19608parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19609Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19610section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19611to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19612of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19613an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19614&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19615
19616.vindex "&$host$&"
19617.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19618The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19619transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19620which the message is being sent. For example:
19621.code
19622transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19623 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19624.endd
19625
19626Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19627generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19628command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19629.ilist
19630If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19631part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19632expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19633example:
19634.code
19635transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19636.endd
19637This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19638&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19639stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19640the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19641&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19642Exim tried to expand the first one.
19643.next
19644Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19645expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19646arguments. Consider this example:
19647.code
19648transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19649 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19650.endd
19651The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19652if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19653.code
19654transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19655 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19656.endd
19657.endlist
19658
19659The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19660For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19661normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19662A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19663serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19664the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19665bounced from a transport filter.
19666
19667If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19668passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19669message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19670
19671
19672.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19673.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19674When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19675that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19676temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19677&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19678way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19679error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19680becomes a temporary error.
19681
19682
19683.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19684.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19685.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19686This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19687run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19688given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19689associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19690option is not set.
19691
19692For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19693specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19694&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19695
19696.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19697For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19698sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19699to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19700retry data.
19701.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19702.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19703.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19704
19705
19706
19707
19708
19709
19710. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19711. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19712
19713.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19714 "Address batching"
19715.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19716The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19717one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19718remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19719normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19720transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19721copy of the message is delivered each time.
19722
19723.cindex "batched local delivery"
19724.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19725.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19726In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19727local transport, for example:
19728
19729.ilist
19730In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19731delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19732recipients saves space.
19733.next
19734In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19735a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19736.next
19737In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19738to a scanner program or
19739to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19740acceptable.
19741.endlist
19742
19743These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19744(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19745repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19746
19747The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19748delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19749(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19750&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19751(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19752to certain conditions:
19753
19754.ilist
19755.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19756If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19757batching is possible.
19758.next
19759.vindex "&$domain$&"
19760If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19761addresses with the same domain are batched.
19762.next
19763.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19764If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19765addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19766customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19767including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19768from taking place.
19769.next
19770Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19771delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19772group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19773be the same.
19774.endlist
19775
19776In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19777both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19778is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19779course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19780option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19781&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19782&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19783.code
19784check_string = "."
19785escape_string = ".."
19786.endd
19787when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19788given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19789&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19790
19791.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19792If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19793&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19794that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19795transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19796addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19797
19798.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19799.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19800If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19801transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19802the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19803of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19804argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19805delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19806are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19807
19808
19809
19810
19811. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19812. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19813
19814.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19815.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19816.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19817.cindex "directory creation"
19818.cindex "creating directories"
19819The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19820file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19821files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19822format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19823University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19824being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19825to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19826delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19827supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19828directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19829
19830The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19831default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19832SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19833included.
19834
19835.cindex "quota" "system"
19836Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19837also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19838system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19839
19840If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19841partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19842modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19843creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19844
19845Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19846file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19847private options.
19848
19849The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19850users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19851putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19852&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19853option).
19854
19855
19856
19857.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19858The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19859the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19860the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19861normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19862
19863.vindex "&$address_file$&"
19864.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19865However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19866directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19867forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19868user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19869the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19870name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19871operation. There are two cases:
19872
19873.ilist
19874If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19875must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19876common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19877different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19878default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19879name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19880&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19881.next
19882If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19883used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19884contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19885.endlist
19886
19887
19888.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19889.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19890As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19891have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19892form:
19893.code
19894save folder23
19895.endd
19896or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19897.code
19898require "fileinto";
19899fileinto "folder23";
19900.endd
19901In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19902must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19903case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19904is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19905way of handling this requirement:
19906.code
19907file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19908 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19909 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19910 {$address_file} \
19911 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19912 }} \
19913 }
19914.endd
19915With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19916location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19917&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19918
19919&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19920&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19921the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19922you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19923&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19924path to the transport.
19925
19926&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19927the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19928
19929
19930
19931
19932.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19933.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19934
19935
19936
19937.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19938.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19939.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19940.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19941Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19942regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19943delivery is deferred.
19944
19945
19946.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19947.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19948.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19949By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19950that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19951are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19952what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19953are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19954
19955
19956.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19957See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19958However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19959happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19960file.
19961
19962
19963.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19964See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19965
19966
19967.option check_group appendfile boolean false
19968When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19969option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19970delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19971file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19972
19973
19974.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19975When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19976is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19977process is running.
19978
19979
19980.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19981.cindex "&""From""& line"
19982As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19983matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19984replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19985a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19986contains is significant.
19987
19988If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19989are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19990configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19991&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19992&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19993
19994The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19995suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19996&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19997if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19998.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19999.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20000.code
20001check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20002escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20003message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20004message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20005.endd
20006.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20007.cindex "directory creation"
20008When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20009directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20010is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20011
20012The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20013operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20014example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20015is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20016in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20017
20018
20019
20020.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20021This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20022by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20023directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20024delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20025beneath.
20026
20027The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20028&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20029set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20030given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20031names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20032by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20033&%file_must_exist%&.
20034
20035
20036.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20037This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20038or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20039redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20040
20041When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20042into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20043appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20044(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20045&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20046
20047
20048.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20049.cindex "base62"
20050.vindex "&$inode$&"
20051When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20052&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20053whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20054.code
20055q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20056.endd
20057This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20058inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20059option.
20060
20061
20062.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20063If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20064&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20065
20066
20067.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20068See &%check_string%& above.
20069
20070
20071.option file appendfile string&!! unset
20072This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20073&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20074of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20075specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20076&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20077&%file%&.
20078
20079.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20080.cindex "locking files"
20081.cindex "lock files"
20082If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20083mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20084
20085The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20086path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20087examples:
20088.code
20089file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20090file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20091file = $home/inbox
20092.endd
20093.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20094In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20095is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20096create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20097deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20098run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20099
20100
20101
20102.option file_format appendfile string unset
20103.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20104This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20105before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20106start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20107colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20108second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20109string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20110transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20111this added to it:
20112.code
20113file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20114 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20115.endd
20116Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20117a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20118to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20119to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20120is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20121match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20122delivery is deferred.
20123
20124
20125.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20126If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20127A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20128If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20129
20130
20131.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20132.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20133.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20134.cindex "locking files"
20135By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20136when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20137sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20138Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20139for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20140deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20141mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20142misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20143
20144On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20145not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20146is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20147and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20148
20149If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20150timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20151retries is
20152.code
20153(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20154.endd
20155rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20156which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20157&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20158
20159You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20160local deliveries because of errors of the form
20161.code
20162failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20163.endd
20164
20165.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20166This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20167&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20168&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20169
20170
20171.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20172This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20173for details of locking.
20174
20175
20176.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20177This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20178is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20179
20180
20181.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20182This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20183used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20184
20185
20186.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20187.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20188When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20189exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20190accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20191
20192
20193.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20194.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20195.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20196If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20197number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20198followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20199external source that maintains the data.
20200
20201
20202.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20203.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20204.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20205If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20206size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20207This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20208maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20209it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20210
20211
20212
20213.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20214.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20215If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20216file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20217transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20218&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20219&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20220directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20221SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20222&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20223
20224
20225.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20226.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20227.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20228This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20229a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20230directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20231calculation. The default value is:
20232.code
20233maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20234.endd
20235This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20236(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20237&_Trash_&
20238folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20239.code
20240maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20241.endd
20242This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20243directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20244calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20245directly into that directory.
20246
20247
20248.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20249This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20250&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20251
20252
20253.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20254This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20255section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20256
20257
20258.new
20259.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20260.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20261The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20262If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20263creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20264quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20265value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20266&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20267.wen
20268
20269.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20270.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20271.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20272The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20273effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20274matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20275containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20276delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20277&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20278See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20279
20280
20281.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20282.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20283If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20284new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20285SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20286below for further details.
20287
20288
20289.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20290This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20291section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20292
20293
20294.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20295This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20296section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20297
20298
20299.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20300.cindex "locking files"
20301.cindex "file" "locking"
20302.cindex "file" "MBX format"
20303.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20304This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20305set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20306the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20307traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20308IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20309
20310&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20311automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20312empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20313combination:
20314.code
20315mbx_format = true
20316message_prefix =
20317message_suffix =
20318.endd
20319If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20320&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20321is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20322&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20323interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20324should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20325going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20326mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20327
20328If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20329the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20330(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20331append messages to it.
20332
20333
20334.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20335.cindex "&""From""& line"
20336The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20337The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20338in which case it is:
20339.code
20340message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20341 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20342.endd
20343&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20344&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20345
20346.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20347The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20348The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20349in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20350setting
20351.code
20352message_suffix =
20353.endd
20354&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20355&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20356
20357.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20358If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20359has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20360permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20361if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20362a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20363value, and this option is ignored.
20364
20365
20366.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20367This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20368mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20369true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20370continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20371
20372
20373.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20374If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20375successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20376on users about incoming mail.
20377
20378
20379.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20380.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20381This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20382or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20383is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20384all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20385individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20386&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20387have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20388
20389As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20390multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20391For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20392
20393A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20394may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20395If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20396become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20397Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20398the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20399
20400The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20401(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20402for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20403large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20404be handled.
20405
20406&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20407
20408The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20409the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20410be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20411fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20412system quota failures.
20413
20414By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20415mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20416last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20417during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20418refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20419message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20420changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20421for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20422continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20423delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20424
20425
20426.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20427This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20428into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20429called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20430delivery directory.
20431
20432
20433.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20434This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20435number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20436can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20437failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20438&"no quota"&.
20439
20440
20441.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20442See &%quota%& above.
20443
20444
20445.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20446This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20447for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20448these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20449If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20450captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20451file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20452
20453This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20454&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20455facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20456the file length to the file name. For example:
20457.code
20458maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20459quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20460.endd
20461An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20462number of lines in the message.
20463
20464The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20465file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20466sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20467
20468Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20469
20470
20471.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20472See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20473&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20474.code
20475quota_warn_message = "\
20476 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20477 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20478 This message is automatically created \
20479 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20480 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20481 a warning threshold that is\n\
20482 set by the system administrator.\n"
20483.endd
20484
20485
20486.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20487.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20488.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20489.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20490This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20491resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20492size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20493threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20494may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20495sign. For example:
20496.code
20497quota = 10M
20498quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20499.endd
20500If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20501percent sign is ignored.
20502
20503The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20504and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20505warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20506the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20507can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20508&'From:'& line, the default is:
20509.code
20510From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20511.endd
20512.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20513If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20514option.
20515
20516The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20517are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20518percentage.
20519
20520
20521.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20522.cindex "envelope sender"
20523If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20524format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20525you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20526so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20527for details of batch SMTP.
20528
20529
20530.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20531.cindex "carriage return"
20532.cindex "linefeed"
20533This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20534(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20535of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20536of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20537
20538&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20539(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20540in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20541carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20542have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20543changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20544
20545
20546.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20547This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20548exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20549&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20550that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20551&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20552
20553
20554.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20555This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20556the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20557&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20558each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20559
20560This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20561&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20562where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20563both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20564
20565.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20566Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20567have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20568&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20569the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20570error.
20571
20572&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20573is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20574
20575
20576.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20577If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20578appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20579&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20580sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20581&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20582delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20583
20584.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20585In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20586necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20587achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20588file corruption.
20589
20590The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20591It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20592except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20593
20594
20595.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20596This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20597set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20598locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20599of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20600are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20601the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20602rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20603does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20604
20605You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20606&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20607MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20608without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20609
20610
20611
20612
20613.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20614.cindex "appending to a file"
20615.cindex "file" "appending"
20616Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20617
20618.ilist
20619If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20620return is given.
20621
20622.next
20623.cindex "directory creation"
20624If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20625&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20626&%directory_mode%& option.
20627
20628.next
20629If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20630indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20631transport.
20632
20633.next
20634.cindex "file" "locking"
20635.cindex "locking files"
20636.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20637If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20638reliably over NFS, as follows:
20639
20640.olist
20641Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20642current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20643as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20644.next
20645Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20646.next
20647If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20648Unlink the hitching post name.
20649.next
20650Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20651then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20652of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20653restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20654.next
20655If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20656up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20657mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20658lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20659existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20660it before trying again.
20661.endlist olist
20662
20663.next
20664A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20665so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20666than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20667
20668.next
20669.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20670.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20671If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20672&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20673checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20674is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20675ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20676directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20677idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20678checked.
20679
20680.next
20681If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20682and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20683different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20684delivery is deferred.
20685
20686.next
20687If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20688If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20689is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20690permissions.
20691
20692.next
20693The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20694If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20695hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20696
20697.next
20698If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20699changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20700have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20701
20702.next
20703If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20704option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20705directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20706open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20707except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20708set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20709the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20710that prevents link following.
20711
20712.next
20713.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20714If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20715existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20716being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20717after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20718
20719.next
20720If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20721
20722.next
20723.cindex "file" "locking"
20724.cindex "locking files"
20725Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20726are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20727&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20728However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20729file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20730.code
20731/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20732.endd
20733using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20734the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20735the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20736
20737If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20738depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20739&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20740
20741If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20742&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20743to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20744delivery is deferred.
20745
20746If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20747&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20748waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20749immediately. It retries up to
20750.code
20751(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20752.endd
20753times (rounded up).
20754.endlist
20755
20756At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20757and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20758
20759
20760.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20761.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20762.cindex "&""From""& line"
20763When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20764delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20765activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20766&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20767router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20768configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20769ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20770
20771No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20772locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20773separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20774of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20775newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20776&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20777any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20778
20779If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20780the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20781different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20782deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20783
20784
20785.cindex "maildir format"
20786.cindex "mailstore format"
20787There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20788done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20789&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20790formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20791SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20792
20793.cindex "directory creation"
20794In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20795sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20796option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20797constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20798the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20799&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20800deferred.
20801
20802
20803
20804.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20805.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20806If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20807it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20808directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20809directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20810&_new_& subdirectory.
20811
20812In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20813<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20814Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20815before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20816file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20817opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20818Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20819
20820Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20821called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20822do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20823path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20824&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20825contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20826&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20827&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20828
20829These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20830and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20831folders. Consider this example:
20832.code
20833maildir_format = true
20834directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20835 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20836 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20837maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20838.endd
20839If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20840delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20841the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20842not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20843&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20844&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20845
20846However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20847delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20848does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20849&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20850directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20851
20852&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20853not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20854&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20855
20856.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20857.cindex "maildir++"
20858If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20859&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20860the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20861Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20862down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20863the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20864amount of space used.
20865
20866One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20867computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20868checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20869needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20870use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20871of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20872
20873
20874
20875
20876.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20877If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20878When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20879tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20880name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20881the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20882
20883
20884.vindex "&$message_size$&"
20885Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20886&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20887happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20888variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20889forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20890be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20891Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20892empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20893colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
20894maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
20895backwards compatibility).
20896
20897For one common implementation, you might set:
20898.code
20899maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
20900.endd
20901but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
20902
20903It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
20904as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
20905&[stat()]& each message file.
20906
20907
20908.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20909.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20910.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20911If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20912storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20913within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20914creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20915the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20916to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20917
20918The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20919messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20920in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20921value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20922is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20923need to know the quota.
20924
20925If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20926file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20927
20928A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20929maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20930See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20931details.
20932
20933
20934.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20935.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20936If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20937files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20938message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20939this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20940contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20941itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20942
20943During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20944&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20945&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20946mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20947file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20948the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20949
20950The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20951option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20952the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20953There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20954greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20955appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20956
20957If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20958failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20959configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20960&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20961
20962
20963.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20964If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20965file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20966messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20967section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20968.code
20969directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20970.endd
20971might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20972then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20973expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20974.ecindex IIDapptra1
20975.ecindex IIDapptra2
20976
20977
20978
20979
20980
20981
20982. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20983. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20984
20985.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20986.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20987.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20988The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20989the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20990automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20991&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20992to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20993
20994If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20995&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20996delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20997that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20998another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20999
21000
21001The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21002&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21003directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21004message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21005empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21006
21007The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21008by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21009passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21010transport is run as a consequence of a
21011&%mail%&
21012or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21013supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21014that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21015case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21016is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21017&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21018
21019&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21020command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21021gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21022&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21023
21024There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21025that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21026&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21027address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21028separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21029the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21030message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21031
21032Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21033message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21034immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21035the transport defers.
21036Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21037controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21038
21039If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21040&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21041of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21042&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21043
21044.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21045If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21046the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21047as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21048is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21049problems. They are just discarded.
21050
21051
21052
21053.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21054.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21055
21056.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21057This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21058message when the message is specified by the transport.
21059
21060
21061.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21062This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21063when the message is specified by the transport.
21064
21065
21066.option file autoreply string&!! unset
21067The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21068is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21069string comes first.
21070
21071
21072.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21073If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21074subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21075
21076
21077.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21078If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21079option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21080
21081
21082.option from autoreply string&!! unset
21083This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21084specified by the transport.
21085
21086
21087.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21088This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21089when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21090&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21091
21092
21093.option log autoreply string&!! unset
21094This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21095the message is specified by the transport.
21096
21097
21098.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21099If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21100used.
21101
21102
21103.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21104If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21105item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21106discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21107generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21108
21109
21110
21111.option once autoreply string&!! unset
21112This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21113recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21114This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21115
21116If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21117By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21118is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21119However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21120message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21121this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21122prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21123infinity.
21124
21125If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21126and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21127greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21128Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21129regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21130
21131In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21132which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21133be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21134means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21135unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21136file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21137
21138
21139.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21140See &%once%& above.
21141
21142
21143.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21144See &%once%& above.
21145After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21146
21147
21148.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21149This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21150specified by the transport.
21151
21152
21153.option return_message autoreply boolean false
21154If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21155message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21156configuration option.
21157
21158
21159.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21160This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21161specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21162automatic responses. For example:
21163.code
21164subject = Re: $h_subject:
21165.endd
21166There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21167subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21168bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21169non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21170small.
21171
21172
21173
21174.option text autoreply string&!! unset
21175This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21176message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21177the text comes first.
21178
21179
21180.option to autoreply string&!! unset
21181This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21182when the message is specified by the transport.
21183.ecindex IIDauttra1
21184.ecindex IIDauttra2
21185
21186
21187
21188
21189. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21190. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21191
21192.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21193.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21194.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21195.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21196.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21197The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21198specified command
21199or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21200This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21201transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21202implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21203to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21204has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21205.code
21206TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
21207.endd
21208.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21209is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21210included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21211as follows:
21212
21213.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21214See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21215
21216
21217.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21218This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21219Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21220good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21221batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21222
21223
21224.option command lmtp string&!! unset
21225This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21226is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21227arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21228number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21229is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21230LMTP protocol.
21231
21232.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21233.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21234If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21235commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21236in its response to the LHLO command.
21237
21238.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21239This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21240be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21241delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21242
21243
21244.option timeout lmtp time 5m
21245The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21246respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21247is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21248LMTP transport:
21249.code
21250lmtp:
21251 driver = lmtp
21252 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21253 batch_max = 20
21254 user = exim
21255.endd
21256This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21257necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21258
21259
21260
21261. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21262. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21263
21264.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21265.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21266.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21267The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21268running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21269pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21270(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21271their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21272following ways:
21273
21274.ilist
21275.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21276A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21277transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21278contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21279is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21280.next
21281.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21282If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21283transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21284more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21285(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21286(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21287that are routed to the transport.
21288.next
21289.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21290A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21291alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21292pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
21293one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
21294only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
21295the local part that was redirected.
21296.endlist
21297
21298
21299The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21300deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21301implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21302
21303In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21304&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21305other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21306transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21307directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21308details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21309for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21310
21311
21312.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21313If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21314delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21315any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21316write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21317
21318
21319
21320
21321.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21322.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21323If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21324have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21325the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21326in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21327later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21328logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21329&"local delivery failed"&.
21330
21331If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21332the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21333will be sent as normal.
21334
21335If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21336script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21337value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21338apply in this case.
21339
21340If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21341return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21342asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21343a non-existent command may be the problem.
21344
21345The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21346set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21347error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21348return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21349included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21350similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21351failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21352&%temp_errors%&.
21353
21354
21355
21356.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21357.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21358The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21359by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21360&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21361run.
21362
21363.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21364Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21365double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21366way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21367
21368String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21369traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21370expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21371For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21372quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21373.code
21374command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21375.endd
21376will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21377arguments. You have to write
21378.code
21379command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21380.endd
21381to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21382argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21383result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21384interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21385generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21386expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21387example:
21388.code
21389command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21390.endd
21391
21392.cindex "transport" "filter"
21393.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21394.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21395Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21396&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21397place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21398transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21399inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21400avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21401&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21402
21403After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21404in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21405message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21406standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21407read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21408may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21409control what is done with it.
21410
21411Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21412in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21413taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21414explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21415where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21416under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21417an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21418works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21419as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21420&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21421with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21422
21423
21424
21425.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21426.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21427.cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21428The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21429This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21430the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21431environment.
21432.display
21433&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21434&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21435&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21436&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21437&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21438&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21439&`LOGNAME `& see below
21440&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21441&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21442&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21443&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21444&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21445&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21446&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21447&`USER `& see below
21448.endd
21449When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21450router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21451called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21452the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21453removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21454LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21455same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21456
21457.cindex "HOST"
21458HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21459associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21460pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21461the router.
21462
21463.cindex "HOME"
21464If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21465for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21466by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21467user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21468
21469
21470.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21471.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21472
21473
21474
21475.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21476.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21477The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21478permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21479permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21480paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21481&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21482in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21483the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21484&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21485otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21486example, if
21487.code
21488allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21489.endd
21490and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21491&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21492&%use_shell%& is set.
21493
21494
21495.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21496See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21497
21498
21499.option batch_max pipe integer 1
21500This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21501See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21502
21503
21504.option check_string pipe string unset
21505As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21506&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21507by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21508&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21509any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21510of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21511the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21512ignored.
21513
21514
21515.option command pipe string&!! unset
21516This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21517obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21518set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21519the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21520Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21521&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21522
21523
21524.option environment pipe string&!! unset
21525.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21526.cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21527This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21528command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21529a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21530environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21531
21532
21533.option escape_string pipe string unset
21534See &%check_string%& above.
21535
21536
21537.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21538.cindex "exec failure"
21539.cindex "failure of exec"
21540.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21541Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21542any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21543is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21544frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21545
21546
21547.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21548.cindex "signal exit"
21549.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21550Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21551a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21552frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21553
21554
21555.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21556If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21557run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21558Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21559from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21560&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21561
21562&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21563See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21564
21565.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21566.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21567If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21568one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21569and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21570
21571
21572.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21573If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21574return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21575&%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21576written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21577Only one of them may be set.
21578
21579
21580
21581.option log_output pipe boolean false
21582If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21583output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21584&%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21585
21586
21587
21588.option max_output pipe integer 20K
21589This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21590standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21591process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21592catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21593the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21594&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21595exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21596
21597
21598.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21599The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21600The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21601.code
21602message_prefix = \
21603 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21604 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
21605.endd
21606.cindex "Cyrus"
21607.cindex "&%tmail%&"
21608.cindex "&""From""& line"
21609This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21610However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21611or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21612setting
21613.code
21614message_prefix =
21615.endd
21616&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21617&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21618
21619
21620.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21621The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21622The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21623The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21624.code
21625message_suffix =
21626.endd
21627&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21628&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21629
21630
21631.option path pipe string "see below"
21632This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21633variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21634.code
21635/bin:/usr/bin
21636.endd
21637If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21638sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21639apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21640
21641
21642.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21643Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21644a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21645during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21646It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21647for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21648resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21649installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21650of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21651
21652
21653.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21654.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21655If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21656process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21657to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21658&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21659accept the message is used.
21660
21661
21662.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21663When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21664contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21665in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21666command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21667handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21668
21669
21670.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21671If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21672return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21673is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21674However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21675message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21676&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21677
21678
21679
21680.option return_output pipe boolean false
21681If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21682deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21683is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21684However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21685output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21686option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21687of them may be set.
21688
21689
21690
21691.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21692.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21693This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21694asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21695and &%return_output%& is not set,
21696and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21697temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21698numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21699codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21700defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21701compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21702and 73, respectively.
21703
21704
21705.option timeout pipe time 1h
21706If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21707causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21708specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21709command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21710and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21711if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21712
21713.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21714A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21715runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21716treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21717is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21718delivery to be deferred.
21719
21720.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21721This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21722
21723
21724.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21725.cindex "envelope sender"
21726If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21727SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21728commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21729you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21730&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21731
21732.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21733.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21734This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21735BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21736resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21737limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21738class database.
21739
21740
21741.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21742.cindex "carriage return"
21743.cindex "linefeed"
21744This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21745(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21746of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21747of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21748
21749The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21750written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21751are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21752&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21753values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21754
21755
21756.option use_shell pipe boolean false
21757.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21758If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21759instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21760&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21761where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21762modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21763&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21764command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21765its &%-c%& option.
21766
21767
21768
21769.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21770.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21771.cindex "&'procmail'&"
21772.cindex "external local delivery"
21773.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21774.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21775The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21776delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21777this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21778uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21779by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21780necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21781appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21782configuration for &%procmail%&:
21783.code
21784# transport
21785procmail_pipe:
21786 driver = pipe
21787 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21788 return_path_add
21789 delivery_date_add
21790 envelope_to_add
21791 check_string = "From "
21792 escape_string = ">From "
21793 umask = 077
21794 user = $local_part
21795 group = mail
21796
21797# router
21798procmail:
21799 driver = accept
21800 check_local_user
21801 transport = procmail_pipe
21802.endd
21803In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21804&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21805or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21806user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21807&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21808home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21809
21810&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21811.code
21812IFS=" "
21813.endd
21814as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21815use a shell to run pipe commands.
21816
21817.cindex "Cyrus"
21818The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21819deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21820.code
21821# transport
21822local_delivery_cyrus:
21823 driver = pipe
21824 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21825 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21826 user = cyrus
21827 group = mail
21828 return_output
21829 log_output
21830 message_prefix =
21831 message_suffix =
21832
21833# router
21834local_user_cyrus:
21835 driver = accept
21836 check_local_user
21837 local_part_suffix = .*
21838 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21839.endd
21840Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21841&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21842sender.
21843.ecindex IIDpiptra1
21844.ecindex IIDpiptra2
21845
21846
21847. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21848. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21849
21850.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21851.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21852.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21853The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21854or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21855that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21856explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21857&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21858
21859
21860.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21861The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21862two ways:
21863
21864.ilist
21865If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21866routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21867that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21868the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21869does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21870value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21871section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21872.next
21873.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21874When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21875looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21876connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21877for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21878process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21879process.
21880.endlist
21881
21882
21883For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21884incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21885no further messages are sent over that connection.
21886
21887
21888
21889.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21890.vindex "&$host$&"
21891.vindex "&$host_address$&"
21892At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21893&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21894passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21895specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21896&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21897that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21898&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21899
21900
21901.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21902.vindex &$tls_bits$&
21903.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21904.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21905.vindex &$tls_sni$&
21906At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
21907&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
21908are the values that were set when the message was received.
21909These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21910SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
21911variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21912appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21913are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21914&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21915
21916
21917.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21918.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21919The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21920
21921
21922.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21923.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21924When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21925is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21926runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21927reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21928setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21929problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21930
21931.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21932.cindex "local host" "sending to"
21933.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21934When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21935to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21936deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21937the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21938configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21939configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21940
21941
21942.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21943.cindex "Cyrus"
21944When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21945is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21946overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21947forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21948to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21949ignored.
21950
21951The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21952started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21953&$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21954particular connection.
21955
21956If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21957&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21958deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21959unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21960
21961This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21962deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21963&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21964.code
21965authenticated_sender = $local_part
21966.endd
21967This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21968allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21969
21970Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21971domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21972value.
21973
21974
21975.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21976If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21977is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21978authenticated as a client.
21979
21980
21981.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21982This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21983sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21984remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21985
21986
21987.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21988This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21989to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21990several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21991less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21992systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21993option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21994
21995
21996.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21997.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21998.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21999.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22000This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22001over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22002For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22003option.
22004
22005
22006.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22007This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22008the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22009of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22010
22011
22012.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22013This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22014domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22015cutoff times.
22016
22017In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22018them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22019Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22020retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22021a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22022unhappy at this prospect, so...
22023
22024If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22025addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22026IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22027none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22028delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22029addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22030continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22031&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22032to them.
22033
22034
22035.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22036If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22037and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22038the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22039in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22040
22041
22042.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22043If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22044&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22045See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22046details.
22047
22048
22049
22050.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22051.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22052String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22053colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22054port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22055&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22056item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22057in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22058
22059Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22060addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22061&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22062not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22063&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22064However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22065
22066If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22067the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22068transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22069address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22070list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22071
22072Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22073re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22074addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22075copy of the message is sent.
22076
22077The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22078&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22079both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22080from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22081fails"& facility.
22082
22083
22084.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22085This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22086line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22087zero.
22088
22089.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22090If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22091being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22092(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22093instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22094it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22095
22096.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22097This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22098server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22099implementations of TLS.
22100
22101.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22102.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22103.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22104.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22105The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22106been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22107command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22108option is:
22109.code
22110$primary_hostname
22111.endd
22112During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22113the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22114&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22115used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22116servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22117that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22118interface address, you could use this:
22119.code
22120helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22121 {$primary_hostname}}
22122.endd
22123The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22124callouts.
22125
22126.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22127Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22128finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22129&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22130email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22131all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22132
22133The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22134processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22135&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22136&%hosts_override%& is set.
22137
22138The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22139list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22140separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22141&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22142item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22143in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22144of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22145
22146If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22147the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22148well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22149address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22150&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22151&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22152that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22153address are used.
22154
22155During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22156unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22157
22158
22159.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22160.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22161.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22162.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22163.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22164This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22165example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22166matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22167start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22168facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22169
22170
22171.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22172.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22173Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22174that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22175
22176
22177.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22178.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22179Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22180matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22181
22182
22183.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22184.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22185.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22186.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22187.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22188This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22189delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22190&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22191
22192
22193.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22194This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22195tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22196why it exists.
22197
22198
22199
22200.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22201.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22202.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22203.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22204For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22205been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22206message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22207explanation of when this might be needed.
22208
22209
22210.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22211If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22212attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22213&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22214&%fallback_hosts%&.
22215
22216
22217.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22218.cindex "randomized host list"
22219.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22220.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22221If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22222&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22223were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22224router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22225is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22226list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22227
22228When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22229order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22230behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22231&`+`& in the host list. For example:
22232.code
22233hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22234.endd
22235The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22236randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22237If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22238
22239.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22240.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22241This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22242before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22243servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22244authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22245temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22246hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22247&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22248
22249
22250.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22251.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22252Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22253matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22254&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22255incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22256
22257.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22258.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22259This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22260authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22261connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22262unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22263&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22264
22265.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22266.cindex "bind IP address"
22267.cindex "IP address" "binding"
22268.vindex "&$host$&"
22269.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22270This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22271call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22272&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22273message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22274&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22275outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22276interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22277unknown.
22278
22279During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22280&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22281during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22282string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22283string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22284separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22285.code
22286interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22287.endd
22288The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22289connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22290&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22291interface to use if the host has more than one.
22292
22293
22294.option keepalive smtp boolean true
22295.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22296This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22297connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22298periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22299of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22300or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22301that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22302that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22303TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22304unreachable hosts.
22305
22306
22307.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22308.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22309If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22310string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22311has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22312
22313.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22314.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22315This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22316SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22317so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22318permits this.
22319
22320
22321.option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22322.vindex "&$domain$&"
22323When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22324addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22325to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22326handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22327&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22328is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22329
22330
22331.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22332.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22333.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22334This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22335&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22336received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22337The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22338variable that contains an outgoing port.
22339
22340If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22341otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22342normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22343&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22344is deferred.
22345
22346
22347
22348.option protocol smtp string smtp
22349.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22350.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22351.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22352.vindex "&$port$&"
22353If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22354the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22355protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22356deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22357over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22358
22359.new
22360If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22361changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22362connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22363The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22364.wen
22365
22366
22367.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22368Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22369constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22370means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22371tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22372addresses is not affected.
22373
22374However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22375each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22376the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22377Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22378instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22379hosts.
22380
22381
22382.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22383.cindex "serializing connections"
22384.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22385Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22386host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22387the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22388slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22389Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22390&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22391
22392.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22393Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22394written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22395is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22396records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22397guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22398
22399If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22400relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22401start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22402may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22403are used for ETRN serialization.
22404
22405
22406.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22407.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22408.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22409.cindex "size" "of message"
22410.cindex "transport" "filter"
22411.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22412If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22413MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22414an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22415sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22416configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22417this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22418
22419Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22420the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22421
22422
22423.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22424.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22425.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22426.vindex "&$host$&"
22427.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22428The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22429client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22430connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22431address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22432details of TLS.
22433
22434&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22435certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22436name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22437assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22438client.
22439
22440
22441.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22442.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22443.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22444This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22445be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22446
22447
22448.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22449.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22450.vindex "&$host$&"
22451.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22452The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22453client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22454connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22455&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22456expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22457result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22458the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22459
22460
22461.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22462.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22463.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22464.vindex "&$host$&"
22465.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22466The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22467when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22468the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22469&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22470expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22471is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22472&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22473ciphers is a preference order.
22474
22475
22476
22477.new
22478.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22479.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22480.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22481If this option is set then it sets the $tls_sni variable and causes any
22482TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22483the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22484certificate and private key for the session.
22485
22486See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22487
22488OpenSSL only, also requiring a build of OpenSSL that supports TLS extensions.
22489.wen
22490
22491
22492
22493.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22494.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22495When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22496setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22497to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22498current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22499option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22500response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22501TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22502unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22503in clear.
22504
22505
22506.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22507.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22508.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22509.vindex "&$host$&"
22510.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22511The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22512permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22513Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22514&%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22515files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22516single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22517&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22518expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22519
22520
22521
22522
22523.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22524 "SECTvalhosmax"
22525.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22526.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22527There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22528tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22529&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22530
22531
22532The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22533for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22534option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22535multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22536retrying.
22537
22538Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22539multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22540created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22541
22542Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22543several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22544problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22545&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22546delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22547
22548Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22549arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22550limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22551some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22552&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22553that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22554see below for an exception).
22555
22556Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22557list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22558If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22559but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22560that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22561
22562Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22563higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22564hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22565which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22566tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22567reached their retry times.
22568
22569However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22570large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22571Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22572of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22573time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22574without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22575all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22576there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22577the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22578every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22579reached.
22580
22581The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22582particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22583out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22584reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22585been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22586take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22587
22588The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22589Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22590and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22591possible IP addresses have been tried.
22592.ecindex IIDsmttra1
22593.ecindex IIDsmttra2
22594
22595
22596
22597
22598
22599. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22600. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22601
22602.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22603.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22604There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22605addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22606(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22607abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22608
22609Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22610messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22611&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22612appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22613locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22614unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22615lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22616
22617One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22618when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22619such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22620do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22621
22622
22623.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22624This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22625main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22626&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22627
22628Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22629Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22630facility; you do not have to use it.
22631
22632The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22633configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22634addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22635address to which it applies.
22636
22637Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22638the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22639rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22640those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22641by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22642are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22643rules.
22644
22645Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22646applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22647well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22648headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22649
22650
22651In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22652legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22653in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22654used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22655Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22656discouraged.
22657
22658There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22659illustrated by these examples:
22660
22661.ilist
22662The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22663exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22664gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22665&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22666.next
22667A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22668&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22669.endlist
22670
22671
22672
22673.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22674.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22675.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22676Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22677message's processing.
22678
22679.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22680At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22681by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22682ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22683is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22684rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22685rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22686RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22687rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22688
22689.vindex "&$domain$&"
22690.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22691Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22692may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22693rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22694from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22695for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22696value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22697as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22698SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22699
22700As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22701recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22702the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22703any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22704.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22705before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22706
22707When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22708rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22709redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22710
22711.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22712.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22713.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22714At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22715specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22716This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22717section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22718header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22719applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22720
22721The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22722transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22723transport time.
22724
22725
22726
22727
22728.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22729.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22730.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22731Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22732configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22733&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
227342822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22735transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22736appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22737envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22738.code
22739exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22740.endd
22741might produce the output
22742.code
22743sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22744from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22745to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22746cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22747bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22748reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22749env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22750env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22751.endd
22752which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22753the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22754present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22755set for a particular transport.
22756
22757
22758.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22759.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22760The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22761rules in the form
22762.display
22763<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22764.endd
22765Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22766transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22767takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22768any colons must be doubled, of course).
22769
22770The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22771Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22772case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22773characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22774ignored.
22775
22776For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22777order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22778replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22779
22780The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22781releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22782received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22783lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22784address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22785(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22786that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22787
22788.vindex "&$domain$&"
22789.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22790The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22791string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22792rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22793.code
22794*@* ${lookup ...
22795.endd
22796where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22797refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22798
22799
22800.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22801.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22802.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22803The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22804address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22805single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22806against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22807you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22808facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22809
22810Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22811case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22812can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22813
22814.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22815After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22816depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22817replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22818refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22819numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22820of pattern they are set as follows:
22821
22822.ilist
22823If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22824refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22825the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22826pattern
22827.code
22828*queen@*.fict.example
22829.endd
22830is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22831.code
22832$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22833$1 = hearts-
22834$2 = wonderland
22835.endd
22836Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22837does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22838
22839.next
22840If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22841of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22842for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22843rewriting rule of the form
22844.display
22845&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22846.endd
22847and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22848.code
22849$1 = foo
22850$2 = bar
22851$3 = baz.example
22852.endd
22853If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22854wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22855&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22856partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22857whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22858.endlist
22859
22860
22861.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22862.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22863If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22864match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22865rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22866.code
22867hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22868.endd
22869specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22870&'From:'& headers.
22871
22872.vindex "&$domain$&"
22873.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22874If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22875yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22876&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22877Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22878cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22879matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22880the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22881current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22882expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22883entry written to the panic log.
22884
22885
22886
22887.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22888There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22889
22890.ilist
22891Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22892c, f, h, r, s, t.
22893.next
22894A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22895.next
22896Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22897.endlist
22898
22899For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22900E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22901
22902
22903
22904.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22905 "SECID154"
22906.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22907If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22908&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22909and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22910transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22911rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22912.display
22913&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22914&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22915&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22916&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22917&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22918&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22919&`h`& rewrite all headers
22920&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22921&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22922&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22923.endd
22924"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22925individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22926other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22927
22928You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22929restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22930
22931
22932.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22933.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22934.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22935.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22936The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22937SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22938before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22939required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22940data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22941
22942.vindex "&$domain$&"
22943.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22944This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22945compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22946input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22947the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22948expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22949original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22950
22951
22952.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22953There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22954take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22955correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22956
22957.ilist
22958If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22959unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22960absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22961.next
22962If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22963even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22964expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22965(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22966.next
22967The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22968address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22969rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22970.next
22971.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22972When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22973to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22974left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22975.code
22976From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22977.endd
22978into
22979.code
22980From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22981.endd
22982.cindex "RFC 2047"
22983Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22984done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22985causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22986replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
229872822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22988brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22989(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22990is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22991
22992When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22993rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22994.endlist
22995
22996
22997.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22998Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22999.code
23000*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23001*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23002 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23003.endd
23004Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23005the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23006has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23007consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23008present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23009explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23010at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23011error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23012
23013The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23014domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23015.code
23016root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23017.endd
23018were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23019local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23020
23021Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23022&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23023messages that originate outside the local host:
23024.code
23025*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23026 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23027.endd
23028The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23029space.
23030
23031.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23032.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23033Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23034an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23035the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23036remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23037sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23038components. For example, the rule
23039.code
23040\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23041.endd
23042rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23043&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23044a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23045method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23046to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23047use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23048can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23049.ecindex IIDaddrew
23050
23051
23052
23053
23054
23055. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23056. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23057
23058.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23059.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23060.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23061The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23062retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23063be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23064empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23065errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23066general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23067line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23068address, domain and error.
23069
23070The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23071host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23072Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23073address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23074been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23075tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23076log selector is set, the message
23077.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23078&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23079skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23080the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23081
23082Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23083in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23084actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23085failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23086the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23087added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23088same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23089domain are maintained independently.
23090
23091When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23092receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23093always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23094behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23095quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23096suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23097subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23098the local address is reached.
23099
23100.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23101If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23102whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23103files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23104always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23105
23106The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23107rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23108record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23109timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23110and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23111messages that it should now be retaining.
23112
23113
23114
23115.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23116.cindex "retry" "rules"
23117Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23118separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23119addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23120enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23121in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23122present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23123message's sender, respectively.
23124
23125
23126The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23127&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23128which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23129has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23130list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23131which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23132example,
23133.code
23134lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23135.endd
23136provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23137whereas
23138.code
23139alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23140.endd
23141applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23142In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23143part.
23144
23145.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23146&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
23147must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23148expressions work in address lists.
23149.display
23150&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23151&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23152.endd
23153
23154
23155.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23156When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23157example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23158against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23159router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23160regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23161A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23162&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23163&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23164
23165Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23166failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23167configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23168&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23169local transports).
23170
23171.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23172However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23173suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23174whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23175rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23176failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23177recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23178reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23179&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23180lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23181commands.
23182
23183
23184
23185.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23186 "SECID160"
23187For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23188example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23189twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23190&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23191the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23192suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23193.code
23194a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23195 MX 6 p.q.r.example
23196 MX 7 m.n.o.example
23197.endd
23198and the retry rules are
23199.code
23200p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23201a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23202.endd
23203and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23204first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23205rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23206to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23207tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23208first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23209
23210In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23211first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23212&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23213routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23214
23215&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23216However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23217host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23218.code
23219route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23220.endd
23221then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23222textual form of the IP address.
23223
23224.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23225.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23226The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23227asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23228
23229.vlist
23230.vitem &%auth_failed%&
23231Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23232&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23233
23234.vitem &%data_4xx%&
23235A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23236after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23237
23238.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23239A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23240
23241.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23242A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23243.endlist
23244
23245For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23246as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23247recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23248and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23249retry rule of this form:
23250.code
23251the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23252.endd
23253These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23254LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23255
23256.vlist
23257.vitem &%lost_connection%&
23258A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23259legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23260for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23261
23262.vitem &%refused_MX%&
23263A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23264
23265.vitem &%refused_A%&
23266A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23267
23268.vitem &%refused%&
23269A connection was refused.
23270
23271.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23272A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23273
23274.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23275A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23276
23277.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23278A connection attempt timed out.
23279
23280.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23281There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23282obtained from an MX record.
23283
23284.vitem &%timeout_A%&
23285There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23286obtained from an MX record.
23287
23288.vitem &%timeout%&
23289There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23290
23291.vitem &%tls_required%&
23292The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23293&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23294to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23295
23296.vitem &%quota%&
23297A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23298transport.
23299
23300.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23301.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23302.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23303A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23304transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23305&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23306for four days.
23307.endlist
23308
23309.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23310The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23311timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23312it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23313However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23314heuristic rules:
23315
23316.ilist
23317If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23318used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23319quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23320.next
23321.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23322For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23323subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23324the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23325change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23326MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23327time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23328.next
23329For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23330obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23331.endlist
23332
23333The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23334mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23335when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23336error).
23337
23338
23339
23340.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23341.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23342You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23343specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23344apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23345form:
23346.display
23347&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23348.endd
23349The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23350.code
23351* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23352.endd
23353matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23354host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23355For example:
23356.code
23357a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23358.endd
23359&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23360(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23361only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23362its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23363all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23364
23365When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23366&%-f%& command line option, like this:
23367.code
23368exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23369.endd
23370If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23371list is never matched.
23372
23373
23374
23375
23376
23377.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23378.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23379The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23380sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23381.display
23382<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23383.endd
23384The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23385time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23386arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23387time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23388relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23389
23390.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23391.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23392.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23393.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23394The available algorithms are:
23395
23396.ilist
23397&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23398the interval.
23399.next
23400&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23401specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23402is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23403.next
23404&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23405retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23406maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23407the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23408rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23409members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23410queue processing times.
23411.endlist
23412
23413When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23414order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23415used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23416case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23417current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23418computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23419interval is found. The main configuration variable
23420.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23421.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23422.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23423&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23424cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23425
23426A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23427host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23428basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23429for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23430generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23431time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23432time.
23433
23434.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23435Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23436run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23437starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23438new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23439If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23440occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23441messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23442processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23443your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23444number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23445sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23446
23447The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23448&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23449&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23450&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23451are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23452deliveries that have been deferred.
23453
23454
23455.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23456Here are some example retry rules:
23457.code
23458alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23459wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23460wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23461lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23462* refused_A F,2h,20m;
23463* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23464.endd
23465The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23466&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23467mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23468hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23469parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23470effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23471fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23472days.
23473
23474The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23475happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23476intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23477first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23478so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23479
23480The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23481They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23482all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23483were not obtained from an MX record.
23484
23485The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23486first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23487not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23488hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
234891.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23490
23491
23492
23493.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23494.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23495.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23496.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23497.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23498Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23499consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23500set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23501been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23502arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23503failing for the first time.
23504
23505This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23506backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23507Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23508down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23509
23510If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23511every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23512message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23513
23514
23515
23516
23517.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23518.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23519.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23520Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23521that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23522default retry rule:
23523.code
23524* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23525.endd
23526the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23527long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23528failure for the recipient address that counts.
23529
23530When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23531addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23532causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23533In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23534time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23535
23536For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23537messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23538post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23539
23540If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23541.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23542&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23543default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23544reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23545attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23546those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23547the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23548
23549In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23550for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23551times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23552behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23553to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23554notice.
23555
23556If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23557addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23558addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23559no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23560words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23561addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23562If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23563&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23564deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23565true.
23566
23567.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23568.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23569Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23570intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23571its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23572because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23573host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23574failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23575reached.
23576
23577Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23578applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23579Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23580examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23581commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23582time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23583is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23584time out the address.
23585
23586The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23587the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23588given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23589time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23590not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23591considered immediately.
23592.ecindex IIDretconf1
23593.ecindex IIDregconf2
23594
23595
23596
23597
23598
23599
23600. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23601. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23602
23603.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23604.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23605.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23606The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23607with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23608described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23609to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23610permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23611transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23612other.
23613
23614.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23615Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23616
23617.ilist
23618The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23619the client's EHLO command.
23620.next
23621The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23622may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23623.next
23624The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23625appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23626just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23627any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23628with the AUTH command.
23629.next
23630The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23631.next
23632If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23633option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23634mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23635connection.
23636.next
23637If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23638authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23639unauthenticated connection.
23640.endlist
23641
23642If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23643mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23644SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23645includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23646.display
23647&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23648&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23649&`Connected to server.example.`&
23650&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
23651&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23652&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23653&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23654&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23655&`250-PIPELINING`&
23656&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
23657&`250 HELP`&
23658.endd
23659The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23660authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23661mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23662routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23663controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23664included by setting
23665.code
23666AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
23667AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23668.new
23669AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
23670AUTH_GSASL=yes
23671AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
23672.wen
23673AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
23674AUTH_SPA=yes
23675.endd
23676in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23677authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23678the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
23679.new
23680The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
23681work via a socket interface.
23682The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
23683provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
23684The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
23685supporting setting a server keytab.
23686The sixth can be configured to support
23687the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23688not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
23689supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23690.wen
23691
23692The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23693section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23694authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23695authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23696is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23697messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23698options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23699
23700To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23701&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23702either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23703functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23704to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23705both sets of options, is required. For example:
23706.code
23707cram:
23708 driver = cram_md5
23709 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23710 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23711 client_name = ph10
23712 client_secret = secret2
23713.endd
23714The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23715&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23716
23717Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23718The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23719authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23720in Exim.
23721
23722.new
23723&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
23724per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
23725account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
23726authenticating data.
23727
23728Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
23729&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
23730and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
23731Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
23732used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
23733second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
23734user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
23735configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
23736&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
23737as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
23738choose to honour.
23739
23740A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
23741to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
23742mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
23743typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
23744.wen
23745
23746
23747
23748.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23749.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23750.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23751
23752.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23753When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23754&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23755used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23756encrypted by a setting such as:
23757.code
23758client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23759.endd
23760(Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23761used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23762cipher used for the delivery.)
23763
23764
23765.option driver authenticators string unset
23766This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23767authenticators is to be used.
23768
23769
23770.option public_name authenticators string unset
23771This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23772implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23773contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23774but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23775defaults to the driver's instance name.
23776
23777
23778.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23779When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23780is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23781mechanism is not advertised.
23782If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23783forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23784See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23785
23786
23787.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23788This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23789is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23790for details.
23791
23792.new
23793For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
23794mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
23795.wen
23796
23797For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23798authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23799authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23800authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23801to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23802error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23803string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23804expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23805other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23806the error text.
23807
23808
23809.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23810If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23811command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23812output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23813out the values of variables.
23814If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23815output, and Exim carries on processing.
23816
23817
23818.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23819.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23820When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23821expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23822messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23823lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23824configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23825refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23826If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23827
23828
23829.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23830This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23831as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23832driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23833as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23834remembered for later use.
23835How it is used is described in the following section.
23836
23837
23838
23839
23840
23841.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23842.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23843.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23844When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23845the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23846message:
23847
23848.ilist
23849If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23850than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23851.next
23852If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23853.next
23854.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23855If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23856running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23857from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23858&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23859return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23860given for the MAIL command.
23861.next
23862If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23863is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23864authenticated.
23865.next
23866If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23867the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23868&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23869valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23870fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23871&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23872the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23873message.
23874.endlist
23875
23876
23877When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23878hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23879&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23880process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23881
23882.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23883Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23884MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23885therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23886value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23887ACL is run.
23888
23889
23890
23891.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23892.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23893When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23894authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23895conditions:
23896
23897.ilist
23898The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23899.next
23900It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23901yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23902.endlist
23903
23904The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23905the mechanisms are advertised.
23906
23907Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23908provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23909even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23910set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23911You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23912For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23913that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23914.code
23915auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23916.endd
23917so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23918
23919The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23920authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23921advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23922such as:
23923.code
23924server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23925.endd
23926.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23927If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23928yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23929
23930When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23931immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23932command. This is the case if
23933
23934.ilist
23935The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23936.next
23937No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23938.next
23939Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23940server authenticators.
23941.endlist
23942
23943
23944Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23945to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23946AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23947
23948If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23949server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23950that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23951the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23952fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23953rejected with a 504 error.
23954
23955.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23956.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23957When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23958&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23959or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23960public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23961client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23962no successful authentication.
23963
23964
23965
23966
23967.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23968.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23969.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23970.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23971Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23972configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23973encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23974script:
23975.code
23976use MIME::Base64;
23977printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23978.endd
23979.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23980This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23981interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23982some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23983command line to run this script on such data might be
23984.code
23985encode '\0user\0password'
23986.endd
23987Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23988backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23989whose code value is zero.
23990
23991&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23992digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23993you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23994interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23995
23996&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23997specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23998example, a command such as
23999.code
24000encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24001.endd
24002gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24003
24004If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24005base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24006.code
24007echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24008.endd
24009The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24010in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24011output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24012should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24013
24014
24015
24016.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24017.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24018The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24019&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24020announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24021of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24022
24023.ilist
24024For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24025they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24026mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24027of the authenticator.
24028.next
24029.vindex "&$host$&"
24030.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24031When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24032variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24033that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24034any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24035Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24036delivery to be deferred.
24037.next
24038If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24039Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24040try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24041usual way.
24042.next
24043If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24044carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24045possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24046no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24047what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24048&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24049delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24050turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24051deliver the message unauthenticated.
24052.endlist
24053
24054.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24055When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24056parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24057the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24058is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24059incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24060allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24061to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24062&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24063&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24064the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24065.ecindex IIDauthconf1
24066.ecindex IIDauthconf2
24067
24068
24069
24070
24071
24072
24073. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24074. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24075
24076.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24077.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24078.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24079The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24080LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24081plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24082security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24083(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24084use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24085connections as you do for login accounts.
24086
24087.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24088.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24089When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24090
24091.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24092This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24093configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24094
24095.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24096The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24097prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24098given.
24099
24100.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24101.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24102.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24103.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24104 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24105.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24106.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24107
24108When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24109expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24110response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24111values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24112a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24113are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24114(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24115
24116For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24117the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24118variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24119string expansions that also use them for other things.
24120
24121If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24122supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24123data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24124
24125.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24126Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24127&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24128authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24129to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24130&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24131expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24132generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24133For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24134string as the error text.
24135
24136&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24137password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24138There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24139
24140
24141
24142.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24143.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24144.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24145.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24146The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24147sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24148separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24149subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24150
24151The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24152Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24153configured as follows:
24154.code
24155fixed_plain:
24156 driver = plaintext
24157 public_name = PLAIN
24158 server_prompts = :
24159 server_condition = \
24160 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24161 server_set_id = $auth2
24162.endd
24163Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24164are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24165password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24166or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24167
24168The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24169the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24170AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24171authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24172.code
24173250-AUTH PLAIN
24174.endd
24175and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24176.code
24177AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24178.endd
24179As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24180data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24181.code
24182AUTH PLAIN
24183.endd
24184to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24185prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24186
24187The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24188when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24189represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24190is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24191second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24192
24193Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24194realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24195authenticating clients it could make sense.
24196
24197A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24198&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24199comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24200this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24201This is an incorrect example:
24202.code
24203server_condition = \
24204 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24205.endd
24206The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24207which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24208incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24209non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24210strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24211the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24212name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24213.code
24214server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24215 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24216.endd
24217In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24218fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24219used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24220always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24221writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24222
24223
24224.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24225.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24226.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24227The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24228in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24229user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24230plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24231.code
24232fixed_login:
24233 driver = plaintext
24234 public_name = LOGIN
24235 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24236 server_condition = \
24237 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24238 server_set_id = $auth1
24239.endd
24240Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24241with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24242if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24243strings are used to obtain two data items.
24244
24245Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24246example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24247&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24248strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24249name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24250.code
24251login:
24252 driver = plaintext
24253 public_name = LOGIN
24254 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24255 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24256 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
24257 ldapauth{\
24258 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24259 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24260 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24261 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24262.endd
24263We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24264does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24265operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24266&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24267correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24268the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24269uninterpreted string.
24270
24271
24272.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24273A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24274interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24275traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24276Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24277&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
24278
24279
24280
24281
24282.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24283.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24284The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24285
24286.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24287If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24288authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24289the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24290usual.
24291
24292.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24293The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24294string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24295string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24296to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24297most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24298with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24299way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24300(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24301so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24302&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24303&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24304
24305&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24306splitting takes priority and happens first.
24307
24308Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24309the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24310there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24311NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24312the string.
24313
24314This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24315authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24316.code
24317fixed_plain:
24318 driver = plaintext
24319 public_name = PLAIN
24320 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24321.endd
24322The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24323command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24324that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24325.code
24326fixed_login:
24327 driver = plaintext
24328 public_name = LOGIN
24329 client_send = : username : mysecret
24330.endd
24331The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24332the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24333prompts.
24334.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24335.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24336
24337
24338
24339
24340. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24341. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24342
24343.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24344.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24345.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24346.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24347.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24348The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24349sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24350name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24351string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24352is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24353secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24354available in plain text at either end.
24355
24356
24357.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24358.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24359This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24360authenticator as a server:
24361
24362.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24363.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24364When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24365the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24366obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24367that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24368string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24369fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24370returned to the client.
24371
24372For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24373in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24374deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24375numeric variables for other things.
24376
24377For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24378client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24379user name, authentication fails.
24380.code
24381fixed_cram:
24382 driver = cram_md5
24383 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24384 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24385 server_set_id = $auth1
24386.endd
24387.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24388If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24389name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24390secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24391.code
24392lookup_cram:
24393 driver = cram_md5
24394 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24395 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24396 {$value}fail}
24397 server_set_id = $auth1
24398.endd
24399Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24400because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24401
24402.new
24403As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24404using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24405lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24406realm, with:
24407.code
24408cyrusless_crammd5:
24409 driver = cram_md5
24410 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24411 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24412 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24413 server_set_id = $auth1
24414.endd
24415.wen
24416
24417.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24418.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24419When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24420
24421
24422
24423.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24424This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24425computing the response to the server's challenge.
24426
24427
24428.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24429This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24430expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24431
24432
24433.vindex "&$host$&"
24434.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24435Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24436to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24437expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24438prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24439authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24440send the message to the current server.
24441
24442A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24443strings, is:
24444.code
24445fixed_cram:
24446 driver = cram_md5
24447 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24448 client_name = ph10
24449 client_secret = secret
24450.endd
24451.ecindex IIDcramauth1
24452.ecindex IIDcramauth2
24453
24454
24455
24456. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24457. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24458
24459.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24460.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24461.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24462.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24463.cindex "Kerberos"
24464The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24465Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24466
24467The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24468library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24469Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24470including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24471directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24472
24473The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24474the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24475then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24476name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24477
24478Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24479or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24480user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24481by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24482depending on the driver you are using.
24483
24484The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24485be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24486Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24487changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24488layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24489implementation.
24490.new
24491For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24492may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24493variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24494Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24495With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24496environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24497is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24498the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24499.wen
24500
24501
24502.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24503The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24504(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24505previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24506use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24507confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24508things.
24509
24510
24511.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24512This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24513library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24514SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24515
24516
24517.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24518This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24519default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24520you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24521example:
24522.code
24523sasl:
24524 driver = cyrus_sasl
24525 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24526 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24527 server_set_id = $auth1
24528.endd
24529
24530.new
24531.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24532This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24533.wen
24534
24535
24536.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24537This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24538
24539
24540For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24541private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24542the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24543PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24544.code
24545sasl_cram_md5:
24546 driver = cyrus_sasl
24547 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24548 server_set_id = $auth1
24549
24550sasl_plain:
24551 driver = cyrus_sasl
24552 public_name = PLAIN
24553 server_set_id = $auth2
24554.endd
24555Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24556not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24557but it is present in many binary distributions.
24558.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24559.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24560
24561
24562
24563
24564. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24565. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24566.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24567.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24568.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24569This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24570Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24571If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24572to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24573authenticator only. There is only one option:
24574
24575.option server_socket dovecot string unset
24576
24577This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24578authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24579mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24580authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24581.code
24582dovecot_plain:
24583 driver = dovecot
24584 public_name = PLAIN
24585 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24586 server_set_id = $auth2
24587
24588dovecot_ntlm:
24589 driver = dovecot
24590 public_name = NTLM
24591 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24592 server_set_id = $auth1
24593.endd
24594If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24595&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24596option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24597connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24598option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24599who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24600.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24601.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24602
24603
24604. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24605. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24606.new
24607.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
24608.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
24609.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
24610.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
24611.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
24612.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24613.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24614.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
24615.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
24616.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
24617.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
24618.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
24619The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
24620library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
24621and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
24622scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
24623made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
24624without code changes in Exim.
24625
24626
24627.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
24628Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
24629of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
24630authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
24631ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
24632context.
24633
24634This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
24635as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
24636see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
24637
24638This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
24639only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
24640writing, that's the SCRAM family.
24641
24642This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
24643this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
24644of Exim may switch the default to be true.
24645
24646
24647.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
24648This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24649library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24650Some mechanisms will use this data.
24651
24652
24653.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
24654This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24655default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24656you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24657example:
24658.code
24659sasl:
24660 driver = gsasl
24661 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24662 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24663 server_set_id = $auth1
24664.endd
24665
24666
24667.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
24668Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
24669that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
24670the password itself.
24671
24672The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
24673In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
24674The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
24675if available, else the empty string.
24676The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
24677else the empty string.
24678
24679A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
24680
24681If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
24682option to be simply "true".
24683
24684
24685.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
24686This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24687Some mechanisms will use this data.
24688
24689
24690.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
24691This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24692&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24693(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24694
24695
24696.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
24697This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24698&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24699(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24700
24701
24702.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
24703This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24704Some mechanisms will use this data.
24705
24706
24707.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
24708.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24709These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
24710They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
24711
24712Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
24713meanings for these variables:
24714
24715.ilist
24716.vindex "&$auth1$&"
24717&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
24718.next
24719.vindex "&$auth2$&"
24720&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
24721.next
24722.vindex "&$auth3$&"
24723&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
24724.endlist
24725
24726On a per-mechanism basis:
24727
24728.ilist
24729.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24730EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
24731the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24732.next
24733.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24734ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
24735the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24736.next
24737.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24738GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
24739&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
24740the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24741.endlist
24742
24743An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
24744identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
24745email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
24746
24747
24748An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
24749and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
24750.code
24751gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
24752 driver = gsasl
24753 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24754 server_realm = imap.example.org
24755 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
24756 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
24757 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
24758 server_condition = yes
24759.endd
24760
24761.wen
24762
24763. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24764. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24765
24766.new
24767.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
24768.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
24769.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
24770.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24771.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
24772The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
24773Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
24774reliably.
24775
24776.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
24777This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
24778for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
24779identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24780
24781.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
24782If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
24783&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
24784The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
24785
24786.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
24787This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
24788&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
24789from the keytab.
24790
24791
24792.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
24793Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
24794to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
24795not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
24796
24797The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
24798Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
24799Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
24800role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
24801
24802.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24803.ilist
24804.vindex "&$auth1$&"
24805&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
24806.next
24807.vindex "&$auth2$&"
24808&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
24809authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
24810GSS Display Name.
24811.endlist
24812
24813.wen
24814
24815. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24816. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24817
24818.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
24819.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
24820.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
24821.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
24822.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
24823.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
24824.cindex "NTLM authentication"
24825The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24826Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24827which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24828this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24829taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24830server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24831follows:
24832
24833.ilist
24834After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24835authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24836.next
24837The server sends back a challenge.
24838.next
24839The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24840and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24841.endlist
24842
24843Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24844
24845
24846
24847.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24848.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24849The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24850
24851.option server_password spa string&!! unset
24852.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24853This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24854authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24855compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24856&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24857it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24858for other things. For example:
24859.code
24860spa:
24861 driver = spa
24862 public_name = NTLM
24863 server_password = \
24864 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24865.endd
24866If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24867failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24868
24869
24870
24871
24872
24873.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24874.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24875The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24876
24877
24878
24879.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24880This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24881
24882
24883.option client_password spa string&!! unset
24884This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24885
24886
24887.option client_username spa string&!! unset
24888This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24889configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24890&'msn.com'&:
24891.code
24892msn:
24893 driver = spa
24894 public_name = MSN
24895 client_username = msn/msn_username
24896 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24897 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24898.endd
24899.ecindex IIDspaauth1
24900.ecindex IIDspaauth2
24901
24902
24903
24904
24905
24906. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24907. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24908
24909.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24910 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24911.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24912.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24913.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24914.cindex "OpenSSL"
24915.cindex "GnuTLS"
24916Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24917Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24918GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24919cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24920order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24921version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24922You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24923level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24924certificates are used.
24925
24926RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24927connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24928server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24929mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24930between them is encrypted.
24931
24932Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24933and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24934certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24935possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24936encryption state.
24937
24938&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24939disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24940in order to get TLS to work.
24941
24942
24943
24944.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24945 "SECID284"
24946.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24947.cindex "smtps protocol"
24948.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24949.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24950Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24951SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24952waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24953port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24954allocated for this purpose.
24955
24956This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24957still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24958the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24959numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24960.code
24961tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24962.endd
24963The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24964via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24965the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24966the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24967an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24968defined elsewhere.
24969
24970There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24971&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24972
24973
24974
24975
24976
24977
24978.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24979.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24980The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24981followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24982to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24983.code
24984USE_GNUTLS=yes
24985.endd
24986in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24987.code
24988SUPPORT_TLS=yes
24989.endd
24990You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24991include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24992
24993There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24994
24995.ilist
24996The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24997name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24998.next
24999The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
25000facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters.
25001.new
25002Since then, the GnuTLS support has been updated to generate parameters upon
25003demand, keeping them in the spool directory. See &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for
25004details.
25005.wen
25006.next
25007.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
25008Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25009separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25010affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
25011.next
25012OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25013DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25014RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25015in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25016for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25017to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25018&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25019option).
25020.next
25021The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25022sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25023.new
25024.next
25025Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25026This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25027explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25028implementation, then patches are welcome.
25029.wen
25030.endlist
25031
25032
25033.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25034.new
25035GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25036to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25037Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25038&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25039of bits requested.
25040The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25041its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25042parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25043that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25044renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25045this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25046place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25047
25048For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25049recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25050Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25051values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25052parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25053If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25054until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25055a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25056
25057The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25058in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25059generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25060
25061To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25062and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25063&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25064renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25065.code
25066# ls
25067[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25068# rm -f new-params
25069# touch new-params
25070# chown exim:exim new-params
25071# chmod 0600 new-params
25072# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25073# chmod 0400 new-params
25074# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25075.endd
25076If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25077stalling is removed.
25078
25079The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25080Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25081the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25082a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25083and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25084failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25085of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25086which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25087GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25088to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25089limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25090
25091The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25092value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25093&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
250942432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25095.wen
25096
25097
25098.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25099.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25100.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25101There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25102suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25103are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25104DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25105directly to this function call.
25106Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25107&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25108The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25109documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25110
25111.ilist
25112It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25113.next
25114It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25115or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25116ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25117SSL v3 algorithms.
25118.next
25119Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25120the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25121SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25122algorithms.
25123.endlist
25124
25125Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25126&`-`& or &`+`&.
25127.ilist
25128If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25129ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25130stated.
25131.next
25132If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25133of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25134.next
25135If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25136option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25137.endlist
25138
25139If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25140a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25141includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25142not be moved to the end of the list.
25143.endlist
25144
25145.new
25146The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25147string:
25148.code
25149# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25150$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25151.endd
25152
25153This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25154there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25155submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25156choice of clients used:
25157.code
25158# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25159tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25160 {DEFAULT}\
25161 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
25162.endd
25163.wen
25164
25165
25166
25167.new
25168.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25169 "SECTreqciphgnu"
25170.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25171.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25172.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25173.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25174.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25175.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25176.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25177The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25178as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25179ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25180
25181The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25182
25183The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25184controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25185&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25186the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25187the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25188aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25189
25190Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25191"Priority strings". This is online as
25192&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25193but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25194installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25195&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string.html, then the example code)
25196on that site can be used to test a given string.
25197
25198Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25199additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25200"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25201
25202This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25203there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25204by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25205where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25206used:
25207.code
25208# GnuTLS variant
25209tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25210 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
25211 {SECURE128}}
25212.endd
25213.wen
25214
25215
25216.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25217.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25218When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25219the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25220but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25221that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25222need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25223sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25224
25225If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25226problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25227persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25228with the error
25229.code
25230554 Security failure
25231.endd
25232If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25233rejected with a 554 error code.
25234
25235To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25236match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25237However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25238without some further configuration at the server end.
25239
25240It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25241encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25242.code
25243tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25244tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25245.endd
25246These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25247the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25248contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25249that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25250always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25251certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25252set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25253is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25254certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25255the server's certificate.
25256
25257If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25258source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25259few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25260
25261&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25262they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25263Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25264transport.
25265
25266With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25267require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25268this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25269.code
25270tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25271.endd
25272is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25273with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
25274suites that the server supports. See the command
25275.code
25276openssl dhparam
25277.endd
25278for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
25279when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
25280
25281The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25282host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25283for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25284in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25285forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25286
25287.cindex "cipher" "logging"
25288.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25289.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
25290The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25291an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25292incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25293also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25294&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25295condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25296(For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
25297&<<SECID185>>&.)
25298
25299Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25300can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25301cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25302example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25303contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25304documentation for more details.
25305
25306
25307.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25308.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25309.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25310If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25311session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25312&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25313apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25314Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25315contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25316expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25317for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25318&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25319
25320A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25321directory is used
25322(OpenSSL only),
25323each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25324of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25325certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25326.code
25327openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25328.endd
25329where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25330
25331The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25332what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25333does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25334&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25335attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25336dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25337session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25338fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25339example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25340relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25341
25342.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
25343When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25344the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25345&$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25346
25347.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25348Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25349&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25350&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25351&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25352certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
25353
25354
25355.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25356.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25357.cindex "revocation list"
25358.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25359Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25360certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25361server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25362an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25363of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25364CRL in PEM format.
25365
25366
25367.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25368.cindex "cipher" "logging"
25369.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25370.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25371.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25372The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25373deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25374server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25375within the &(smtp)& transport.
25376
25377It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25378transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25379server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25380this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25381transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25382
25383If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25384to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25385&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25386those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25387set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25388usual way.
25389
25390When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25391the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25392a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25393session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25394&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25395delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25396it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25397STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25398negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25399unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25400unencrypted.
25401
25402The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25403transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25404if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25405&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25406
25407If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25408must name a file or,
25409for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25410expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25411against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25412in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25413
25414If
25415&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25416list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25417the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25418alternative hosts, if any.
25419
25420 &*Note*&:
25421These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25422is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25423by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25424client.
25425
25426.vindex "&$host$&"
25427.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25428All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25429&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25430which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25431behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25432
25433.vindex &$tls_bits$&
25434.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25435.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25436.vindex &$tls_sni$&
25437Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25438&$tls_bits$&, &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25439variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25440that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25441successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25442outgoing connection.
25443
25444
25445
25446.new
25447.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25448.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25449.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25450.oindex "&%tls_sni%&"
25451With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25452information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25453extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25454&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25455client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25456within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25457for this session.
25458
25459This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25460which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25461address.
25462
25463With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25464against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25465provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25466be of limited use in that environment.
25467
25468With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25469connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25470choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25471wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25472different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25473
25474The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25475if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25476nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25477only point of caution. The &$tls_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25478for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25479
25480Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_sni$& is set then it is a string
25481received from a client.
25482It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25483
25484If the string &`tls_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25485option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25486during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25487
25488.ilist
25489.vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25490&%tls_certificate%&
25491.next
25492.vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25493&%tls_crl%&
25494.next
25495.vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25496&%tls_privatekey%&
25497.next
25498.vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25499&%tls_verify_certificates%&
25500.endlist
25501
25502Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
25503attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
25504can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
25505arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
25506
25507The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
25508are re-expanded.
25509
25510When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
25511for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
25512enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
25513see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
25514
25515When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
255160.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
25517built, then you have SNI support).
25518.wen
25519
25520
25521
25522.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25523 "SECTmulmessam"
25524.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25525.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25526Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25527an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25528one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25529of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25530connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25531to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
25532session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
25533try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
25534if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
25535
25536The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
25537after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
25538just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
25539reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
25540successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
25541SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
25542should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
25543subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
25544and delay other deliveries to that host.
25545
25546To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
25547closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
25548closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
25549information is recorded.
25550
25551There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
25552&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
25553connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
25554
25555
25556
25557
25558.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
25559.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
25560In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
25561certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
25562place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
25563myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
25564to Apache, currently at
25565.display
25566&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
25567.endd
25568Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
25569links to further files.
25570Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
255710-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
25572Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
25573.display
25574&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
25575.endd
25576
25577
25578.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
25579The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
25580certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
25581sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
25582not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
25583First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
25584certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
25585intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
25586certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
25587The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
25588validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
25589root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
25590install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
25591
25592
25593.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
25594.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
25595You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
25596with OpenSSL, like this:
25597.code
25598openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
25599 -days 9999 -nodes
25600.endd
25601&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
25602delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
25603specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
25604important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
25605that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
25606prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
25607this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
25608
25609A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
25610may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
25611encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
25612
25613However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
25614user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
25615certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
25616must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
25617authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
25618signed with that self-signed certificate.
25619
25620For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
25621user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
25622Open-source PKI book, available online at
25623&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
25624.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
25625.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
25626
25627
25628
25629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25630. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25631
25632.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
25633.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
25634.cindex "control of incoming mail"
25635.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
25636.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
25637Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
25638configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
25639name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
25640one very small ACL:
25641.code
25642begin acl
25643small_acl:
25644 accept hosts = one.host.only
25645.endd
25646You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
25647which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
25648
25649The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
25650certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
25651when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
25652option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
25653in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
25654local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
25655a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
25656&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
25657
25658
25659.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
25660The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
25661configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
25662The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
25663relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
25664
25665
25666
25667.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
25668.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
25669In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
25670options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
25671.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
25672.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25673.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
25674.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
25675.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25676.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25677.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
25678.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25679.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
25680.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
25681.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
25682.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25683.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25684.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
25685
25686.table2 140pt
25687.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
25688.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
25689.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
25690.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
25691.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
25692.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
25693.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
25694.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
25695.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
25696.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
25697.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
25698.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
25699.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
25700.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
25701.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
25702.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
25703.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
25704.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
25705.endtable
25706
25707For example, if you set
25708.code
25709acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
25710.endd
25711the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
25712in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
25713done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
25714sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
25715command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
25716trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
25717testing as possible at RCPT time.
25718
25719
25720.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
25721.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25722The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
25723apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
25724really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
25725the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
25726relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
25727are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
25728&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
25729&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
25730in any of these ACLs.
25731
25732The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
25733non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
25734analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
25735batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
25736result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
25737really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
25738on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
25739controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
25740.code
25741control = suppress_local_fixups
25742.endd
25743This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
25744run, it is too late.
25745
25746The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25747content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25748
25749The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
25750kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
25751temporary error for these kinds of message.
25752
25753
25754.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
25755.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25756.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
25757The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
25758session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
25759an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
25760accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
25761the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
25762&%smtp_banner%& option.
25763
25764
25765.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
25766.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25767.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25768The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
25769EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
25770&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
25771Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
25772session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
25773setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
25774
25775If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
25776modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
25777at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
25778affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
25779an EHLO response.
25780
25781
25782.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
25783.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25784Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
25785command, with two responses being sent to the client.
25786When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
25787is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
25788the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
25789response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
25790added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
25791are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
25792
25793You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
25794in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
25795tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
25796received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
25797the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
25798associated with the DATA command.
25799
25800For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
25801error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
25802MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
25803before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
25804and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
25805your resources.
25806
25807
25808.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
25809The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
25810enabled (which is the default).
25811
25812The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
25813received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
25814otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
25815
25816For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHID12>>&.
25817
25818
25819.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
25820The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25821content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25822
25823
25824.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
25825.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25826The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
25827does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
25828does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
25829permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
25830
25831This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
25832session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
25833messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
25834more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
25835
25836&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
25837the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
25838
25839You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
25840&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
25841response to QUIT.
25842
25843This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
25844failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
25845because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
25846client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
25847connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
25848
25849
25850.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
25851.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
25852The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
25853an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
25854trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
25855because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
25856situation even worse.
25857
25858Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
25859logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
25860modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
25861and &%warn%&.
25862
25863.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
25864When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
25865to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
25866connection. The possible values are:
25867.table2
25868.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
25869.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
25870.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
25871.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
25872.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
25873.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
25874.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
25875.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
25876.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
25877.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
25878.endtable
25879In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
25880Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
25881With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
25882overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
25883&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
25884used.
25885
25886
25887.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
25888.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
25889The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
25890you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
25891.code
25892acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
25893 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
25894.endd
25895In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
25896providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
25897non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
25898expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
25899more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
25900
25901The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
25902configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
25903string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
25904
25905.ilist
25906If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
25907contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
25908Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
25909lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
25910If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
25911causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
25912.code
25913acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
25914 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
25915 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
25916.endd
25917This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
25918back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
25919file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
25920can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
25921.next
25922If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
25923Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
25924matches the string.
25925.next
25926If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
25927the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
25928want to have something like
25929.code
25930acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
25931.endd
25932in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
25933newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
25934.endlist
25935
25936
25937
25938
25939.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
25940.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
25941Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
25942section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
25943&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
25944database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
25945return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
25946&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
25947This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
25948
25949For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
25950&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
25951submitters of non-SMTP messages.
25952
25953
25954ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
25955has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
25956individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
25957blackholing facility. Use it with care.
25958
25959If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
25960ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
25961RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
25962recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
25963run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
25964remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
25965&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
25966
25967
25968.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
25969The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
25970recipients; it may create new recipients.
25971
25972
25973
25974.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
25975.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
25976The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
25977all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
25978not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
25979reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
25980
25981For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
25982these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
25983used to accept or reject anything.
25984
25985For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
25986&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
25987&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
25988when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
25989
25990For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
25991&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
25992This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
25993messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
25994configuration file.
25995
25996
25997
25998
25999.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26000.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26001.vindex &$domain$&
26002.vindex &$local_part$&
26003.vindex &$sender_address$&
26004.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26005.vindex &$smtp_command$&
26006When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26007that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26008&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26009statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26010&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26011is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26012
26013When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26014contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26015set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26016how it is used.
26017
26018.vindex "&$message_size$&"
26019The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26020the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26021that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26022the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26023received).
26024
26025.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26026.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26027The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26028The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26029accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26030of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26031&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26032&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26033
26034
26035
26036
26037
26038.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26039.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26040.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26041.vindex &$smtp_command$&
26042When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26043the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26044and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26045These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26046here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26047encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26048does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26049unencrypted connections.
26050.code
26051acl_check_auth:
26052 accept encrypted = *
26053 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26054 {CRAM-MD5}}
26055 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26056.endd
26057(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26058that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26059encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26060option to do this.)
26061
26062
26063
26064.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26065.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26066.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26067An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26068with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26069Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26070set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26071
26072If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26073used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26074provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26075example:
26076.code
26077deny dnslists = list1.example
26078dnslists = list2.example
26079.endd
26080If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26081the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26082happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26083all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26084test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26085
26086
26087.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26088The ACL verbs are as follows:
26089
26090.ilist
26091.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26092&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26093of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26094appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26095is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26096after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26097check a RCPT command:
26098.code
26099accept domains = +local_domains
26100endpass
26101verify = recipient
26102.endd
26103If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26104passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26105the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26106fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26107&%endpass%&.
26108
26109The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26110use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26111that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26112configuration.
26113
26114.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26115If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26116depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26117(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26118statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26119SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26120.display
26121&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26122&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26123.endd
26124You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26125response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26126same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26127
26128If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26129an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26130for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26131of &%endpass%&.
26132
26133
26134.next
26135.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26136&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26137an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26138&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26139temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26140&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26141be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26142
26143
26144.next
26145.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26146&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26147the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26148example,
26149.code
26150deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26151.endd
26152rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26153
26154
26155.next
26156.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26157&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26158&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26159that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26160the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26161recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26162recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26163message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26164do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26165
26166If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26167its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26168The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26169
26170
26171.next
26172.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26173&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26174forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26175.code
26176drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26177 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26178.endd
26179There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26180The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26181
26182.next
26183.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26184&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26185statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26186example, when checking a RCPT command,
26187.code
26188require message = Sender did not verify
26189 verify = sender
26190.endd
26191passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26192verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26193&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26194discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26195
26196.next
26197.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26198&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26199&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26200to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26201written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26202message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26203duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26204
26205If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26206and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26207&%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
26208condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26209&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26210
26211If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26212some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26213This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26214is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26215conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26216is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26217onwards.
26218
26219
26220.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26221When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26222text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26223want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26224.code
26225warn !verify = sender
26226 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26227.endd
26228.endlist
26229
26230At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26231
26232As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26233written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26234subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26235continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26236mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26237
26238
26239
26240.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26241.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26242There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26243can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26244of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26245transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26246variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26247an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26248alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26249the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26250.ilist
26251The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26252throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26253while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26254on the same SMTP connection.
26255.next
26256The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26257while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26258reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26259.endlist
26260
26261When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26262preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26263time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26264.code
26265accept hosts = whatever
26266 set acl_m4 = some value
26267accept authenticated = *
26268 set acl_c_auth = yes
26269.endd
26270&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26271be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26272&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26273
26274.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26275What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26276referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26277false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26278error is generated.
26279
26280Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26281their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26282
26283
26284.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26285.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26286.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26287An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26288.code
26289deny domains = *.dom.example
26290 !verify = recipient
26291.endd
26292causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26293&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26294negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26295two statements are equivalent:
26296.code
26297deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26298deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26299.endd
26300However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26301side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26302
26303The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26304of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26305condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26306.code
26307accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26308 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26309accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26310 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26311.endd
26312Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26313the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26314different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26315condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26316therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26317the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26318and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26319
26320ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26321specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26322others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26323warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26324message is handled.
26325
26326The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
26327processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26328modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26329consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26330.code
26331require message = Can't verify sender
26332 verify = sender
26333 message = Can't verify recipient
26334 verify = recipient
26335 message = This message cannot be used
26336.endd
26337If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26338&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26339so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26340recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26341verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26342because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26343
26344For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26345modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26346happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26347the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26348.code
26349deny hosts = ...
26350 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26351 message = Invalid sender from client host
26352.endd
26353The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26354by which time Exim has set up the message.
26355
26356
26357
26358.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26359.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26360The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26361
26362.vlist
26363.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26364This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26365incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26366accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26367
26368.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26369.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26370.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26371This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26372continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26373the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26374update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26375write rather ugly lines like this:
26376.display
26377&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26378.endd
26379Instead, all you need is
26380.display
26381&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26382.endd
26383
26384.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26385.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26386This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26387incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26388lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26389lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26390controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26391even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26392
26393As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26394separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26395in several different ways. For example:
26396
26397. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26398. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26399. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26400. ==== way.
26401
26402.ilist
26403It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26404.code
26405 accept ...some conditions
26406 control = queue_only
26407.endd
26408In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26409other words, when the conditions are all true.
26410
26411.next
26412It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26413.code
26414 accept ...some conditions...
26415 control = queue_only
26416 ...some more conditions...
26417.endd
26418If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26419statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26420In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26421to be relevant.
26422
26423.next
26424It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26425decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26426example:
26427.code
26428 warn ...some conditions...
26429 control = freeze
26430 accept ...
26431.endd
26432This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26433&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26434log entry.
26435
26436.next
26437If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26438&%require%& verb. For example:
26439.code
26440 require control = no_multiline_responses
26441.endd
26442.endlist
26443
26444.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26445.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26446.oindex "&%-bh%&"
26447This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
26448interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
26449option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
26450instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
26451as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
26452flushed before the delay is imposed.
26453
26454Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26455example:
26456.code
26457deny ...some conditions...
26458 delay = 30s
26459.endd
26460The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26461&"deny"&. Compare this with:
26462.code
26463deny delay = 30s
26464 ...some conditions...
26465.endd
26466which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26467can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26468.code
26469warn ...some conditions...
26470 delay = 2m
26471 control = freeze
26472accept ...
26473.endd
26474
26475If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26476responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26477they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26478delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26479appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26480unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26481using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26482
26483
26484.vitem &*endpass*&
26485.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26486This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26487&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26488failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26489failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26490confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26491&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26492
26493
26494.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26495.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26496This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26497ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26498.code
26499require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
26500 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26501.endd
26502&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
26503example:
26504.display
26505&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
26506&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
26507.endd
26508When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
26509that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
26510recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
26511message.
26512
26513The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
26514the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
26515denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
26516available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
26517variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
26518&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
26519ignored.
26520
26521.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26522If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
26523verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
26524error message.
26525
26526If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
26527the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
26528more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
26529actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
26530of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
26531is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
26532
26533If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
26534example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
26535the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
26536logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
26537both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
26538logging rejections.
26539
26540
26541.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
26542.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
26543.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
26544This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
26545about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
26546be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
26547may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
26548ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
26549.display
26550&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
26551&` log_reject_target =`&
26552.endd
26553This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
26554permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
26555current ACL.
26556
26557
26558.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26559.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
26560.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
26561This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
26562processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
26563&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
26564access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
26565ACLs. For example:
26566.display
26567&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
26568&` control = freeze`&
26569&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
26570.endd
26571By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
26572with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
26573another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
26574example:
26575.code
26576logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
26577logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
26578.endd
26579
26580
26581.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26582.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26583This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
26584message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
26585or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
26586there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
26587&%accept%& for details.)
26588
26589The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
26590to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
26591generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
26592&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
26593the &%hosts%& condition fails:
26594.code
26595require message = Host not recognized
26596 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
26597.endd
26598(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
26599processed.)
26600
26601.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
26602.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
26603For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
26604of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
26605is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
26606is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
26607overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
26608accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
26609truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
26610EHLO options.
26611
26612When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
26613consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
26614of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
26615.code
26616deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
26617 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
26618.endd
26619The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
26620by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
26621access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
266222&'xx'&.
26623
26624Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
26625the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
26626
26627The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
26628literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
26629anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
26630response.
26631
26632.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26633If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
26634specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
26635However, the original message is available in the variable
26636&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
26637wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
26638routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
26639use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
26640
26641For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
26642is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
26643modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
26644all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
26645&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
26646&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
26647effect.
26648
26649
26650.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
26651.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
26652This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
26653&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
26654.endlist
26655
26656
26657
26658
26659
26660.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
26661.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26662The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
26663
26664.vlist
26665.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
26666This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
26667has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
26668apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
26669HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
26670really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
26671not work without it. For example:
26672.code
26673warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
26674 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
26675.endd
26676Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
26677the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
26678matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
26679mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
26680by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
26681
26682
26683.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
26684 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
26685.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
26686.cindex "case of local parts"
26687.vindex "&$local_part$&"
26688These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
26689(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
26690are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
26691any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
26692for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
26693is encountered.
26694
26695These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
26696local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
26697in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
26698handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
26699configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
26700
26701This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
26702containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
26703spam score:
26704.code
26705warn control = caseful_local_part
26706 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
26707 $acl_m4 + \
26708 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
26709 }
26710 control = caselower_local_part
26711.endd
26712Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
26713is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
26714
26715
26716.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
26717.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
26718.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
26719This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
26720with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
26721&'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
26722may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
26723the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
26724option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
26725contexts):
26726.code
26727 control = debug
26728 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
26729 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
26730 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
26731.endd
26732
26733
26734.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
26735 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
26736.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
26737.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
26738These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
26739is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
26740state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
26741in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
26742
26743The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26744connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
26745messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
26746&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
26747before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
26748synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
26749work with.
26750
26751
26752.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
26753.cindex "fake defer"
26754.cindex "defer, fake"
26755This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
26756except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
26757550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
26758messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
26759use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
26760
26761.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
26762.cindex "fake rejection"
26763.cindex "rejection, fake"
26764This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
26765words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
26766message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
26767However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
26768only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26769the same SMTP connection.
26770
26771The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
26772message is supplied, the following is used:
26773.code
26774550-Your message has been rejected but is being
26775550-kept for evaluation.
26776550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
26777550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
26778.endd
26779This facility should be used with extreme caution.
26780
26781.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
26782.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
26783This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26784other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26785it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
26786current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
26787SMTP connection.
26788
26789This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
26790&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
26791is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
26792are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
26793
26794.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
26795.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
26796Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
26797avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26798use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
26799disables such output flushing.
26800
26801.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
26802.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
26803Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
26804avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
26805use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
26806that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
26807
26808.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
26809This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
26810extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
26811of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
26812or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
26813needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
26814only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
26815the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
26816to be useful in production.
26817
26818.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
26819.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
26820This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
26821It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
26822SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
26823
26824If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
26825suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
26826one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
26827(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
26828responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
26829sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
26830
26831.ilist
26832Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
26833sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
26834verification failed"&) is sent.
26835.next
26836If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
26837line is output.
26838.endlist
26839
26840The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
26841calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
26842
26843.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
26844.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
26845This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
26846the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
26847response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
26848controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
26849&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
26850
26851.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
26852.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
26853.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
26854This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
26855other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
26856it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
26857runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
26858effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
26859to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
26860same SMTP connection.
26861
26862.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
26863.cindex "message" "submission"
26864.cindex "submission mode"
26865This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
26866latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
26867the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
26868operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
26869necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
26870This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
26871late (the message has already been created).
26872
26873Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
26874messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
26875submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
26876The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
26877that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
26878
26879.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
26880.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
26881This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
26882complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
26883normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
26884
26885.ilist
26886Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
26887dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
26888.next
26889No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
26890.next
26891There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
26892.endlist ilist
26893
26894This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
26895passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
26896used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
26897and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
26898data is read.
26899
26900&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
26901that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
26902.endlist vlist
26903
26904
26905.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
26906All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
26907
26908.ilist
26909Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
26910.next
26911Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
26912&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
26913.next
26914Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
26915.next
26916Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
26917.endlist
26918
26919
26920
26921.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
26922.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
26923.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
26924.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26925The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
26926to an incoming message, as in this example:
26927.code
26928warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26929 dialup.mail-abuse.org
26930 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
26931.endd
26932The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
26933MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
26934receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
26935&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
26936any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
26937RCPT ACL).
26938
26939If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
26940are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
26941lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
26942front of any line that is not a valid header line.
26943
26944Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
26945They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
26946However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
26947is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
26948during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
26949with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
26950lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
26951In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
26952non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
26953message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
26954are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
26955
26956.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
26957Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
26958message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
26959ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
26960header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
26961ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
26962passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
26963this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
26964&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
26965
26966The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
26967processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
26968.display
26969&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26970&` `&<&'some condition'&>
26971
26972&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
26973&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26974.endd
26975In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
26976condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
26977condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
26978ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
26979honoured.
26980
26981.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26982For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
26983&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
26984effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
26985them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
26986usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
26987are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
26988specifications.
26989
26990By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
26991header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
26992be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
26993after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
26994that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
26995
26996This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
26997&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
26998header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
26999to be a header name first.) For example:
27000.code
27001warn add_header = \
27002 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27003.endd
27004If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27005each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27006you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27007up in reverse order.
27008
27009&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27010added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27011system filter or in a router or transport.
27012
27013
27014
27015
27016.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27017.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27018Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27019compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27020for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27021content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27022
27023Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27024senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27025result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27026done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27027can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27028same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27029The conditions are as follows:
27030
27031
27032.vlist
27033.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27034.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27035.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27036.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27037The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27038&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27039&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27040false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27041condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27042condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27043ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27044
27045If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27046the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27047&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27048conditions are tested.
27049
27050ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27051loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27052circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27053for different local users or different local domains.
27054
27055.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27056.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27057.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27058.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27059If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27060the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27061authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27062.code
27063authenticated = *
27064.endd
27065
27066.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27067.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27068.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27069.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27070.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27071This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27072expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27073&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27074number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27075any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27076&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27077ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27078negative.
27079
27080.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27081.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27082This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27083content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27084&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27085If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27086problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27087chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27088
27089.vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27090.cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27091This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27092content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27093&<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27094
27095.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27096.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27097.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27098.cindex "black list (DNS)"
27099.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27100This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27101&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27102use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27103different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27104&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27105
27106.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27107.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27108.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27109.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27110.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27111This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27112of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27113enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27114lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27115&%domains%& test.
27116
27117&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27118use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27119
27120
27121.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27122.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27123.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27124.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27125If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27126name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27127encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27128.code
27129encrypted = *
27130.endd
27131
27132
27133.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
27134.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27135.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27136.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27137This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27138name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27139you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27140.code
27141accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27142.endd
27143The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27144the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27145and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27146
27147The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27148Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27149but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27150find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27151opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27152found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27153
27154If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27155address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27156.code
27157accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27158accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27159.endd
27160The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27161is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27162statement can then check the IP address.
27163
27164.vindex "&$host_data$&"
27165If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27166of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27167allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27168.code
27169deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27170message = $host_data
27171.endd
27172which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27173
27174.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27175.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27176.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27177.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27178.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27179This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27180part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27181enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27182result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27183the next &%local_parts%& test.
27184
27185.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27186.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27187.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27188.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27189This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27190content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27191viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27192
27193.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27194.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27195.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27196This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27197content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27198&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27199with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27200&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27201
27202.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27203.cindex "rate limiting"
27204This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27205messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27206
27207.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27208.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27209.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27210.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27211This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27212recipient address against a list of recipients.
27213
27214.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27215.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27216.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27217This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27218content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27219non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27220any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27221
27222.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27223.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27224.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27225.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27226.vindex "&$domain$&"
27227.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27228This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27229domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27230&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27231of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27232lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27233RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27234influence the sender checking.
27235
27236&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27237relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27238
27239.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27240.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27241.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27242.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27243This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27244for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27245.code
27246senders = :
27247.endd
27248&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27249relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27250
27251.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27252.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27253.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27254This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27255content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27256SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27257
27258.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27259.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27260.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27261.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27262.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27263.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27264This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27265certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27266server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27267or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27268
27269.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27270.cindex "CSA verification"
27271This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27272send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27273&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27274
27275.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27276.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27277.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27278.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27279.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27280.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27281This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27282received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27283&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27284of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27285is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27286However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27287that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27288to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27289might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27290
27291Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27292section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27293&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27294condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27295.code
27296deny senders = :
27297 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27298 !verify = header_sender
27299.endd
27300
27301.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27302.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27303.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27304.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27305.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27306This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27307received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27308&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27309lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27310and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27311permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27312&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27313appropriate.
27314
27315Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27316ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27317.code
27318To: @
27319.endd
27320and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27321common as they used to be.
27322
27323.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27324.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27325.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27326.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27327.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27328.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27329.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27330This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27331client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27332attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27333condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27334&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27335independently of this condition.
27336
27337For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27338option), this condition is always true.
27339
27340
27341.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27342.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27343.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27344This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27345Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27346&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27347case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27348&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27349used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27350
27351There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27352recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27353
27354
27355.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
27356.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27357.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
27358.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
27359.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
27360.vindex "&$address_data$&"
27361This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
27362recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
27363&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
27364of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
27365This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
27366verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
27367address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
27368value for the child address.
27369
27370.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
27371.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27372.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
27373.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
27374This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
27375address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
27376was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
27377Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
27378one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
27379original IP address.
27380
27381If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
27382is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
27383
27384.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
27385.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27386.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
27387.cindex "sender" "verifying"
27388.cindex "verifying" "sender"
27389This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
27390message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
27391the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
27392condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
27393
27394.vindex "&$address_data$&"
27395.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
27396If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
27397value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
27398value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
27399statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
27400want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
27401
27402Details of verification are given later, starting at section
27403&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
27404to avoid doing it more than once per message.
27405
27406.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
27407.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27408This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
27409verified as a sender.
27410.endlist
27411
27412
27413
27414.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
27415.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27416.cindex "black list (DNS)"
27417.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27418In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
27419is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
27420address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
27421domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
27422special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
27423address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
27424.code
27425deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
27426 dialups.mail-abuse.org
27427.endd
27428the following records are looked up:
27429.code
2743043.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
2743143.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
27432.endd
27433As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
27434Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
27435to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
27436use two separate conditions:
27437.code
27438deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27439 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27440.endd
27441If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
27442behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
27443record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
27444processed.
27445
27446This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
27447(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
27448blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
27449following special items in the list:
27450.display
27451&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
27452&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
27453&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
27454.endd
27455.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
27456.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
27457.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
27458Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
27459.code
27460deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
27461.endd
27462Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
27463warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
27464.code
27465deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27466warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
27467 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27468.endd
27469DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
27470so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
27471connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
27472connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
27473
27474
27475
27476.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
27477.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
27478By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
27479of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
27480after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
27481.code
27482deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
27483.endd
27484This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
27485use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
27486MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
27487&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
27488
27489
27490
27491
27492.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
27493.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
27494There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
27495addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
27496&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
27497with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
27498listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
27499.code
27500deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
27501 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27502.endd
27503This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
27504RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
27505example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
27506up by this example is
27507.code
27508tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
27509.endd
27510A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
27511addresses. For example:
27512.code
27513deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27514 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27515.endd
27516The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
27517name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
27518
27519
27520
27521
27522.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
27523.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
27524The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
27525names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
27526name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
27527As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
27528this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
27529either to double the separators like this:
27530.code
27531dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
27532.endd
27533or to change the separator character, like this:
27534.code
27535dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
27536.endd
27537If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
27538blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
27539occurs. Consider this condition:
27540.code
27541dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
27542.endd
27543The DNS lookups that occur are:
27544.code
275452.1.168.192.black.list.tld
27546a.domain.black.list.tld
27547.endd
27548Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
27549address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
27550are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
27551or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
27552only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
27553successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
27554error for a previous item.
27555
27556The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
27557syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
27558.code
27559dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
27560dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
27561.endd
27562However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
27563is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
27564.code
27565deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
27566 $sender_address_domain \
27567 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
27568 see $dnslist_text.
27569 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
27570 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
27571 $sender_address_domain} }} }
27572.endd
27573Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
27574multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
27575and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
27576of expanding the condition might be something like this:
27577.code
27578dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
27579.endd
27580Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
27581domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
27582
27583The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
27584&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
27585
27586
27587
27588
27589.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
27590.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
27591DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
27592just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
27593RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
27594The values used on the RBL+ list are:
27595.display
27596127.1.0.1 RBL
27597127.1.0.2 DUL
27598127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
27599127.1.0.4 RSS
27600127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
27601127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
27602127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
27603.endd
27604Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
27605different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
27606see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
27607
27608
27609.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
27610.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
27611.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
27612.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
27613.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
27614.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
27615.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
27616When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
27617the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
27618&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
27619(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
27620the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
27621&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
27622cases, for example:
27623.code
27624deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
27625.endd
27626the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
27627&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
27628For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
27629might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
27630.code
27631deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
27632.endd
27633If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
27634&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
27635
27636If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
27637addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
27638The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
27639record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
27640very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
27641information.
27642
27643You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
27644&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
27645expanded until after it has failed. For example:
27646.code
27647deny hosts = !+local_networks
27648 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
27649 at $dnslist_domain
27650 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
27651.endd
27652
27653
27654
27655.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
27656.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
27657You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
27658in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
27659For example,
27660.code
27661deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
27662.endd
27663rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
27664any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
27665that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
27666describes how multiple records are handled.
27667
27668More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
27669separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
27670&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
27671.code
27672deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27673.endd
27674If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
27675addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
27676first. For example:
27677.code
27678deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
27679 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
27680.endd
27681
27682If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
27683listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
27684In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
27685true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
27686tested. For example:
27687.code
27688dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
27689.endd
27690matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
27691want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
27692being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
27693.code
27694dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27695.endd
27696matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
27697an odd number.
27698
27699
27700
27701.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
27702You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
27703condition. Whereas
27704.code
27705deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27706.endd
27707means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27708IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
27709.code
27710deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27711.endd
27712means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27713IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
27714words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
27715the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
27716
27717&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
27718host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
27719
27720If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
27721previous example is precisely equivalent to
27722.code
27723deny dnslists = a.b.c
27724 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27725.endd
27726However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
27727Consider this example:
27728.code
27729deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27730 list.dsbl.org : \
27731 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
27732 relays.ordb.org
27733.endd
27734Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
27735.code
27736deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27737 list.dsbl.org
27738deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
27739 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
27740deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
27741.endd
27742which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
27743
27744
27745
27746
27747.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
27748A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
27749thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
27750is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
27751the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
27752the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
27753.code
27754dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
27755.endd
27756What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
27757127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
27758condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
27759because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
27760affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
27761additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
27762
27763.ilist
27764If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
27765IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
27766condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27767.next
27768If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
27769looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
27770changed to:
27771.code
27772dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
27773.endd
27774and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27775false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
27776.code
27777dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
27778.endd
27779for the condition to be true.
27780.endlist
27781
27782When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
27783the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
27784.ilist
27785If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
27786addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
27787.code
27788dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
27789.endd
27790If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27791false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
27792.next
27793If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
27794looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
27795.code
27796dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
27797.endd
27798If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
27799true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
27800.code
27801dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27802.endd
27803for the condition to be false.
27804.endlist
27805When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
27806between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
27807
27808
27809
27810
27811.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
27812.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
27813When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
27814the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
27815the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
27816address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
27817only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
27818can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
27819in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
27820lists.
27821
27822A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
27823two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
27824do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
27825If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
27826restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
27827a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
27828domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
27829.code
27830reject message = \
27831 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
27832 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
27833 dnslists = \
27834 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
27835 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27836.endd
27837For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
27838&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
27839match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
27840value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
27841record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
27842The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
27843
27844If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
27845given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
27846the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
27847.code
27848reject dnslists = \
27849 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
27850 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
27851 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
27852 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
27853.endd
27854In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
27855values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
27856done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
27857
27858
27859
27860.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
27861.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
27862.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
27863If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
27864nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
278653ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
27866.code
278671.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
27868 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27869.endd
27870(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
27871lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
27872IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
27873.code
27874*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
27875.endd
27876is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
27877Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
27878
27879You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
27880&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
27881.code
27882deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
27883 dnslists = some.list.example
27884.endd
27885
27886.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
27887.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
27888.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
27889.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
27890The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
27891which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
27892&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
27893commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
27894works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
27895host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
27896.display
27897&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
27898.endd
27899If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
27900period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
27901
27902As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
27903&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
27904configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
27905of &'p'&.
27906
27907The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
27908time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
27909means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
27910parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
27911send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
27912in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
27913constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
27914changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
27915both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
27916
27917There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
27918log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
27919when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
27920instructions when it is run with no arguments.
27921
27922The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
27923sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
27924retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
27925which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
27926By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
27927of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
27928user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
27929&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
27930example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
27931authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
27932
27933The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
27934rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
27935&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
27936ACL.
27937
27938Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
27939specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
27940or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
27941&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
27942using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
27943separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
27944
27945Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
27946any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
27947stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
27948remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
27949remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
27950behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
27951the &%count=%& option.
27952
27953
27954.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
27955.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
27956The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
27957normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
27958&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
27959
27960The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
27961the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
27962&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
27963&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
27964
27965The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
27966the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
27967in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
27968used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
27969in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
27970follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
27971in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
27972
27973The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
27974accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27975&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
27976&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
27977ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
27978in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
27979recipients as a large high-speed burst.
27980
27981The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
27982number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
27983last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
27984recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
27985&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
27986
27987The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
27988condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
27989command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
27990multiple different commands.
27991
27992The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
27993measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
27994&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
27995increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
27996other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
27997
27998The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
27999
28000
28001.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28002.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28003You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28004control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28005mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28006
28007If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28008previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28009
28010For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28011it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28012can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28013in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28014new rate.
28015.code
28016acl_check_connect:
28017 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28018 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28019 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28020# ...
28021acl_check_mail:
28022 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28023 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28024 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28025.endd
28026
28027If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28028processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28029it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28030in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28031same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28032multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28033checks.
28034
28035The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28036use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28037update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28038&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28039next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28040
28041
28042.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28043.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28044If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28045engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28046&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28047counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28048rest of the ACL.
28049
28050The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28051updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28052client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28053the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28054counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28055email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28056is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28057For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28058from getting any email through.
28059
28060The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28061updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28062of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28063actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28064counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28065pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28066again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28067attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28068.code
28069 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28070.endd
28071
28072
28073.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28074.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28075The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28076rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28077mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28078sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28079&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28080measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28081options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28082
28083For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28084has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28085rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28086per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28087go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28088recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28089
28090When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28091&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28092rate.
28093
28094The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28095other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28096unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28097required increases with larger limits.
28098
28099The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28100will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28101the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28102the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28103events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28104times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28105throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28106limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28107are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28108as intended.
28109
28110
28111.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28112Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28113when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28114(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28115policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28116message. For example:
28117.code
28118# Log all senders' rates
28119warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28120 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28121
28122# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28123# at the decimal point.
28124warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28125 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28126 $sender_rate_limit }s
28127
28128# Keep authenticated users under control
28129deny authenticated = *
28130 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28131
28132# System-wide rate limit
28133defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28134 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28135
28136# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28137# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28138defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28139 messages per $sender_rate_period
28140 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28141 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28142 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28143.endd
28144&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28145especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28146bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28147making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28148RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28149this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28150hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28151
28152
28153
28154.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28155.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28156.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28157Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28158&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28159&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28160The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28161verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28162other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28163.code
28164verify = sender/callout
28165verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28166.endd
28167The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28168address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28169difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28170be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28171(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28172The available options are as follows:
28173
28174.ilist
28175If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28176remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28177check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28178.next
28179If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28180normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28181options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28182verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28183.next
28184The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28185discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28186.next
28187The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28188immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28189generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28190discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28191.endlist
28192
28193.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28194.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28195.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28196.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28197After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28198error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28199coding like this:
28200.code
28201warn !verify = sender
28202 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28203.endd
28204If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28205denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28206verification failure.
28207
28208In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28209appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28210
28211.ilist
28212&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28213was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28214.next
28215&%route%&: Routing failed.
28216.next
28217&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28218occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28219connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28220.next
28221&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28222.next
28223&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28224.endlist
28225
28226The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28227rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28228
28229
28230
28231
28232.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28233.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28234.cindex "callout" "verification"
28235.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28236For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28237checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28238the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28239&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28240a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28241address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28242sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28243deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28244sender's domain.
28245
28246Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28247request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28248described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28249lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28250cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28251caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28252
28253Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28254the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28255callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28256callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28257on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28258
28259If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28260second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28261one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28262&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28263router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28264&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28265&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28266supplies a host list.
28267
28268The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28269remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28270specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28271specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28272specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28273the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28274&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28275
28276For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28277test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28278following SMTP commands are sent:
28279.display
28280&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28281&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
28282&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28283&`QUIT`&
28284.endd
28285LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28286set to &"lmtp"&.
28287
28288A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28289for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28290the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28291that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28292do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28293&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28294
28295If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28296succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28297Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28298hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28299&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28300
28301.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28302A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28303output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28304clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28305disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28306
28307
28308
28309
28310.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28311.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28312The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28313optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28314.code
28315verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28316.endd
28317The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28318separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28319deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28320
28321
28322.vlist
28323.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28324.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28325This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28326For example:
28327.code
28328verify = sender/callout=5s
28329.endd
28330The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28331remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28332the &%connect%& parameter.
28333
28334
28335.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28336.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28337This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28338for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28339.code
28340verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28341.endd
28342If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28343
28344.vitem &*defer_ok*&
28345.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28346When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28347of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28348updated in this circumstance.
28349
28350.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
28351.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
28352This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
28353&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
28354accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
28355unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
28356
28357
28358.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28359.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
28360When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
28361verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
28362sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
28363whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
28364MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
28365as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
28366(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
28367address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
28368.code
28369require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
28370.endd
28371This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
28372
28373
28374.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28375.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
28376This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
28377For example:
28378.code
28379verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
28380.endd
28381This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
28382commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
28383be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
28384very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
28385(for example, when network connections are timing out).
28386
28387
28388.vitem &*no_cache*&
28389.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
28390.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
28391When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
28392
28393.vitem &*postmaster*&
28394.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
28395When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
28396check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
28397rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
28398the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
28399used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
28400made, until the cache record expires.
28401
28402.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28403The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
28404You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
28405For example:
28406.code
28407require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
28408.endd
28409If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
28410one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
28411.code
28412require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
28413.endd
28414&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
28415account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
28416a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
28417postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
28418
28419
28420.vitem &*random*&
28421.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
28422When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
28423check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
28424really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
28425&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
28426.code
28427$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
28428.endd
28429The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
28430parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
28431specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
28432a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
28433succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
28434
28435.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
28436.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
28437This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28438.code
28439deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
28440.endd
28441.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
28442It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
28443performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
28444that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
28445domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
28446
28447.vitem &*use_sender*&
28448This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28449.code
28450require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
28451.endd
28452It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
28453command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
28454need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
28455sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
28456usefulness of callout caching.
28457.endlist
28458
28459If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
28460command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
28461&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
28462usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
28463that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
28464Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
28465these circumstances.
28466
28467However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
28468host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
28469callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
28470sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
28471callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
28472own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
28473is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
28474
28475Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
28476caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
28477by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
28478actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
28479
28480
28481
28482
28483.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
28484.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
28485.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
28486.cindex "caching" "callout"
28487Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
28488used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
28489option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
28490different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
28491a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
28492entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
28493
28494When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
28495the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
28496is not available.
28497
28498The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
28499independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
28500(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
28501
28502If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
28503commands up to and including
28504.code
28505MAIL FROM:<>
28506.endd
28507(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
28508any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
28509domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
28510making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
28511separate expiry times for domain cache records:
28512&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
28513&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
28514
28515Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
28516cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
28517Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
28518ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
28519will eventually be noticed.
28520
28521The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
28522being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
28523behaviour will be the same.
28524
28525
28526
28527.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
28528.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
28529See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
28530verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
28531failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
28532relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
28533you might see:
28534.code
28535MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
28536250 OK
28537RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
28538550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
28539550-Called: 192.168.34.43
28540550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
28541550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
28542550 Sender verification failed
28543.endd
28544If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
28545only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
28546out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
28547&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
28548example:
28549.code
28550verify = sender/no_details
28551.endd
28552
28553.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
28554.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
28555.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
28556A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
28557during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
28558or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
28559it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
28560
28561.ilist
28562When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
28563continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
28564verification also fails.
28565.next
28566When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
28567verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
28568.endlist
28569
28570This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
28571way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
28572example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
28573.code
28574A.Wol: aw123
28575aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
28576.endd
28577work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
28578redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
28579mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
28580verification to succeed.
28581
28582It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
28583redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
28584generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
28585option. For example:
28586.code
28587require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
28588.endd
28589In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
28590the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
28591
28592When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
28593redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
28594also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
28595address and a report is output for each of them.
28596
28597
28598
28599.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
28600.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
28601Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
28602which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
28603special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
28604domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
28605Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
28606.code
28607verify = csa
28608.endd
28609This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
28610valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
28611succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
28612&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
28613&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
28614be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
28615
28616The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
28617detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
28618looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
28619address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
28620
28621.ilist
28622The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
28623.next
28624The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
28625.next
28626The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
28627(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
28628.next
28629The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
28630that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
28631.endlist
28632
28633The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
28634use for the DNS query. The default is:
28635.code
28636verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
28637.endd
28638This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
28639is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
28640address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
28641the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
28642meaningful to say:
28643.code
28644verify = csa/$sender_host_address
28645.endd
28646In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
28647This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
28648&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
28649
28650If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
28651is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
28652making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
28653using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
28654default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
28655default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
28656(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
28657of legitimate HELO domains.
28658
28659The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
28660direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
28661search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
28662addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
28663lookup such as:
28664.code
28665${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
28666.endd
28667has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
28668The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
28669authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
28670
28671
28672
28673
28674.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
28675.cindex "BATV, verifying"
28676Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
28677of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
28678Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
28679recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
28680bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
28681spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
28682
28683There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
28684&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
28685the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
28686address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
28687item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
28688The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
28689&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
28690
28691As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
28692database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
28693like this:
28694.code
28695PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
28696 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
28697 }{$value}}
28698.endd
28699Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
28700list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
28701use this:
28702.code
28703# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
28704deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
28705 senders = :
28706 recipients = +batv_senders
28707
28708# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
28709deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
28710 senders = :
28711 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
28712 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
28713 !condition = $prvscheck_result
28714.endd
28715The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
28716to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
28717send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
28718recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
28719the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
28720
28721A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
28722&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
28723prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
28724the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
28725the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
28726timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
28727of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
28728
28729There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
28730you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
28731deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
28732router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
28733.code
28734batv_redirect:
28735 driver = redirect
28736 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
28737.endd
28738This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
28739of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
28740address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
28741local addresses.
28742
28743To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
28744can be used:
28745.code
28746external_smtp_batv:
28747 driver = smtp
28748 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
28749 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
28750 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
28751 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
28752 {$value}fail}}}
28753.endd
28754If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
28755
28756
28757
28758.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
28759.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
28760.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
28761.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
28762An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
28763delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
28764within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
28765passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
28766.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
28767but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
28768
28769Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
28770A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
28771relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
28772a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
28773with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
28774same host is fulfilling both functions,
28775. ///
28776. as illustrated in the diagram below,
28777. ///
28778but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
28779not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
28780system to arbitrary domains.
28781
28782
28783You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
28784runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
28785Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
28786example, suppose you want to do the following:
28787
28788.ilist
28789Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
28790locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
28791&'my.dom2.example'&.
28792.next
28793Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
28794These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
28795.next
28796Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
28797Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
28798.endlist
28799
28800
28801In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
28802.code
28803domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
28804domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
28805hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
28806.endd
28807Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
28808command:
28809.code
28810acl_check_rcpt:
28811 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
28812 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
28813.endd
28814The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
28815the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
28816statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
28817hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
28818than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
28819default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
28820in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28821
28822
28823
28824.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
28825.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
28826You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
28827that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
28828the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28829
28830For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
28831&'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
28832host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
28833will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
28834patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
28835trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
28836results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
28837.ecindex IIDacl
28838
28839
28840
28841. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28842. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28843
28844.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
28845.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
28846The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
28847as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
28848was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
28849maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
28850specification.
28851
28852It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
28853&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
28854scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
28855messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
28856chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
28857
28858If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
28859Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
28860&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
28861
28862.ilist
28863Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
28864for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
28865.next
28866Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
28867&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
28868run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
28869.next
28870An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
28871of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
28872.next
28873Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
28874conditions.
28875.next
28876Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
28877.endlist
28878
28879There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
28880called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
28881condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
28882
28883Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
28884added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
28885changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
28886EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
28887this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
28888&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
28889
28890All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
28891temporarily created in a file called:
28892.display
28893<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
28894.endd
28895The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
28896expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
28897first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
28898scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
28899removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
28900.code
28901control = no_mbox_unspool
28902.endd
28903has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
28904same directory by default.
28905
28906
28907
28908.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
28909.cindex "virus scanning"
28910.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
28911.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
28912The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
28913It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
28914specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
28915in memory and thus are much faster.
28916
28917
28918.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
28919You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
28920file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
28921are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
28922.display
28923&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
28924.endd
28925If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
28926.code
28927av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
28928.endd
28929If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
28930before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
28931
28932.vlist
28933.vitem &%aveserver%&
28934.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28935This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
28936at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
28937which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
28938example:
28939.code
28940av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
28941.endd
28942
28943
28944.vitem &%clamd%&
28945.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
28946This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
28947&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
28948unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
28949in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
28950required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
28951number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
28952.code
28953av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
28954av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
28955av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
28956.endd
28957If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
28958keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
28959to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
28960more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
28961Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
28962There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
28963you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
28964If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
28965contributing the code for this scanner.
28966
28967.vitem &%cmdline%&
28968.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
28969This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
28970used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
28971type takes 3 mandatory options:
28972
28973.olist
28974The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
28975and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
28976
28977.next
28978A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
28979virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
28980absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
28981the &"trigger"& expression.
28982
28983.next
28984Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
28985match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
28986&"name"& expression.
28987.endlist olist
28988
28989For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
28990.code
28991Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
28992.endd
28993For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
28994name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
28995for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
28996configuration setting:
28997.code
28998av_scanner = cmdline:\
28999 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29000 found in file:'(.+)'
29001.endd
29002.vitem &%drweb%&
29003.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29004The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29005argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29006separated by white space, as in these examples:
29007.code
29008av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29009av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29010.endd
29011If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29012is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29013
29014.vitem &%fsecure%&
29015.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29016The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29017argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29018.code
29019av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29020.endd
29021If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29022Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29023
29024.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29025.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29026This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29027Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29028scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29029For example:
29030.code
29031av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29032.endd
29033The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29034
29035.vitem &%mksd%&
29036.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29037This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29038parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29039&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29040the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29041provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29042been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29043.code
29044av_scanner = mksd:2
29045.endd
29046You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29047
29048.vitem &%sophie%&
29049.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29050Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29051You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29052for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29053client communication. For example:
29054.code
29055av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29056.endd
29057The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29058the option.
29059.endlist
29060
29061When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29062the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29063ACL.
29064
29065The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29066makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29067The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29068for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29069However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29070which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29071message.
29072
29073The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29074use. It can then be one of
29075
29076.ilist
29077&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29078The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29079recommended usage.
29080.next
29081&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29082the condition fails immediately.
29083.next
29084A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29085condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29086expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29087.endlist
29088
29089You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29090even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29091causes the ACL to defer.
29092
29093.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29094When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29095&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29096&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29097logging data.
29098
29099If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29100use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29101&%malware%& condition.
29102
29103Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29104imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29105
29106Here is a very simple scanning example:
29107.code
29108deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29109 demime = *
29110 malware = *
29111.endd
29112The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29113.code
29114deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29115 demime = *
29116 malware = */defer_ok
29117.endd
29118The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29119aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29120.code
29121av_scanner = $acl_m0
29122.endd
29123in the main Exim configuration.
29124.code
29125deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29126 set acl_m0 = sophie
29127 malware = *
29128
29129deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29130 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29131 malware = *
29132.endd
29133
29134
29135.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29136.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29137.cindex "spam scanning"
29138.cindex "SpamAssassin"
29139The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29140score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29141&url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29142installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29143.code
29144perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29145.endd
29146SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29147documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29148nicely, however.
29149
29150.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29151After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29152By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29153port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29154part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29155.code
29156spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29157.endd
29158You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29159&%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29160these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29161address/port pair:
29162.code
29163spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29164.endd
29165You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29166reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29167&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29168option, separated with colons:
29169.code
29170spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29171 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29172 192.168.2.12 783
29173.endd
29174Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29175fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29176servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29177condition defers.
29178
29179&*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29180multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29181
29182The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29183a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29184used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29185expansion.
29186
29187.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29188Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29189.code
29190deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29191 spam = joe
29192.endd
29193The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29194relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29195to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29196default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29197However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29198
29199The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29200principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29201have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29202&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29203read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29204are not set.
29205
29206The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29207you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29208&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29209
29210
29211Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29212large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29213are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29214example:
29215.code
29216deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29217 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29218 spam = nobody
29219.endd
29220
29221The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29222SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29223&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29224it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29225
29226.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29227When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29228variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29229available for use at delivery time.
29230
29231.vlist
29232.vitem &$spam_score$&
29233The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29234for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29235
29236.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29237The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29238example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29239because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29240The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29241
29242.vitem &$spam_bar$&
29243A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29244integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29245&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29246headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29247
29248.vitem &$spam_report$&
29249A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29250message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29251.endlist
29252
29253The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29254spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29255does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29256
29257The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29258the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29259failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29260statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29261spam condition, like this:
29262.code
29263deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29264 spam = joe/defer_ok
29265.endd
29266This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29267
29268Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29269condition:
29270.code
29271# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29272warn spam = nobody:true
29273 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29274 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29275
29276# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29277# is over threshold
29278warn spam = nobody
29279 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29280
29281# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29282deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29283 spam = nobody:true
29284 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29285.endd
29286
29287
29288
29289.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29290.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29291.cindex "MIME content scanning"
29292.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29293.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29294The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29295each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29296of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29297specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29298options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29299cases.
29300
29301These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29302ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29303the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29304message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29305ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29306result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29307&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29308
29309You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29310only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29311condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29312&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29313&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29314
29315At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29316information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29317of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29318parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29319part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29320syntax is:
29321.display
29322&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29323.endd
29324The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29325the value can be:
29326
29327.olist
29328&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29329.next
29330The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29331&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
29332a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
29333full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
29334.next
29335A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
29336directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
29337is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
29338the full path and file name.
29339.next
29340If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
29341filename, and the default path is then used.
29342.endlist
29343The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
29344errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
29345a file with its original, proposed filename using
29346.code
29347decode = $mime_filename
29348.endd
29349However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
29350anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
29351automatically unlinked.
29352
29353For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
29354content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
29355as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
29356variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
29357before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
29358
29359The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
29360used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
29361respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
29362
29363.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
29364The following list describes all expansion variables that are
29365available in the MIME ACL:
29366
29367.vlist
29368.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
29369If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
29370have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
29371has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
29372contains the empty string.
29373
29374.vitem &$mime_charset$&
29375This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
29376&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
29377.code
29378us-ascii
29379gb2312 (Chinese)
29380iso-8859-1
29381.endd
29382Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
29383case-insensitively.
29384
29385.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
29386This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
29387header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
29388implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
29389only used for display purposes.
29390
29391.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
29392This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
29393header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
29394
29395.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
29396This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
29397This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
29398
29399.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
29400This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29401successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
29402size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
29403has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
29404
29405.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
29406This variable contains the normalized content of the
29407&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
29408type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
29409
29410.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
29411If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
29412value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
29413are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
29414.code
29415text/plain
29416text/html
29417application/octet-stream
29418image/jpeg
29419audio/midi
29420.endd
29421If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
29422empty string.
29423
29424.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
29425This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29426successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
29427containing the decoded data.
29428.endlist
29429
29430.cindex "RFC 2047"
29431.vlist
29432.vitem &$mime_filename$&
29433This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
29434proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
29435&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
29436RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
29437found, this variable contains the empty string.
29438
29439.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
29440This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
29441attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
29442content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
29443
29444The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
29445cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
29446follows:
29447
29448.olist
29449The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
29450
29451.next
29452If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
29453so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
29454
29455.next
29456If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
29457and the rest are attachments.
29458
29459.next
29460All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
29461.endlist olist
29462
29463As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
29464alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
29465coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
29466.code
29467deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
29468!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
29469condition = $mime_is_coverletter
29470condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
29471.endd
29472.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
29473This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
29474&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
29475Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
29476want to carry out specific actions on them.
29477
29478.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
29479This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
29480checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
29481decoding is fully recursive.
29482
29483.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
29484This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
29485starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
29486counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
29487&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
29488complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
29489parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
29490.endlist
29491
29492
29493
29494.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
29495.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
29496.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
29497You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
29498the message, or on individual MIME parts.
29499
29500The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
29501matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
29502MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
29503linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
29504have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
29505
29506The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
29507to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
29508part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
29509is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
29510and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
2951132K characters are checked.
29512
29513The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
29514literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
29515expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
29516with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
29517Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
29518.code
29519deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
29520 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
29521.endd
29522The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
29523&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
29524matching regular expression.
29525
29526&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
29527CPU-intensive.
29528
29529
29530
29531
29532.section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
29533.cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
29534.cindex "MIME content scanning"
29535The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
29536extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
29537&%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
29538ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
29539condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
29540the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
29541use the &%demime%& condition.
29542
29543The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
29544errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
29545against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
29546parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
29547scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
29548antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
29549
29550On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
29551colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
29552example:
29553.code
29554deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
29555 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
29556.endd
29557If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
29558false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
29559full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
29560the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
29561
29562The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
29563conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
29564zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
29565
29566The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
29567
29568.vlist
29569.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
29570.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
29571When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
29572severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
29573severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
29574zero, no error occurred.
29575
29576.vitem &$demime_reason$&
29577.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
29578When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
29579human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
29580.endlist
29581
29582.vlist
29583.vitem &$found_extension$&
29584.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
29585When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
29586extension it found.
29587.endlist
29588
29589Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
29590the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
29591
29592If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
29593condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
29594right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
29595facility:
29596.code
29597# Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
29598deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
29599 demime = *
29600 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
29601
29602# Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
29603# Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
29604deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
29605 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
29606
29607# Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
29608# examine them and eventually thaw them.
29609deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
29610 demime = exe:doc
29611 control = freeze
29612.endd
29613.ecindex IIDcosca
29614
29615
29616
29617
29618. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29619. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29620
29621.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
29622 "Local scan function"
29623.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
29624.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
29625.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
29626In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
29627want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
29628
29629The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
29630passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
29631a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
29632condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
29633non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
29634
29635To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
29636possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
29637in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
29638can of course use a little C stub to call it.
29639
29640The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
29641when Exim is just about to accept the message.
29642It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
29643well as messages arriving via SMTP.
29644
29645Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
29646option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
29647Zero means &"no timeout"&.
29648Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
29649before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
29650are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
29651incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
29652For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
29653code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
29654
29655
29656
29657.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
29658.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
29659To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
29660function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
29661&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
29662directory, so you might set
29663.code
29664LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
29665.endd
29666for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
29667Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
29668be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
29669function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
29670commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
29671_src/local_scan.c_.
29672
29673If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
29674for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
29675.code
29676LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29677.endd
29678in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
29679
29680
29681
29682
29683.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
29684.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
29685You must include this line near the start of your code:
29686.code
29687#include "local_scan.h"
29688.endd
29689This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
29690prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
29691almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
29692for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
29693It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
29694strings and pointers to character strings:
29695.code
29696#define CS (char *)
29697#define CCS (const char *)
29698#define CSS (char **)
29699#define US (unsigned char *)
29700#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
29701#define USS (unsigned char **)
29702.endd
29703The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
29704.code
29705extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
29706.endd
29707The arguments are as follows:
29708
29709.ilist
29710&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
29711(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
29712recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
29713
29714The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
29715character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
29716id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
29717macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
29718case this changes in some future version.
29719.next
29720&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
29721string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
29722.endlist
29723
29724The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
29725
29726.vlist
29727.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
29728.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
29729The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
29730the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
29731newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
29732maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
29733
29734.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
29735This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29736queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
29737
29738.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
29739This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29740queued without immediate delivery.
29741
29742.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
29743The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
29744passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
29745they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
29746&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
29747used.
29748
29749.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
29750The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
29751message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
29752problem"& is used.
29753
29754.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29755This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
29756message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
29757&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
29758&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
29759&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
29760same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29761
29762.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
29763This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
29764LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
29765.endlist
29766
29767If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
29768reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
29769&%-oe%& command line options.
29770
29771
29772
29773.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
29774.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
29775It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
29776that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
29777want to do this, you must have the line
29778.code
29779LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29780.endd
29781in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
29782&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
29783file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
29784to define them.
29785
29786The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
29787&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
29788and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
29789alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
29790variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
29791entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
29792.code
29793static int my_integer_option = 42;
29794static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
29795
29796optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
29797 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
29798 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
29799};
29800
29801int local_scan_options_count =
29802 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
29803.endd
29804The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
29805configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
29806.code
29807begin local_scan
29808my_integer = 99
29809my_string = some string of text...
29810.endd
29811The available types of option data are as follows:
29812
29813.vlist
29814.vitem &*opt_bool*&
29815This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
29816variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
29817that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
29818whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
29819TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
29820values.)
29821
29822.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
29823This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
29824The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
29825multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
29826
29827.vitem &*opt_int*&
29828This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
29829&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
29830Exim.
29831
29832.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
29833This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
29834&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
29835printed with the suffix K or M.
29836
29837.vitem &*opt_octint*&
29838This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
29839octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
29840always output in octal.
29841
29842.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
29843This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
29844variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
29845
29846.vitem &*opt_time*&
29847This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
29848type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
29849.endlist
29850
29851If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
29852out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
29853
29854
29855
29856.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
29857.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
29858The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
29859are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
29860Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
29861including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
29862C variables are as follows:
29863
29864.vlist
29865.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
29866This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
29867
29868.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
29869This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
29870
29871.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
29872This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
29873is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
29874&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
29875
29876.ilist
29877The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
29878testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
29879other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
29880
29881.next
29882The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
29883by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
29884of debugging bits.
29885.endlist ilist
29886
29887Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
29888selected, you should use code like this:
29889.code
29890if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29891 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29892.endd
29893.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
29894After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
29895variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
29896
29897.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
29898A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
29899discussed below.
29900
29901.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
29902A pointer to the last of the header lines.
29903
29904.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
29905The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
29906
29907.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
29908This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
29909&%-bh%& command line option.
29910
29911.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
29912The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
29913is NULL for locally submitted messages.
29914
29915.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
29916The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
29917command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
29918specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
29919
29920.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
29921This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
29922&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
29923
29924.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
29925The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
29926
29927.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
29928The number of accepted recipients.
29929
29930.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
29931.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
29932.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
29933The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
29934&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
29935can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
29936below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
29937adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
29938&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
29939value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
29940blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
29941and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
29942
29943.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
29944The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
29945
29946.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
29947The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
29948locally-submitted messages.
29949
29950.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
29951The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
29952was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
29953
29954.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
29955The name of the sending host, if known.
29956
29957.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
29958The port on the sending host.
29959
29960.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
29961This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
29962
29963.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
29964This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
29965
29966.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
29967The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
29968requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
29969.endlist
29970
29971
29972.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
29973The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
29974You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
29975(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
29976their type to *.
29977
29978
29979.vlist
29980.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
29981A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
29982
29983.vitem &*int&~type*&
29984A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
29985characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
29986Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
29987with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
29988rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
29989lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
29990
29991.vitem &*int&~slen*&
29992The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
29993internal newlines.
29994
29995.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
29996A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
29997a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
29998.endlist
29999
30000
30001
30002.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30003The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30004
30005.vlist
30006.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30007This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30008
30009.vitem &*int&~pno*&
30010This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30011the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30012and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30013
30014.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30015If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30016recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30017envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30018router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30019an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30020&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30021is NULL for all recipients.
30022.endlist
30023
30024
30025
30026.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30027.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30028The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30029These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30030release:
30031
30032.vlist
30033.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30034 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30035
30036This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30037&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30038be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30039for the process in &%newumask%&.
30040
30041Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30042and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30043standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30044descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30045argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30046
30047The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30048
30049.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30050This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30051seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30052return value is as follows:
30053
30054.ilist
30055>= 0
30056
30057The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30058ending status.
30059
30060.next
30061< 0 and > &--256
30062
30063The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30064signal number.
30065
30066.next
30067&--256
30068
30069The process timed out.
30070.next
30071&--257
30072
30073The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30074.endlist
30075
30076.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30077This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30078Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30079want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30080forks a subprocess that is running
30081.code
30082exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30083.endd
30084and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30085that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30086of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30087recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30088
30089When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30090finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30091fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30092addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30093
30094
30095.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30096 *sender_authentication)*&
30097This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30098that it runs is:
30099.display
30100&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30101.endd
30102The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30103
30104
30105.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30106This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30107output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30108calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30109conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30110.code
30111if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30112 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30113.endd
30114
30115.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30116This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30117expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30118The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30119expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30120the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30121block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30122&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30123
30124.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30125This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30126existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30127character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30128substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30129if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30130
30131.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30132 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30133This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30134chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30135
30136If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30137&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30138NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30139matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30140&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30141found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30142marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30143option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30144top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30145headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30146.code
30147header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30148 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30149.endd
30150Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30151there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30152
30153
30154.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30155This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30156occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30157particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30158match the specification, the function does nothing.
30159
30160
30161.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30162 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30163This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30164a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30165colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30166&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30167.code
30168if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30169.endd
30170.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30171.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30172This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30173The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30174back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30175zero-terminated.
30176
30177.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30178This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30179zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30180to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30181string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30182yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30183easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30184added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30185
30186.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30187This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30188matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30189.display
30190&`OK `& match succeeded
30191&`FAIL `& match failed
30192&`DEFER `& match deferred
30193.endd
30194DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30195inability to contact a database.
30196
30197.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30198 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30199This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30200controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30201&'lss_match_domain()'&.
30202
30203.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30204 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
30205This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30206controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30207matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30208
30209.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30210 uschar&~*list)*&"
30211This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30212expected to be
30213.code
30214lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30215.endd
30216.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30217An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30218is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30219looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30220values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30221returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30222failed.
30223
30224.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30225 *format,&~...)*&"
30226This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30227is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30228&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30229them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30230arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30231contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30232
30233
30234.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30235This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30236is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30237with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30238
30239This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30240described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30241the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30242value afterwards. For example:
30243.code
30244 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30245 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30246 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30247.endd
30248
30249.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30250This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30251recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30252matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30253address.
30254.endlist
30255
30256
30257.cindex "RFC 2047"
30258.vlist
30259.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30260 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30261This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30262these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30263from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30264a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30265made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30266binary string is returned with an error message.
30267
30268The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30269maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30270encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30271
30272.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30273.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30274If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30275contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30276not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30277
30278The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30279&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30280which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30281
30282If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30283argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30284set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30285returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30286with translation.
30287
30288
30289.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30290This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30291below.
30292
30293.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30294The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30295output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30296stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30297SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30298is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30299opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30300test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30301is involved.
30302
30303If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30304output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30305
30306Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30307must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30308LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30309LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30310initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30311to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30312that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30313.code
30314smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30315return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30316.endd
30317Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30318the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30319&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30320multiple output lines.
30321
30322The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30323does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30324the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30325detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30326you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30327dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30328arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30329is an error.
30330
30331.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
30332This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
30333chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
30334runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30335
30336.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
30337This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
30338permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30339
30340.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
30341See below.
30342
30343.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
30344See below.
30345
30346.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
30347These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
30348The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
30349number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
30350and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
30351pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
30352more discussion.
30353.endlist
30354
30355
30356
30357.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
30358.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
30359No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
30360The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
30361recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
30362to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
30363message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
30364terminates.
30365
30366Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
30367data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
30368connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
30369one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
30370
30371If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
30372in the same SMTP connection, you should set
30373.code
30374store_pool = POOL_PERM
30375.endd
30376before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
30377restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
30378the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
30379set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
30380
30381The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
30382&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
30383There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
30384block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
30385&%store_pool%&.
30386.ecindex IIDlosca
30387
30388
30389
30390
30391. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30392. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30393
30394.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
30395.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
30396.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
30397.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
30398The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
30399that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
30400also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
30401they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
30402
30403The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
30404is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
30405It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
30406commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
30407The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
30408
30409The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
30410is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
30411the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
30412If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
30413of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
30414prevent it happening on retries.
30415
30416.vindex "&$domain$&"
30417.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30418&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
30419specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
30420&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
30421you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
30422independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
30423described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
30424
30425
30426.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
30427.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
30428.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
30429The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
30430setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
30431other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
30432&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
30433.code
30434system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
30435system_filter_user = exim
30436.endd
30437If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
30438&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
30439specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
30440&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
30441&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
30442by the &%reply%& command.
30443
30444
30445.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
30446You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
30447filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
30448are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
30449
30450If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
30451you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
30452
30453
30454
30455.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
30456The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
30457files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
30458mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
30459available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
30460If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
30461they cause errors.
30462
30463.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
30464There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
30465files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
30466is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
30467&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
30468subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
30469manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
30470
30471&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
30472specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
30473succeed, it will not be tried again.
30474If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
30475arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
30476
30477When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
30478&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
30479users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
30480to which users' filter files can refer.
30481
30482
30483
30484.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
30485.vindex "&$recipients$&"
30486The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
30487of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
30488filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
30489
30490
30491
30492.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
30493.cindex "freezing messages"
30494.cindex "message" "freezing"
30495.cindex "message" "forced failure"
30496.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
30497.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
30498.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
30499There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
30500always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
30501filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
30502for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
30503word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
30504.code
30505fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
30506.endd
30507The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
30508
30509The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
30510message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
30511and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
30512delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
30513that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
30514run.
30515
30516The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
30517not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
30518filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
30519is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
30520
30521.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
30522.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
30523The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
30524well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
30525up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
30526log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
30527two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
30528strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
30529message. For example:
30530.code
30531fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
30532 because it contains attachments that we are \
30533 not prepared to receive."
30534.endd
30535
30536.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
30537Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
30538the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
30539the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
30540command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
30541Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
30542use, for example
30543.code
30544if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
30545then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
30546.endd
30547though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
30548alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
30549generated by the filter.
30550
30551The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
30552&%defer%&,
30553&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
30554set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
30555as
30556.code
30557mail ...
30558freeze
30559.endd
30560to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
30561failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
30562take place.
30563
30564
30565
30566.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
30567.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
30568.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
30569.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
30570Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
30571.code
30572headers add <string>
30573headers remove <string>
30574.endd
30575The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
30576added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
30577filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
30578space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
30579forced to fail, the command has no effect.
30580
30581You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
30582continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
30583including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
30584example:
30585.code
30586headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
30587 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
30588 X-header-2: ...."
30589.endd
30590Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
30591be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
30592space after input continuations is ignored.
30593
30594The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
30595This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
30596those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
30597&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
30598header with the same name, they are all removed.
30599
30600The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
30601of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
30602from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
30603modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
30604Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
30605used for all recipients of the message.
30606
30607During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
30608header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
30609that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
30610routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
30611routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
30612until the message is actually being written (see section
30613&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
30614
30615If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
30616added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
30617present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
30618present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
30619message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
30620conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
30621modified more than once.
30622
30623Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
30624use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
30625For example:
30626.code
30627headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
30628headers remove "Subject"
30629headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
30630headers remove "Old-Subject"
30631.endd
30632
30633
30634
30635.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
30636.cindex "envelope sender"
30637In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
30638.code
30639errors_to <some address>
30640.endd
30641in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
30642delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
30643user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
30644might use
30645.code
30646unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
30647.endd
30648to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
30649address if its delivery failed.
30650
30651
30652
30653.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
30654.vindex "&$domain$&"
30655.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30656In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
30657delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
30658operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
30659such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
30660filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
30661which implements such a filter:
30662.code
30663central_filter:
30664 check_local_user
30665 driver = redirect
30666 domains = +local_domains
30667 file = /central/filters/$local_part
30668 no_verify
30669 allow_filter
30670 allow_freeze
30671.endd
30672The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
30673&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
30674the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
30675use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
30676
30677Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
30678specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
30679its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
30680address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
30681normal way.
30682.ecindex IIDsysfil1
30683.ecindex IIDsysfil2
30684.ecindex IIDsysfil3
30685
30686
30687
30688
30689
30690
30691. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30692. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30693
30694.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
30695.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
30696Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
30697all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
30698these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
30699this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
30700removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
30701before it is placed on Exim's queue.
30702
30703Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
30704&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
30705that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
30706its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
30707set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
30708
30709&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
30710or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
30711loopback interface specially in any way.
30712
30713If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
30714that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
30715
30716
30717
30718
30719.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
30720.cindex "message" "submission"
30721.cindex "submission mode"
30722Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
30723&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
30724received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
30725state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
30726.code
30727control = submission
30728.endd
30729in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
30730&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
30731a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
30732known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
30733example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
30734interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
30735.code
30736warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
30737 control = submission
30738.endd
30739.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
30740There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
30741is used to separate options. For example:
30742.code
30743control = submission/sender_retain
30744.endd
30745Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
30746true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
30747of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
30748the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
30749authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
30750&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
30751attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
30752
30753When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
30754domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
30755example:
30756.code
30757control = submission/domain=some.domain
30758.endd
30759The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
30760&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
30761that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
30762&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
30763.code
30764accept authenticated = *
30765 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
30766 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
30767 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
30768.endd
30769Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
30770option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
30771the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
30772.code
30773bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
30774.endd
30775then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
30776line would be:
30777.code
30778Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
30779.endd
30780.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
30781By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
30782used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
30783specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
30784
30785&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
30786ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
30787untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
30788specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
30789does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
30790spoof another's address.
30791
30792.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
30793.cindex "line endings"
30794.cindex "carriage return"
30795.cindex "linefeed"
30796RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
30797linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
30798SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
30799conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
30800use CRLF or just CR.
30801
30802Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
30803using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
30804receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
30805Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
30806MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
30807has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
30808that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
30809other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
30810follows:
30811
30812.ilist
30813LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
30814.next
30815CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
30816is ignored.
30817.next
30818The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
30819nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
30820terminator.
30821.next
30822If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
30823the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
30824is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
30825people trying to play silly games.
30826.next
30827If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
30828bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
30829line.
30830.endlist
30831
30832
30833
30834
30835
30836.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
30837.cindex "unqualified addresses"
30838.cindex "address" "qualification"
30839By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
30840host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
30841SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
30842messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
30843requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
30844
30845Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
30846sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
30847&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
30848cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
30849value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
30850
30851.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
30852.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
30853Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
30854that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
30855line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
30856are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
30857other words, such qualification is also controlled by
30858&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
30859
30860
30861
30862
30863.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
30864.cindex "&""From""& line"
30865.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
30866.cindex "sender" "address"
30867.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
30868.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
30869.cindex "envelope sender"
30870.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30871Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
30872with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
30873&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
30874.code
30875From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
30876From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
30877.endd
30878This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
30879Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
30880via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
30881such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
30882&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
30883and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
30884regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
30885default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
30886that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
30887
30888.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
30889When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
30890a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
30891contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
30892then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
30893qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
30894the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
30895
30896If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
30897sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
30898that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
30899
30900Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
30901treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
30902as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
30903incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
30904
30905
30906
30907.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
30908.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
30909RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
30910&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
30911recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
30912&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
30913&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
30914
30915.blockquote
30916&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
30917processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
30918.endblockquote
30919
30920This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
30921address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
30922follows:
30923
30924.ilist
30925A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
30926is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
30927.next
30928If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
30929&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
30930&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
30931.next
30932For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
30933also removed.
30934.next
30935For a locally-submitted message,
30936if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
30937&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
30938the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
30939included in log lines in this case.
30940.next
30941The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
30942&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
30943.endlist
30944
30945
30946
30947
30948.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
30949Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
30950includes the header line:
30951.code
30952Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
30953.endd
30954
30955.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
30956.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
30957If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
30958message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
30959extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
30960existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
30961
30962
30963.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
30964.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
30965If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
30966Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
30967&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
30968
30969.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
30970.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
30971.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
30972&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
30973set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
30974the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
30975in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
30976set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
30977messages.
30978
30979
30980.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
30981.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
30982.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
30983&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
30984Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
30985generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
30986messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
30987(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
30988messages.
30989
30990
30991.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
30992.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
30993.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30994.cindex "message" "submission"
30995.cindex "submission mode"
30996If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
30997adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
30998
30999.ilist
31000The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31001message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31002.next
31003.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31004The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31005.olist
31006.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31007If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31008&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31009.next
31010If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31011part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31012.next
31013If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31014&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31015.endlist
31016.endlist
31017
31018A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31019
31020If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31021line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31022containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31023are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31024They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31025&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31026&%qualify_domain%&.
31027
31028For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31029&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31030user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31031name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31032
31033
31034.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31035.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31036.cindex "message" "submission"
31037.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31038If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31039&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31040&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31041to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31042creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31043message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31044followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31045in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31046&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31047
31048
31049.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31050.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31051A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31052contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31053Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31054
31055The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31056have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31057line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31058that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31059
31060Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31061changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31062-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31063
31064
31065.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31066.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31067Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31068header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31069section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31070header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31071responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31072processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31073than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31074incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3107511 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31076
31077
31078
31079.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31080.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31081.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31082&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31083it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31084transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31085transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31086default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31087
31088
31089
31090.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31091.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31092.cindex "message" "submission"
31093For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31094existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31095these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31096&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31097control setting.
31098
31099When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31100&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31101control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31102&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31103that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31104&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31105be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31106appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31107line is added to the message.
31108
31109If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31110the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31111&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31112options true at the same time.
31113
31114.cindex "submission mode"
31115By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31116received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31117a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31118not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31119
31120.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31121First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31122authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31123created as follows:
31124
31125.ilist
31126.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31127If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31128&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31129.next
31130If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31131is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31132.next
31133If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31134&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31135.endlist
31136
31137This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31138are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31139added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31140by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31141
31142.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31143&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31144the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31145except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31146
31147
31148
31149.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31150 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31151.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31152.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31153When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31154specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31155process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31156modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31157as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31158
31159In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31160specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31161addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31162changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31163transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31164they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31165
31166&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31167the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31168expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31169
31170For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31171option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31172newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31173.code
31174headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31175 X-added-second: another added header line
31176.endd
31177Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31178
31179The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31180list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31181often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31182not part of the names. For example:
31183.code
31184headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31185.endd
31186When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31187is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31188accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31189an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31190forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31191
31192.oindex "&%unseen%&"
31193However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31194the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31195&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31196
31197Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31198settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31199dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31200requirements.
31201
31202The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31203with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31204these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31205recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31206consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31207names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31208instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31209
31210After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31211lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31212the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31213header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31214
31215This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31216the following consequences:
31217
31218.ilist
31219The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31220remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31221to it, at all times.
31222.next
31223Header lines that are added by a router's
31224&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31225expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31226.next
31227Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31228in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31229.next
31230Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31231a later router or by a transport.
31232.next
31233An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31234removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31235.code
31236headers_remove = subject
31237headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31238.endd
31239.endlist
31240
31241&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31242for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31243
31244
31245
31246
31247
31248.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31249.cindex "address" "constructed"
31250.cindex "constructed address"
31251When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31252the form
31253.display
31254<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31255.endd
31256For example:
31257.code
31258Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31259.endd
31260The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31261otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31262&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31263ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31264upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31265&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31266The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31267there is no password file entry.
31268
31269.cindex "RFC 2047"
31270In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31271parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31272characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31273including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31274&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31275characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31276&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31277is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31278
31279
31280
31281.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31282.cindex "case of local parts"
31283.cindex "local part" "case of"
31284RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31285be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31286addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31287because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31288routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31289original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31290router option.
31291
31292.cindex "mixed-case login names"
31293If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31294assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31295your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31296correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31297.code
31298correct_case:
31299 driver = redirect
31300 domains = +local_domains
31301 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31302 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31303 @$domain
31304.endd
31305For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31306(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31307up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31308on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31309local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31310
31311
31312
31313.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31314.cindex "dot" "in local part"
31315.cindex "local part" "dots in"
31316RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31317part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31318middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31319empty components for compatibility.
31320
31321
31322
31323.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
31324.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
31325Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
31326happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
31327in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
31328&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
31329
31330Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
31331in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
31332routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
31333example, a header such as
31334.code
31335To: hare@teaparty
31336.endd
31337might get rewritten as
31338.code
31339To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
31340.endd
31341Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
31342does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
31343been routed.
31344
31345Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
31346addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
31347result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
31348deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
31349immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
31350routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
31351.ecindex IIDmesproc
31352
31353
31354
31355. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31356. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31357
31358.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
31359.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
31360.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
31361Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
31362LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
31363closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
31364processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
31365
31366.ilist
31367SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
31368.next
31369SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
31370.next
31371Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
31372.endlist
31373
31374For mail delivery, the following are available:
31375
31376.ilist
31377SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
31378.next
31379LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
31380&"lmtp"&);
31381.next
31382LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
31383transport);
31384.next
31385Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
31386the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
31387.endlist
31388
31389&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
31390stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
31391used to contain the envelope information.
31392
31393
31394
31395.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
31396.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
31397.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
31398.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
31399.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
31400.cindex "EHLO"
31401.cindex "HELO"
31402.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31403Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
31404The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
31405processing is the same in both cases.
31406
31407If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
31408parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
31409command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
31410&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
31411such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
31412.cindex "transport" "filter"
31413.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
31414transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
31415suppressed.
31416
31417If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
31418pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
31419required for the transaction.
31420
31421If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
31422was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
31423server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
31424
31425If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
31426the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
31427in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
31428
31429.cindex "carriage return"
31430.cindex "linefeed"
31431Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31432LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
31433order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31434line terminator.
31435
31436If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
31437characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
31438same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
31439even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
31440of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
31441they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
31442each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
31443in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
31444significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
31445
31446When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
31447message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
31448records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
31449particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
31450
31451.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
31452Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
31453a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
31454See the next section for more detail about error handling.
31455
31456.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31457.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
31458When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
31459looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
31460messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
31461creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
31462a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
31463so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
31464does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
31465turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
31466
31467The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
31468limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
31469
31470.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31471The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
31472identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
31473square bracket of the IP address.
31474
31475
31476
31477
31478.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
31479.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
31480.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
31481.cindex "host" "error"
31482Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
31483message errors, and recipient errors.
31484
31485.vlist
31486.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
31487A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
31488particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
31489
31490.ilist
31491Connection refused or timed out,
31492.next
31493Any error response code on connection,
31494.next
31495Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
31496.next
31497Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
31498.next
31499I/O errors at any time,
31500.next
31501Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
31502the &"."& at the end of the data.
31503.endlist ilist
31504
31505For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
31506EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
31507error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
31508host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
31509the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
31510alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
31511host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
31512made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
31513
31514.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
31515.cindex "message" "error"
31516A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
31517particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
31518message errors are:
31519
31520.ilist
31521Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
31522the data,
31523.next
31524Timeout after MAIL,
31525.next
31526Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
31527timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
31528connection at any other time.
31529.endlist ilist
31530
31531For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
31532to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
31533temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
31534addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
31535a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
31536message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
31537that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
31538time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
31539affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
31540it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
31541
31542If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
31543to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
31544over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
31545response to MAIL.
31546
31547.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
31548.cindex "recipient" "error"
31549A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
31550recipient errors are:
31551
31552.ilist
31553Any error response to RCPT,
31554.next
31555Timeout after RCPT.
31556.endlist
31557
31558For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
31559recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
31560sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
31561address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
31562used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
31563routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
31564operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
31565to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
31566if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
31567(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
31568have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
31569the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
31570the retry clock is reset.
31571
31572The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
31573host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
31574other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
31575in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
31576proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
31577than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
31578if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
31579through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
31580recipient's retry time.
31581.endlist
31582
31583In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
31584current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
31585tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
31586own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
31587until the next delivery attempt.
31588
31589Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
31590MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
31591would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
31592host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
31593What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
31594is created.
31595
31596The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
31597these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
31598procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
31599response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
31600it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
31601message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
31602helpful to treat this case as a message error.
31603
31604Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
31605host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
31606or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
31607the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
31608then to be treated as a host error.
31609
31610There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
31611terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
31612reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
31613should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
31614host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
31615
31616
31617
31618
31619.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
31620.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
31621.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
31622.cindex "inetd"
31623.cindex "daemon"
31624Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
31625listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
31626&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
31627.code
31628smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
31629.endd
31630Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
31631agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
31632a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
31633the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
31634with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
31635stream and exits with an error code.
31636
31637By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
31638disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
31639unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
31640&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
31641
31642.cindex "carriage return"
31643.cindex "linefeed"
31644Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31645LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
31646order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31647line terminator.
31648Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
31649sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
31650sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
31651
31652.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
31653.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
31654One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
31655HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
31656commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
31657the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
31658Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
31659match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
31660
31661.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31662.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
31663The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
31664a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
31665&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
31666false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
31667&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
31668value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
31669message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
31670
31671When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
31672its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
31673logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
31674
31675The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
31676prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
31677number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
31678&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
31679rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
31680
31681The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
31682subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
31683for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
31684things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
31685processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
31686sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
31687it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
31688
31689When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
31690and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
31691high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
31692&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
31693applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
31694
31695Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
31696can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
31697&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
31698number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
31699SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
31700&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
31701subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
31702a delivery process.
31703
31704The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
31705&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
31706started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
31707handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
31708however, available with &'inetd'&.
31709
31710Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
31711are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
31712to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
31713section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
31714
31715Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
31716MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
31717&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
31718
31719
31720
31721.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
31722.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
31723If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
31724commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
31725the error response to the last command. The default value for
31726&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
31727abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
31728circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
31729
31730
31731.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
31732.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
31733.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
31734A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
31735something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
31736address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
31737sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
31738&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
31739drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
31740default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
31741broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
31742
31743
31744
31745.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
31746.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
31747The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
31748DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
31749many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
31750denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
31751client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
31752defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
31753
31754When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
31755allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
31756but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
31757or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
31758starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
31759counted.
31760
31761The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
31762STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
31763RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
31764
31765You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
31766&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
31767&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
31768the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
31769specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
31770
31771
31772
31773
31774.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
31775When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
31776runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
31777appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
31778If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31779
31780.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
31781When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
31782called with the &%-bv%& option.
31783
31784.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
31785When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
31786EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
31787than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
31788as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
31789of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
31790VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
31791RCPT failures.
31792
31793
31794
31795.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
31796.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
31797RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
31798overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
31799disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
31800the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
31801should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
31802
31803The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
31804delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
31805the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
31806text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
31807specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
31808the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
31809argument. For example,
31810.code
31811ETRN #brigadoon
31812.endd
31813runs the command
31814.code
31815exim -R brigadoon
31816.endd
31817which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
31818containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
31819default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
31820for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
31821a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
31822
31823.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
31824Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
31825record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
31826the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
31827the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
31828a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
31829left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
31830Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
31831
31832.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
31833For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
31834used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
31835whatever the form of its argument. For
31836example:
31837.code
31838smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
31839 $sender_host_address
31840.endd
31841.vindex "&$domain$&"
31842The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
31843expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
31844and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
31845wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
31846under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
31847for it to change them before running the command.
31848
31849
31850
31851.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
31852.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
31853Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
31854standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
31855line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
31856&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
31857messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
31858sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
31859an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
31860identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
31861runs for RCPT commands:
31862.code
31863accept hosts = :
31864.endd
31865This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
31866
31867
31868
31869.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
31870.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
31871.cindex "batched SMTP output"
31872Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
31873batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
31874be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
31875delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
31876envelope along with the message.
31877
31878The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
31879MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
31880the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
31881HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
31882can be used to specify it.
31883
31884Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
31885one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
31886to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
31887this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
31888chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
31889
31890.vindex "&$host$&"
31891When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
31892sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
31893transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
31894router:
31895.code
31896begin routers
31897route_append:
31898 driver = manualroute
31899 transport = smtp_appendfile
31900 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
31901
31902begin transports
31903smtp_appendfile:
31904 driver = appendfile
31905 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
31906 batch_max = 1000
31907 use_bsmtp
31908 user = exim
31909.endd
31910This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
31911format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
31912message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
31913
31914
31915
31916.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
31917.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
31918.cindex "batched SMTP input"
31919The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
31920reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
31921is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
31922sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
31923rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
31924and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
31925as NOOP; QUIT quits.
31926
31927Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
31928ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
31929
31930If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
31931the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
31932standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
31933make some use of automatically, for example:
31934.code
31935554 Unexpected end of file
31936Transaction started in line 10
31937Error detected in line 14
31938.endd
31939It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
31940file, for example:
31941.code
31942An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
31943The error message was:
31944
31945501 '>' missing at end of address
31946
31947The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
31948The error was detected in line 12.
31949The SMTP command at fault was:
31950
31951rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
31952
319531 previous message was successfully processed.
31954The rest of the batch was abandoned.
31955.endd
31956The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
31957messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
31958accepted.
31959.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
31960.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
31961
31962
31963
31964. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31965. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31966
31967.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
31968 "Customizing messages"
31969When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
31970configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
31971to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
31972the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
31973string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
31974
31975The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
31976cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
31977option. Exim also adds the line
31978.code
31979Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
31980.endd
31981to all warning and bounce messages,
31982
31983
31984.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
31985.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
31986.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
31987If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
31988message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
31989delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
31990&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
31991
31992When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
31993constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
31994separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
31995opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
31996logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
31997item.
31998
31999.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32000.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32001Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32002expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32003the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32004&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32005option, rounded to a whole number.
32006
32007The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32008
32009.ilist
32010The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32011&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32012.next
32013The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32014failing addresses with their error messages.
32015.next
32016The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32017returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32018.next
32019The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32020as part of the error report.
32021.next
32022The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32023truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32024.next
32025The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32026.endlist
32027
32028The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32029following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32030other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32031.code
32032Subject: Mail delivery failed
32033 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32034 {: returning message to sender}}
32035****
32036This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32037
32038A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32039 {that you sent }{sent by
32040
32041<$sender_address>
32042
32043}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32044This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32045****
32046The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32047****
32048------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32049 ------
32050****
32051------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32052 only the first
32053------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32054****
32055.endd
32056.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32057.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32058.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32059The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32060warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32061text sections:
32062
32063.ilist
32064The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32065&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32066.next
32067The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32068the delayed addresses.
32069.next
32070The third item then ends the message.
32071.endlist
32072
32073The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32074have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32075.code
32076Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32077 $warn_message_delay
32078****
32079This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32080
32081A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32082{that you sent }{sent by
32083
32084<$sender_address>
32085
32086}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32087more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32088
32089The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32090The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32091The date of the message is: $h_date
32092
32093The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32094****
32095No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32096continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32097intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32098mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32099the message will be returned to you.
32100.endd
32101.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32102.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32103However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32104appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32105&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32106minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32107of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32108multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32109handled them.
32110
32111
32112
32113
32114. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32115. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32116
32117.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32118This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32119common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32120
32121
32122
32123.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32124.cindex "smart host" "example router"
32125If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32126should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32127routing explicitly:
32128.code
32129send_to_smart_host:
32130 driver = manualroute
32131 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32132 transport = remote_smtp
32133.endd
32134You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32135If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32136receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32137synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32138&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32139
32140
32141
32142
32143.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32144.cindex "mailing lists"
32145Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32146requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32147Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32148
32149The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32150is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32151independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32152lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32153.code
32154lists:
32155 driver = redirect
32156 domains = lists.example
32157 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32158 forbid_pipe
32159 forbid_file
32160 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32161 no_more
32162.endd
32163This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32164in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32165such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32166routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32167
32168The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32169expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32170a mailing list.
32171
32172.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32173The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32174taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32175original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32176the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32177
32178For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32179&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32180&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32181&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32182There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32183the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32184such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32185or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32186&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32187
32188
32189
32190.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32191.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32192If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32193delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32194list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32195list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32196addresses are not rigorously checked.
32197
32198If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32199entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32200&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32201whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32202&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32203
32204
32205
32206.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32207.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32208Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32209in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32210recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32211cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32212delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32213account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32214the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32215message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32216
32217If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32218on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32219router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32220&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32221&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32222subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32223failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32224pre-existing messages.
32225
32226The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32227addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32228addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32229&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32230one level of expansion anyway.
32231
32232
32233
32234.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32235.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32236The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32237send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32238from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32239&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32240
32241The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32242of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32243.code
32244lists_request:
32245 driver = redirect
32246 domains = lists.example
32247 local_part_suffix = -request
32248 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32249 no_more
32250
32251lists_post:
32252 driver = redirect
32253 domains = lists.example
32254 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32255 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32256 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32257 forbid_pipe
32258 forbid_file
32259 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32260 no_more
32261
32262lists_closed:
32263 driver = redirect
32264 domains = lists.example
32265 allow_fail
32266 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32267.endd
32268All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32269they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32270&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32271mailing list.
32272
32273The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32274checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32275checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32276necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32277because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32278not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32279means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32280&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32281&"unrouteable address"& error.
32282
32283The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32284a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32285the address, giving a suitable error message.
32286
32287
32288
32289
32290.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32291.cindex "VERP"
32292.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32293.cindex "envelope sender"
32294Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32295are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32296address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32297the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32298if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32299original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32300
32301.oindex &%errors_to%&
32302.oindex &%return_path%&
32303Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32304facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32305list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32306these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32307host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32308of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32309of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32310.code
32311verp_smtp:
32312 driver = smtp
32313 max_rcpt = 1
32314 return_path = \
32315 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32316 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32317.endd
32318This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32319SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32320&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
32321local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
32322example, that a message whose return path has been set to
32323&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
32324&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
32325rewritten as
32326.code
32327somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
32328.endd
32329.vindex "&$local_part$&"
32330For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
32331have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
32332achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
32333might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
32334&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
32335
32336Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
32337probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
32338extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
32339can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
32340.code
32341dnslookup:
32342 driver = dnslookup
32343 domains = ! +local_domains
32344 transport = \
32345 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32346 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
32347 no_more
32348.endd
32349If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
32350of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
32351routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
32352errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
32353address.
32354
32355On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
32356&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
32357SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
32358and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
32359of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
32360.code
32361verp_dnslookup:
32362 driver = dnslookup
32363 domains = ! +local_domains
32364 transport = remote_smtp
32365 errors_to = \
32366 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
32367 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32368 no_more
32369.endd
32370Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
32371configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
32372Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
32373router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
32374them.
32375
32376The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
32377message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
32378host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
32379a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
32380a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
32381than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
32382used).
32383
32384
32385
32386
32387
32388
32389.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
32390.cindex "virtual domains"
32391.cindex "domain" "virtual"
32392The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
32393meanings:
32394
32395.ilist
32396A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
32397aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
32398top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
32399.next
32400One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
32401with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
32402have login accounts on that host.
32403.endlist
32404
32405The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
32406the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
32407aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
32408virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
32409whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
32410to a router of this form:
32411.code
32412virtual:
32413 driver = redirect
32414 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
32415 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
32416 no_more
32417.endd
32418The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
32419is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
32420domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
32421part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
32422setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
32423string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
32424
32425This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
32426follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
32427can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
32428a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
32429
32430The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
32431way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
32432valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
32433.code
32434my_domains:
32435 driver = accept
32436 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
32437 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
32438 transport = my_mailboxes
32439.endd
32440The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
32441can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
32442file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
32443option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
32444because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
32445follows:
32446.code
32447my_mailboxes:
32448 driver = appendfile
32449 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
32450 user = mail
32451.endd
32452This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
32453required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
32454
32455The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
32456requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
32457up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
32458information about the domains.
32459
32460
32461
32462.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
32463.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
32464.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
32465.cindex "local part" "prefix"
32466.cindex "local part" "suffix"
32467Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
32468incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
32469allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
32470identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
32471parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
32472&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
32473example, consider this router:
32474.code
32475userforward:
32476 driver = redirect
32477 check_local_user
32478 file = $home/.forward
32479 local_part_suffix = -*
32480 local_part_suffix_optional
32481 allow_filter
32482.endd
32483.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
32484It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
32485&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
32486cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
32487.code
32488if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
32489save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
32490endif
32491.endd
32492If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
32493fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
32494&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
32495control over which suffixes are valid.
32496
32497Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
32498&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
32499another MTA:
32500.code
32501userforward:
32502 driver = redirect
32503 check_local_user
32504 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
32505 local_part_suffix = -*
32506 local_part_suffix_optional
32507 allow_filter
32508.endd
32509If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
32510example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
32511does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
32512subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
32513&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
32514
32515
32516
32517.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
32518.cindex "vacation processing"
32519The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
32520a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
32521(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
32522This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
32523that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
32524
32525.ilist
32526A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
32527can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
32528alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
32529&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
32530.code
32531spqr, vacation-spqr
32532.endd
32533.next
32534The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
32535vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
32536user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
32537ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
32538to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
32539message.
32540.endlist
32541
32542Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
32543use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
32544
32545
32546
32547.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
32548.cindex "message" "copying every"
32549Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
32550be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
32551command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
32552each day's messages.
32553
32554There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
32555messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
32556delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
32557notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
32558
32559
32560
32561.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
32562.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
32563It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
32564Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
32565arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
32566permanently connected.
32567
32568Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
32569particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
32570Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
32571
32572
32573.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
32574It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
32575host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
32576approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
32577being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
32578some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
32579to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
32580resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
32581
32582A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
32583intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
32584into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
32585format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
32586destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
32587in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
32588if required.
32589
32590On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
32591you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
32592intermittent host. For example:
32593.code
32594cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
32595.endd
32596This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
32597which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
32598online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
32599options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
32600causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
32601connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
32602immediately.
32603
32604If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
32605issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
32606mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
32607used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
32608avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
32609Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
32610arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
32611
32612
32613
32614.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
32615The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
32616increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
32617connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
32618delivered immediately.
32619
32620.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32621.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
32622.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
32623Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
32624not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
32625possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
32626each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
32627avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
32628&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
32629first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
32630normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
32631destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
32632single SMTP connection.
32633
32634
32635
32636. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32637. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32638
32639.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
32640 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
32641.cindex "client, non-queueing"
32642.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
32643On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
32644email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
32645configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
32646However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
32647configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
32648&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
32649messages this way.
32650
32651If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
32652run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
32653any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
32654continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
32655email is not desirable.
32656
32657There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
32658&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
32659any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
32660host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
32661informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
32662to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
32663to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
32664
32665There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
32666that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
32667ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
32668before sending a message to the smart host.
32669
32670Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
32671tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
32672overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
32673
32674.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
32675There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
32676Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
32677assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
32678just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
32679compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
32680router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
32681
32682When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
32683following ways:
32684
32685.ilist
32686A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
32687In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
32688.next
32689Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
32690assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
32691&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
32692does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
32693successful, a zero return code is given.
32694.next
32695Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
32696be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
32697the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
32698must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
32699deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
32700are.
32701.next
32702If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
32703failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
32704successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
32705.next
32706Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
32707is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
32708smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
32709the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
32710there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
32711.next
32712If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
32713connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
32714failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
32715.next
32716When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
32717(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
32718value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
32719are ever generated.
32720.next
32721No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
32722.next
32723A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
32724true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
32725&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
32726.endlist
32727
32728The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
32729the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
32730deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
32731privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
32732to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
32733the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
32734
32735
32736
32737
32738. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32740
32741.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
32742.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
32743.cindex "log" "types of"
32744Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
32745and the panic log:
32746
32747.ilist
32748.cindex "main log"
32749The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
32750line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
32751down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
32752out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
32753them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
32754they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
32755analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
32756&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
32757.next
32758.cindex "reject log"
32759The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
32760of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
32761The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
32762the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
32763is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
32764lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
32765reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
32766host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
32767can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
32768false.
32769.next
32770.cindex "panic log"
32771.cindex "system log"
32772When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
32773error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
32774are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
32775other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
32776therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
32777regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
32778panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
32779is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
32780message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
32781.endlist
32782
32783Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
32784example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
32785In the log file, this would be all on one line:
32786.code
327872001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
32788 by QUIT
32789.endd
32790By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
32791ways of changing this:
32792
32793.ilist
32794You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
32795you set
32796.code
32797timezone = UTC
32798.endd
32799the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
32800.next
32801If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
32802example:
32803.code
328042003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
32805.endd
32806.endlist
32807
32808.cindex "log" "process ids in"
32809.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32810Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
32811request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
32812&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
32813brackets, immediately after the time and date.
32814
32815
32816
32817
32818.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
32819.cindex "log" "destination"
32820.cindex "log" "to file"
32821.cindex "log" "to syslog"
32822.cindex "syslog"
32823The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
32824should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
32825are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
32826arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
32827It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
32828need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
32829Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
32830
32831The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
32832&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
32833configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
32834references to the host name:
32835.code
32836log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
32837.endd
32838It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
32839rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
32840start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
32841before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
32842configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
32843log at all.
32844
32845The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
32846list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
32847facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
32848colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
32849otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
32850point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
32851implying the use of a default path.
32852
32853When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
32854LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
32855&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
32856mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
32857files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
32858equivalent to the setting:
32859.code
32860log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
32861.endd
32862If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
32863logs are written.
32864
32865A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
32866are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
32867
32868Here are some examples of possible settings:
32869.display
32870&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
32871&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
32872&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
32873&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
32874.endd
32875If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
32876error is logged.
32877
32878
32879
32880.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
32881.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32882.cindex "cycling logs"
32883.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32884.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
32885Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
32886log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
32887provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
32888main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
32889keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
32890
32891An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
32892and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
32893example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
32894message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
32895that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
32896something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
32897ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
32898&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
32899does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
32900tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
32901for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
32902renamed.
32903
32904
32905
32906.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
32907.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
32908Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
32909periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
32910for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
32911&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
32912the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
32913point where the datestamp is required. For example:
32914.code
32915log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
32916log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
32917log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
32918log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
32919.endd
32920As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
32921examples of names generated by the above examples:
32922.code
32923/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
32924/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
32925/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
32926/var/log/exim/main.200212
32927.endd
32928When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
32929files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
32930will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
32931run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
32932
32933The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
32934is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
32935When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
32936the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
32937non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
32938character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
32939log names:
32940.code
32941/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
32942/var/log/exim-panic.log
32943/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
32944/var/log/exim/panic
32945.endd
32946
32947
32948.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
32949.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
32950The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
32951except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
32952Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
32953that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
32954&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
32955by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
32956&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
32957SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
32958&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
32959LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
32960the time and host name to each line.
32961The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
32962
32963.ilist
32964&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
32965.next
32966&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
32967.next
32968&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
32969.endlist
32970
32971Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
32972written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
32973these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
32974by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
32975
32976Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
32977entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
32978these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
32979calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
32980870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
32981additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
32982replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
32983RFC 3164, you should set
32984.code
32985SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
32986.endd
32987in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
32988lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
32989
32990To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
32991entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
32992where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
32993components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
32994because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
32995delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
32996870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
32997&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
32998name, and pid as added by syslog:
32999.code
33000[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33001[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33002[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33003[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33004[5/5] mple>)
33005.endd
33006The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33007(LOG_NOTICE):
33008.code
33009[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33010[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33011[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33012[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33013[5\18] .example>)
33014[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33015[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33016[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33017[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33018[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33019[11\18] 09:43 +0100
33020[12\18] F From: <>
33021[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33022[18\18] X-something: this is another header
33023[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33024[16\18] le>
33025[17\18] B Bcc:
33026[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33027.endd
33028Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33029without modification.
33030
33031If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33032display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33033the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33034where it is.
33035
33036
33037
33038.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33039One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33040successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33041picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33042timestamp. The flags are:
33043.display
33044&`<=`& message arrival
33045&`=>`& normal message delivery
33046&`->`& additional address in same delivery
33047&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33048&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33049&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33050.endd
33051
33052
33053.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33054.cindex "log" "reception line"
33055The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33056message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33057several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33058.code
330592002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33060 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33061 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33062.endd
33063The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33064bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33065generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33066.code
33067R=<message id>
33068.endd
33069which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33070
33071.cindex "HELO"
33072.cindex "EHLO"
33073For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33074record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33075received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33076host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33077above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33078&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33079by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33080verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33081EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33082name in parentheses.
33083
33084Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33085without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33086the log containing text like these examples:
33087.code
33088H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33089H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33090.endd
33091This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33092on.
33093
33094For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33095the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33096of Exim.
33097
33098.cindex "authentication" "logging"
33099.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33100For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33101message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33102of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33103extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33104session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33105suite that was used.
33106
33107The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33108hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33109value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33110there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33111was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33112&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33113authenticator name.
33114
33115.cindex "size" "of message"
33116The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33117received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33118headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33119message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33120other).
33121
33122The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33123data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33124
33125
33126
33127.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33128.cindex "log" "delivery line"
33129The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33130delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33131deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33132to fit it on the page:
33133.code
331342002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33135 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
331362002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33137 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33138 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33139.endd
33140For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33141after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33142intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33143last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33144fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33145
33146If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33147for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33148.display
33149&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33150.endd
33151If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33152parentheses afterwards.
33153
33154.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33155When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33156SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33157flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33158down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33159lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33160
33161The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33162&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33163
33164The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33165data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33166
33167
33168.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33169.cindex "discarded messages"
33170.cindex "message" "discarded"
33171.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33172When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33173obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33174.code
331752002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33176 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33177.endd
33178is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33179because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33180.code
331811999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33182 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33183.endd
33184
33185
33186.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33187When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33188.code
331892002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33190 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33191.endd
33192In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33193last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33194written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33195.code
331962002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33197 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33198.endd
33199When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33200a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33201appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33202
33203
33204
33205.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33206.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33207If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33208following form is logged:
33209.code
332101995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33211 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33212.endd
33213If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33214the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33215.code
332162002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33217 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33218 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33219 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33220 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33221.endd
33222The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33223used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33224disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33225flagged with &`**`&.
33226
33227
33228
33229.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33230.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33231If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33232used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33233&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33234
33235
33236
33237.section "Completion" "SECID257"
33238A line of the form
33239.code
332402002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33241.endd
33242is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33243at the end of its processing.
33244
33245
33246
33247
33248.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33249.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33250A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33251the following table:
33252.display
33253&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
33254&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33255&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33256&`CV `& certificate verification status
33257&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33258&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33259&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33260&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33261&`H `& host name and IP address
33262&`I `& local interface used
33263&`id `& message id for incoming message
33264&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33265&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33266&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33267&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33268&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33269&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33270&`S `& size of message
33271&`ST `& shadow transport name
33272&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33273&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33274&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33275&`X `& TLS cipher suite
33276.endd
33277
33278
33279.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33280Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33281self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33282
33283.ilist
33284.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33285&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33286during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33287This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33288during the first delivery attempt.
33289.next
33290&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33291temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33292for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
33293.next
33294.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
33295&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
33296some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
33297common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
33298&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
33299doing.
33300.next
33301.cindex "error" "ignored"
33302&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33303message:
33304.olist
33305Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33306&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33307.next
33308A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
33309failed. The delivery was discarded.
33310.next
33311A delivery set up by a router configured with
33312. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
33313. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
33314.code
33315 errors_to = <>
33316.endd
33317failed. The delivery was discarded.
33318.endlist olist
33319.endlist ilist
33320
33321
33322
33323
33324
33325.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
33326.cindex "log" "selectors"
33327By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
33328default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
33329&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
33330example:
33331.code
33332log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
33333.endd
33334The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
33335selection marked by asterisks:
33336.display
33337&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
33338&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
33339&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
33340&` arguments `& command line arguments
33341&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
33342&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
33343&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
33344&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
33345&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
33346&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
33347&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
33348&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
33349&` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
33350&` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
33351&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
33352&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
33353&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
33354&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
33355&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
33356&` pid `& Exim process id
33357&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
33358&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
33359&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
33360&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
33361&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
33362&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
33363&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
33364&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
33365&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
33366&` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
33367&` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
33368&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
33369&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
33370&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
33371&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
33372&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
33373&` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
33374&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
33375&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
33376&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
33377&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
33378
33379&` all `& all of the above
33380.endd
33381More details on each of these items follows:
33382
33383.ilist
33384.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
33385&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
33386its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
33387this log selector is set.
33388.next
33389.cindex "log" "rewriting"
33390.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
33391&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
33392rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
33393such users cannot access the log).
33394.next
33395.cindex "log" "full parentage"
33396&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
33397delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
33398parentheses between them.
33399.next
33400.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
33401.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
33402&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
33403to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
33404feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
33405&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
33406privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
33407that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
33408are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
33409because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
33410only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
33411between the caller and Exim.
33412.next
33413.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
33414&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
33415connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
33416.next
33417.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
33418.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
33419&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
33420started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
33421messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
33422process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
33423.next
33424.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
33425&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
33426perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
33427.next
33428.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
33429.cindex "size" "of message"
33430&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
33431the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
33432.next
33433.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
33434.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
33435.cindex "black list (DNS)"
33436&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
33437DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
33438.next
33439.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
33440.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
33441&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
33442is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
33443command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
33444selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
33445.next
33446.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
33447&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
33448any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
33449log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
33450routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
33451.next
33452.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
33453.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
33454&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
33455client's ident port times out.
33456.next
33457.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
33458.cindex "interface" "logging"
33459&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
33460to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
33461followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
33462added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
33463rejection lines.
33464.next
33465.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
33466.cindex "port" "logging remote"
33467.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
33468.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
33469.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
33470&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
33471added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
33472in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
33473changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
33474&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
33475important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
33476.next
33477.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
33478&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
33479connection is unexpectedly dropped.
33480.next
33481.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
33482.cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
33483.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
33484&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
33485containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
33486the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
33487number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
33488.next
33489.cindex "log" "process ids in"
33490.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33491&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
33492immediately after the time and date.
33493.next
33494.cindex "log" "queue run"
33495.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
33496&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
33497.next
33498.cindex "log" "queue time"
33499&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
33500local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
33501&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
33502includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
33503This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
33504delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
33505message has been successfully received.
33506.next
33507&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
33508the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
33509example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
33510message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
33511.next
33512.cindex "log" "recipients"
33513&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
33514as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
33515that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
33516addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
33517has taken place.
33518Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
33519in the list.
33520.next
33521.cindex "log" "sender reception"
33522&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
33523the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
33524&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
33525.next
33526.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
33527&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
33528rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
33529log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
33530rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
33531.next
33532.cindex "log" "retry defer"
33533&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
33534retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
33535message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
33536attempt.
33537.next
33538.cindex "log" "return path"
33539&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
33540the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
33541This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
33542or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
33543.next
33544.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
33545&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
33546and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
33547This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
33548necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
33549.next
33550.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
33551&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
33552gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
33553the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
33554detail is lost.
33555.next
33556.cindex "log" "size rejection"
33557&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
33558it is too big.
33559.next
33560.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
33561.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
33562&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
33563queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
33564it.
33565.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
33566The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
33567.next
33568.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
33569.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
33570&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
33571outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
33572A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
33573response.
33574.next
33575.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
33576.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
33577&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
33578established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
33579&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
33580only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
33581processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
33582dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
33583not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
33584of connections unless this selector is enabled.
33585
33586For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
33587included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
33588reset if the daemon is restarted.
33589Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
33590subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
33591whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
33592match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
33593logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
33594.next
33595.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
33596.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
33597&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
33598RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
33599and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
33600line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
33601.next
33602.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
33603.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
33604&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
33605connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
33606the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
33607does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
33608an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
33609already have their own log lines.
33610
33611The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
33612way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
33613If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
33614an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
33615DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
33616the same logging options.
33617
33618Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
33619is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
33620.code
33621C=EHLO,QUIT
33622.endd
33623shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
33624than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
33625the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
33626setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
33627have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
33628.next
33629.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
33630.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
33631&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
33632encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
33633because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
33634been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
33635it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
33636received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
33637.next
33638.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
33639.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
33640.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
33641.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
33642.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
33643&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
33644encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
33645external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
33646using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
33647.next
33648.cindex "log" "subject"
33649.cindex "subject, logging"
33650&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
33651preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
33652Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
33653specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
33654unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
33655.next
33656.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
33657&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
33658when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
33659verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
33660.next
33661.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
33662.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
33663&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33664connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
33665.next
33666.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
33667.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
33668&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33669connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
33670added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
33671.next
33672.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
33673.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
33674&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
33675the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
33676added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
33677.next
33678.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
33679&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
33680result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
33681.endlist
33682
33683
33684.section "Message log" "SECID260"
33685.cindex "message" "log file for"
33686.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
33687.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
33688.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
33689In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
33690that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
33691they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
33692message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
33693makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
33694to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
33695is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
33696only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
33697
33698On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
33699per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
33700&%message_logs%& option false.
33701.ecindex IIDloggen
33702
33703
33704
33705
33706. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33707. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33708
33709.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
33710.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
33711A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
33712described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
33713the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
33714
33715.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
33716.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
33717 "list what Exim processes are doing"
33718.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
33719.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
33720.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
33721.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
33722 various criteria"
33723.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
33724.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
33725 "extract statistics from the log"
33726.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
33727 "check address acceptance from given IP"
33728.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
33729.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
33730.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
33731.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
33732.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
33733.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
33734.endtable
33735
33736Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
33737&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
33738&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
33739
33740
33741
33742
33743.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
33744.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
33745.cindex "process, querying"
33746.cindex "SIGUSR1"
33747On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
33748(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
33749a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
33750Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
33751processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
33752second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
33753order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
33754send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
33755
33756&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
33757use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
33758script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
33759
33760
33761Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
33762varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
33763but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
33764system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
33765it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
33766options:
33767.display
33768&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
33769&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
33770&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
33771&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
33772.endd
33773An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
33774.code
33775164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3377610483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3377710492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
33778 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3377910592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3378010628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
33781.endd
33782The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
33783been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
33784
33785
33786
33787.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
33788.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
33789.cindex "queue" "grepping"
33790This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
33791.code
33792exim -bpu
33793.endd
33794to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
33795output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
33796options are available:
33797
33798.vlist
33799.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
33800Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
33801brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
33802.code
33803exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
33804.endd
33805.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
33806Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
33807brackets.
33808
33809.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
33810Match against the size field.
33811
33812.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33813Match messages that are younger than the given time.
33814
33815.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
33816Match messages that are older than the given time.
33817
33818.vitem &*-z*&
33819Match only frozen messages.
33820
33821.vitem &*-x*&
33822Match only non-frozen messages.
33823.endlist
33824
33825The following options control the format of the output:
33826
33827.vlist
33828.vitem &*-c*&
33829Display only the count of matching messages.
33830
33831.vitem &*-l*&
33832Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
33833the default.
33834
33835.vitem &*-i*&
33836Display message ids only.
33837
33838.vitem &*-b*&
33839Brief format &-- one line per message.
33840
33841.vitem &*-R*&
33842Display messages in reverse order.
33843.endlist
33844
33845There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
33846
33847
33848
33849.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
33850.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
33851.cindex "queue" "summary"
33852The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
33853-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
33854running a command such as
33855.code
33856exim -bp | exiqsumm
33857.endd
33858The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
33859it, as in the following example:
33860.code
338613 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
33862.endd
33863Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
33864volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
33865been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
33866number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
33867
33868A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
33869domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
33870the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
33871respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
33872domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
33873separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
33874sender.
33875
33876The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
33877this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
33878generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
33879option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
33880level"& addresses).
33881
33882
33883
33884
33885.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
33886 "SECTextspeinf"
33887.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
33888.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
33889The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
33890files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
33891extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
33892match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
33893given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
33894The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
33895If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
33896included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
33897.display
33898&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
33899.endd
33900If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
33901
33902The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
33903condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
33904they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
33905
33906By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
33907makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
33908large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
33909option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
33910case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
33911
33912The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
33913pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
33914regular expression.
33915
33916The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
33917if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
33918
33919If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
33920ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
33921whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
33922
33923
33924.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
33925.cindex "&'exipick'&"
33926John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
33927lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
33928of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
33929&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
33930the &%--help%& option.
33931
33932
33933.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
33934.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33935.cindex "cycling logs"
33936.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33937The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
33938&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
33939you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
33940&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
33941for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
33942There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
33943.ilist
33944&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
33945default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
33946.next
33947&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
33948&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
33949overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
33950configuration.
33951.endlist
33952
33953Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
33954the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
33955run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
33956&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
33957&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
33958logs are handled similarly.
33959
33960If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
33961&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
33962to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
33963any existing log files.
33964
33965If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
33966the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
33967using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
33968setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
33969root &%crontab%& entry of the form
33970.code
339711 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
33972.endd
33973assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
33974&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
33975
33976
33977
33978.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
33979.cindex "statistics"
33980.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
33981A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
33982information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
33983Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
33984LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
33985
33986The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
33987latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
33988lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
33989various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
33990list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
33991.code
33992eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
33993.endd
33994By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
33995messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
33996both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
33997are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
33998addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
33999options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34000also produced per user.
34001
34002The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34003histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34004hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34005example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34006as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34007
34008Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34009have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34010messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34011and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34012recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34013an entirely separate message.
34014
34015&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34016of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34017each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34018not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34019least one address that failed.
34020
34021The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34022or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34023transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34024(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34025a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34026senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34027and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34028
34029The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34030came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34031without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34032
34033There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34034outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34035by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34036.code
34037perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34038.endd
34039
34040.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34041.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34042.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34043.cindex "checking access"
34044The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34045debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34046policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34047familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34048sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34049access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34050
34051The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34052two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34053.code
34054exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34055.endd
34056The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34057given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34058connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34059is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34060.code
34061Rejected:
34062550 Relay not permitted
34063.endd
34064When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34065for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34066options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34067that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34068you can use:
34069.code
34070exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34071 -f himself@there.example
34072.endd
34073Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34074mandatory arguments.
34075
34076Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34077while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34078&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34079
34080
34081
34082.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34083.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34084.cindex "building DBM files"
34085.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34086.cindex "lower casing"
34087.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34088The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34089the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34090&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34091names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34092can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34093
34094A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34095the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34096&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34097strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34098files.
34099
34100The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34101single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34102It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34103well.
34104
34105.cindex "USE_DB"
34106If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34107configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34108names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34109a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34110.code
34111exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34112.endd
34113reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34114&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34115
34116In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34117Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34118environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34119&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34120when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34121recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34122
34123If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34124finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34125option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34126this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34127&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34128There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34129&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34130return code is 2.
34131
34132
34133
34134
34135.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34136.cindex "retry" "times"
34137.cindex "&'exinext'&"
34138A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34139fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34140complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34141information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34142is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34143output. For example:
34144.code
34145$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34146kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34147 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34148 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34149 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34150roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34151 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34152 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34153 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34154 past final cutoff time
34155.endd
34156You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34157will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34158A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34159message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34160suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34161&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34162run very often.
34163
34164The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34165of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34166passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34167configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34168file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34169environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34170
34171
34172
34173.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34174.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34175.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34176Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34177uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34178arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34179second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34180
34181.ilist
34182&'retry'&: the database of retry information
34183.next
34184&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34185for remote hosts
34186.next
34187&'callout'&: the callout cache
34188.next
34189&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34190.next
34191&'misc'&: other hints data
34192.endlist
34193
34194The &'misc'& database is used for
34195
34196.ilist
34197Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34198.next
34199Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34200&(smtp)& transport)
34201.endlist
34202
34203
34204
34205.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34206.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34207The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34208&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34209spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34210.code
34211exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34212.endd
34213Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34214.code
34215T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3421631-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34217.endd
34218The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34219of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34220transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34221a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34222address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34223transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34224to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34225and a textual description of the error.
34226
34227The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34228the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34229ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34230exceeded.
34231
34232Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34233consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34234waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34235one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34236may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34237may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34238cross-references.
34239
34240
34241
34242.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34243.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34244The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34245database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34246days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34247updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34248since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34249for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34250updated sufficiently often.
34251
34252The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34253followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34254the retry database:
34255.code
34256exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34257.endd
34258Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34259message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34260they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34261are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34262types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34263message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34264queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34265&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34266For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34267removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34268whenever it removes information from the database.
34269
34270Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34271needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34272down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34273first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34274records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34275
34276It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34277hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
34278a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
34279work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
34280but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
34281After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
34282point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
34283tidied.
34284
34285&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
34286databases is likely to keep on increasing.
34287
34288
34289
34290
34291.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
34292.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
34293The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
34294Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
34295getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
34296is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
34297key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
34298displayed.
34299
34300If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
34301except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
34302out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
34303data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
34304by new data, for example:
34305.code
34306> 4 951102:1000
34307.endd
34308resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
34309sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
34310used as optional separators.
34311
34312
34313
34314
34315.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
34316.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
34317.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
34318.cindex "locking mailboxes"
34319The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
34320Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
34321&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
34322a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
34323the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
34324argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
34325second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
34326is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
34327is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
34328
34329.vlist
34330.vitem &%-fcntl%&
34331Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
34332
34333.vitem &%-flock%&
34334Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
34335supports it.
34336
34337.vitem &%-interval%&
34338This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
34339interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
34340
34341.vitem &%-lockfile%&
34342Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
34343
34344.vitem &%-mbx%&
34345Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
34346
34347.vitem &%-q%&
34348Suppress verification output.
34349
34350.vitem &%-retries%&
34351This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
34352the lock (default 10).
34353
34354.vitem &%-restore_time%&
34355This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
34356locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
34357example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
34358subsequently sees.
34359
34360.vitem &%-timeout%&
34361This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
34362timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
34363default), a non-blocking call is used.
34364
34365.vitem &%-v%&
34366Generate verbose output.
34367.endlist
34368
34369If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
34370default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
34371mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
34372&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
34373requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
34374file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
34375more than 30 minutes old.
34376
34377The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
34378&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
34379to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
34380&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
34381number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
34382can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
34383
34384The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
34385&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
34386suppresses all output except error messages.
34387
34388A command such as
34389.code
34390exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
34391.endd
34392runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
34393.display
34394&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
34395<&'some commands'&>
34396&`End`&
34397.endd
34398runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
34399suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
34400such as
34401.code
34402exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
34403 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
34404.endd
34405Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
34406second argument &-- hence the quotes.
34407.ecindex IIDutils
34408
34409
34410. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34411. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34412
34413.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
34414.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
34415.cindex "X-windows"
34416.cindex "&'eximon'&"
34417.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
34418.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
34419The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
34420about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
34421perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
34422such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
34423monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
34424
34425
34426
34427.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
34428The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
34429script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
34430binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
34431be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
34432&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
34433parameters are for.
34434
34435The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
34436a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
34437preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
34438.code
34439EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
34440.endd
34441(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
34442the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
34443overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
34444&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
34445syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
34446
34447X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
34448way. For example, a resource setting of the form
34449.code
34450Eximon*background: gray94
34451.endd
34452changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
34453stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
34454black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
34455data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
34456&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
34457For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
34458reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
34459.code
34460xrdb -merge <<End
34461Eximon*highlight: gray
34462End
34463.endd
34464.cindex "admin user"
34465In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
34466&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
34467
34468The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
34469contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
34470if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
34471binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
34472versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
34473
34474The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
34475more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
34476main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
34477delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
34478different parts of the display.
34479
34480
34481
34482
34483.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
34484.cindex "stripchart"
34485The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
34486be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34487&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
34488configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
34489it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
34490hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
34491received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
34492period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
34493parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34494
34495The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
34496displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
34497title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
34498For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
34499
34500It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
34501a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
34502to a single partition.
34503
34504.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
34505This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
34506the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
34507this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
34508100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
34509SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34510&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34511
34512
34513
34514
34515.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
34516.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
34517.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
34518.cindex "window size"
34519Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
34520to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
34521shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
34522stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
34523the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
34524in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
34525
34526When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
34527currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
34528size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
34529remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
34530
34531The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
34532stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
34533the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
34534The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
34535&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
34536the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34537
34538Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
34539built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
34540START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34541
34542
34543
34544.section "The log display" "SECID267"
34545.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
34546The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
34547the main log is maintained.
34548To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
34549removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
34550The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
34551syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
34552to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
34553
34554The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
34555move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
34556scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
34557LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
34558to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
34559much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
34560a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
34561only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
34562available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
34563normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
34564configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34565
34566Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
34567and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
34568respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
34569It cannot go further back up the log.
34570
34571The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
34572normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
34573by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
34574by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
34575back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
34576the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
34577
34578Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
34579There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
34580the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
34581happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
34582&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
34583^C is typed the search is cancelled.
34584
34585The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
34586widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
34587&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
34588eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
34589However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
34590provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
34591come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
34592unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
34593on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
34594window.
34595
34596
34597
34598.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
34599.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
34600The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
34601are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
34602as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
34603parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
34604at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
34605the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
34606there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
34607to force an update of the queue display at any time.
34608
34609When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
34610and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
34611with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
34612pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
34613type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
34614such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
34615of the texts, the message is not displayed.
34616
34617If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
34618are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
34619example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
34620&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
34621has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
34622cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
34623a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
34624
34625While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
34626else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
34627queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
34628pressing the &"Hide"& button.
34629
34630The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
34631time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
34632message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
34633a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
34634recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
34635listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
34636an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
34637not shown.
34638
34639.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
34640If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
34641
34642The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
34643of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
34644The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
34645available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
34646display is updated.
34647
34648
34649
34650.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
34651.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
34652If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
34653pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
34654line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
34655any selected text.
34656
34657If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
34658MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
34659set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
34660value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
34661run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
34662.code
34663EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
34664.endd
34665The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
34666follows:
34667
34668.ilist
34669&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
34670in a new text window.
34671.next
34672&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
34673information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
34674&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
34675.next
34676&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
34677displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
34678amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
34679option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
34680.next
34681&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
34682delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
34683frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
34684a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
34685up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
34686.next
34687&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
34688that the message be frozen.
34689.next
34690.cindex "thawing messages"
34691.cindex "unfreezing messages"
34692.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
34693&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
34694that the message be thawed.
34695.next
34696.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
34697&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
34698that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
34699for any remaining undelivered addresses.
34700.next
34701&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
34702that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
34703message.
34704.next
34705&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
34706be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34707is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34708Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34709causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
34710additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
34711which case no action is taken.
34712.next
34713&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
34714can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34715is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34716Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34717causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
34718recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
34719case no action is taken.
34720.next
34721&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
34722mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
34723.next
34724&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
34725sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
34726&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
34727in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
34728bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
34729not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
34730the address is qualified with that domain.
34731.endlist
34732
34733When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
34734other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
34735particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
34736output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
34737from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
34738&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
34739if no output is generated.
34740
34741The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
34742thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
34743&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
34744force an update of the display after one of these actions.
34745
34746In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
34747cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
34748and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
34749.ecindex IIDeximon
34750
34751
34752
34753
34754
34755. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34756. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34757
34758.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
34759.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
34760This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
34761which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
34762
34763For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
34764Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
34765existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
34766chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
34767security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
34768its security as compared with other MTAs.
34769
34770What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
34771have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
34772absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
34773as soon as possible.
34774
34775
34776.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
34777.cindex "security" "build-time features"
34778There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
34779to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
34780Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
34781penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
34782
34783.ilist
34784ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
34785start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
34786names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
34787value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
34788&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
34789default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
34790
34791If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
34792which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
34793into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
34794configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
34795.next
34796
34797If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
34798or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
34799file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
34800the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
34801root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
34802right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
34803reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
34804it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
34805privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
34806separate commands.
34807
34808.next
34809The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
34810with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
34811CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
34812requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
34813the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
34814but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
34815previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
34816.next
34817If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
34818is disabled.
34819.next
34820FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
34821never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
34822option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
34823to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
34824is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
34825.endlist
34826
34827
34828
34829.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
34830.cindex "setuid"
34831.cindex "root privilege"
34832The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
34833privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
34834example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
34835may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
34836discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
34837is required for two things:
34838
34839.ilist
34840To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
34841the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
34842not required.
34843.next
34844To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
34845perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
34846configuration.
34847.endlist
34848
34849It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
34850receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
34851obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
34852For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
34853&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
34854group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
34855is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
34856&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
34857
34858Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
34859abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
34860&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
34861
34862After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
34863uid and gid in the following cases:
34864
34865.ilist
34866.oindex "&%-C%&"
34867.oindex "&%-D%&"
34868If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
34869the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
34870calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
34871the calling process.
34872However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
34873option may not be used at all.
34874If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
34875can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
34876user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
34877.next
34878.oindex "&%-be%&"
34879.oindex "&%-bf%&"
34880.oindex "&%-bF%&"
34881If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
34882(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
34883calling process.
34884.next
34885If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
34886process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
34887uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
34888runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
34889testing address verification
34890.oindex "&%-bv%&"
34891.oindex "&%-bh%&"
34892(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
34893option).
34894.next
34895For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
34896remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
34897.endlist
34898
34899The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
34900
34901.ilist
34902A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
34903user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
34904function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
34905will be used during message reception.
34906.next
34907A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
34908job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
34909.next
34910A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
34911but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
34912subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
34913deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
34914remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
34915subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
34916while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
34917generating bounce and warning messages.
34918
34919While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
34920process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
34921this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
34922gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
34923.next
34924A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
34925the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
34926.endlist
34927
34928
34929
34930
34931.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
34932.cindex "privilege, running without"
34933.cindex "unprivileged running"
34934.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
34935Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
34936operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
34937by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
34938gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
34939(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
34940routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
34941to any other uid.
34942
34943.cindex SIGHUP
34944.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
34945Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
34946that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
34947correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
34948
34949An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
34950to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
34951process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
34952when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
34953SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
34954
34955It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
34956stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
34957been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
34958effect.
34959
34960If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
34961set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
34962to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
34963
34964In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
34965those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
34966Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
34967that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
34968discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
34969have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
34970number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
34971address this problem at this time.
34972
34973For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
34974is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
34975&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
34976be used in the most straightforward way.
34977
34978If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
34979number of restrictions on what you can do:
34980
34981.ilist
34982You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
34983&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
34984normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
34985work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
34986explicit specification of another user causes an error.
34987.next
34988Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
34989not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
34990.next
34991Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
34992the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
34993and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
34994enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
34995.next
34996Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
34997some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
34998
34999.olist
35000They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35001implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35002mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35003.next
35004You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35005owned by the Exim user.
35006.next
35007You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35008on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35009mailboxes need to be created manually.
35010.endlist olist
35011.endlist ilist
35012
35013
35014These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35015However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35016gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35017gives more security at essentially no cost.
35018
35019If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35020&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35021
35022
35023
35024
35025.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35026Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35027are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35028
35029
35030
35031.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35032.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35033.cindex "IP source routing"
35034Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35035some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35036IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35037IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35038
35039
35040
35041.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35042Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35043be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35044
35045
35046
35047
35048.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35049.cindex "trusted users"
35050.cindex "admin user"
35051.cindex "privileged user"
35052.cindex "user" "trusted"
35053.cindex "user" "admin"
35054Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35055able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35056addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35057local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35058permit a remote host to be specified.
35059
35060.oindex "&%-f%&"
35061However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35062in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35063message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35064but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35065permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35066the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35067
35068Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35069other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35070the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35071as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35072group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35073
35074Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35075can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35076them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35077the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35078includes the contents of files on the spool.
35079
35080.oindex "&%-M%&"
35081.oindex "&%-q%&"
35082By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35083delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
35084restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
35085Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
35086queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
35087setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
35088
35089Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
35090the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
35091the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
35092group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
35093the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
35094unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
35095files.
35096
35097
35098
35099.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
35100.cindex "spool directory" "files"
35101Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
35102set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
35103&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
35104any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
35105
35106
35107
35108.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
35109Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
35110of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
35111with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
35112to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
35113this.
35114
35115
35116
35117.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
35118The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
35119are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
35120Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
35121converted output.
35122
35123
35124
35125.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
35126Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
35127to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
35128does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
35129arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
35130
35131
35132
35133.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35134Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35135defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35136loading it.
35137
35138
35139.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35140.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35141A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35142&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35143The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35144that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35145conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35146
35147The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35148the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35149string.
35150
35151
35152
35153.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35154Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35155formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35156the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35157
35158
35159
35160.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35161These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35162enough to hold the result.
35163.ecindex IIDsecurcon
35164
35165
35166
35167
35168. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35169. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35170
35171.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35172.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35173.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35174.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35175.cindex "spool files" "editing"
35176A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35177followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35178the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35179kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35180two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35181is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35182themselves are recoverable.
35183
35184Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35185need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35186on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35187
35188.ilist
35189You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35190fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35191which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35192place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35193lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35194.next
35195.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35196If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35197&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35198present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35199will always be the case.
35200.next
35201If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35202.next
35203If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35204signature.
35205.endlist
35206All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35207
35208Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35209its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35210files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35211the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35212the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35213is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35214file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
35215-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
35216attempt.
35217
35218.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
35219.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
35220.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
35221The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
35222process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
35223gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
35224message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
35225normally the Exim user.
35226
35227The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
35228transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
35229empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
35230in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
35231created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
35232&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
35233leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
35234&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
35235
35236The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
35237was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
35238start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
35239warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
35240
35241There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
35242order, and are omitted when not relevant:
35243
35244.vlist
35245.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35246This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
35247&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
35248recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
35249this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
35250identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
35251the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
35252the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
35253the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
35254newlines.
35255
35256.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35257A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
35258defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
35259The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35260starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35261character. It may contain internal newlines.
35262
35263.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35264A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
35265Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
35266length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35267starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35268character. It may contain internal newlines.
35269
35270.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
35271This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
35272&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
35273
35274.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
35275This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
35276lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
35277transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
35278messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35279
35280.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
35281This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
35282(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
35283time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
35284hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35285
35286.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
35287The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
35288&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
35289
35290.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
35291The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
35292&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
35293
35294.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35295This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
35296present.
35297
35298.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35299This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
35300present if the number is greater than zero.
35301
35302.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
35303This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
35304file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
35305
35306.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
35307.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
35308The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
35309
35310.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35311This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
35312command.
35313
35314.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35315This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
35316the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
35317messages.
35318
35319.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
35320If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
35321the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
35322&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
35323
35324.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
35325This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
35326address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
35327
35328.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35329.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
35330.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
35331This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
35332if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
35333received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
35334
35335.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
35336For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
35337unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
35338ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
35339supplied by the remote host, if any.
35340
35341.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35342This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
35343which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
35344generated messages.
35345
35346.vitem &%-local%&
35347The message is from a local sender.
35348
35349.vitem &%-localerror%&
35350The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
35351
35352.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
35353This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
35354when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
35355variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
35356
35357.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
35358The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
35359Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
35360
35361.vitem &%-N%&
35362A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
35363actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
35364&%-N%& is assumed.
35365
35366.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
35367This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
35368the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35369
35370.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
35371The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
35372to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
35373
35374.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
35375If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
35376of &$spam_score_int$&.
35377
35378.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
35379A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
35380certificate was verified by the server.
35381
35382.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
35383When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
35384name of the cipher suite that was used.
35385
35386.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
35387When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
35388was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
35389certificate.
35390.endlist
35391
35392Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
35393is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
35394line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
35395is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
35396the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
35397balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
35398to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
35399original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
35400addresses are complete.
35401
35402If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
35403the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
35404Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
35405tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
35406right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
35407follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
35408.code
35409YY darcy@austen.fict.example
35410NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
35411NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35412.endd
35413After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
35414This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
35415recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
35416delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
35417example:
35418.code
354194
35420editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35421darcy@austen.fict.example
35422rdo@foundation
35423alice@wonderland.fict.example
35424.endd
35425However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
35426result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
35427line is of the following form:
35428.display
35429<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
35430 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
35431.endd
35432The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
35433the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
35434fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
35435original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
35436envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
35437length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
35438characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
35439that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
35440
35441
35442A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
35443which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
35444when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
35445character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
35446embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
35447following:
35448
35449.table2 50pt
35450.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
35451.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
35452.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
35453.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
35454.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
35455.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
35456.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
35457.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
35458.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
35459.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
35460.endtable
35461
35462Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
35463purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
35464typical set of headers:
35465.code
35466111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
35467id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35468049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
35469038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
35470042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
35471049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
35472099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
35473darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35474104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
35475darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35476038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35477.endd
35478The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
35479&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
35480unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
35481.ecindex IIDforspo1
35482.ecindex IIDforspo2
35483.ecindex IIDforspo3
35484
35485. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35486. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35487
35488.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHID12" &&&
35489 "DKIM Support"
35490.cindex "DKIM"
35491
35492DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
35493linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
35494be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
35495DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
35496
35497Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
35498disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
35499
35500Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
35501.olist
35502Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
35503It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
35504.next
35505Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
35506ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
35507different signature contexts.
35508.endlist
35509
35510In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
35511default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
35512Exim's standard controls.
35513
35514Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
35515on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
35516exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
35517signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
35518.code
355192009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
35520 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
35521 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
35522 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
35523.endd
35524You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
35525or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
35526control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
35527where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
35528senders).
35529
35530
35531.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
35532.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
35533
35534Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
35535These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
35536
35537.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
35538MANDATORY:
35539The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
35540option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
35541
35542.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
35543MANDATORY:
35544This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
35545variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
35546variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
35547option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
35548
35549.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
35550MANDATORY:
35551This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
35552&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
35553The result can either
35554.ilist
35555be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
35556.next
35557start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
35558the private key.
35559.next
35560be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
35561be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
35562is set.
35563.endlist
35564
35565.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
35566OPTIONAL:
35567This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
35568The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
35569The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
35570only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
35571
35572.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
35573OPTIONAL:
35574This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
35575should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
35576either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
35577unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
35578variables here.
35579
35580.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
35581OPTIONAL:
35582When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
35583list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
35584signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
35585used.
35586
35587
35588.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
35589.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
35590
35591Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
35592&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
35593syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
35594
35595To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
35596containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
35597runtime of the ACL.
35598
35599Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
35600more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
35601&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
35602&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
35603
35604The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
35605list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
35606called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
35607the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
35608list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
35609&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
35610it defaults as:
35611.code
35612dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
35613.endd
35614This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
35615DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
35616call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
35617.code
35618dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
35619.endd
35620This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
35621and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
35622You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
35623.code
35624dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
35625.endd
35626
35627If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
35628&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
35629
35630
35631Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
35632available (from most to least important):
35633
35634
35635.vlist
35636.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
35637The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
35638an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
35639&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
35640.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
35641A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
35642.ilist
35643&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
35644identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35645.next
35646&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
35647More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35648.next
35649&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
35650available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35651.next
35652&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
35653.endlist
35654.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
35655A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
35656"fail" or "invalid". One of
35657.ilist
35658&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
35659key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
35660.next
35661&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
35662record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
35663.next
35664&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
35665body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
35666means that the message body was modified in transit.
35667.next
35668&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
35669could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
35670re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
35671DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
35672.endlist
35673.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
35674The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
35675an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
35676reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35677.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
35678The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
35679if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
35680identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35681.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
35682The key record selector string.
35683.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
35684The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
35685.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
35686The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35687.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
35688The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35689.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
35690A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
35691(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
35692.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
35693The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
35694limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
35695that this variable always expands to an integer value.
35696.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
35697UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
35698When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
35699.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
35700UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
35701signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
35702signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
35703integer size comparisons against this value.
35704.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
35705A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
35706.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
35707"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
35708.vitem &%$nosubdomains%&
35709"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
35710.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
35711Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35712in the key record.
35713.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
35714Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35715in the key record.
35716.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
35717Notes from the key record (tag n=).
35718.endlist
35719
35720In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
35721
35722.vlist
35723.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
35724ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
35725for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
35726(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
35727verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
35728
35729.code
35730# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
35731warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
35732 sender_domains = gmail.com
35733 dkim_signers = gmail.com
35734 dkim_status = none
35735.endd
35736
35737.vitem &%dkim_status%&
35738ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
35739results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
35740to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
35741
35742.code
35743deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
35744 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
35745 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
35746 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
35747.endd
35748
35749The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
35750see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
35751for more information of what they mean.
35752.endlist
35753
35754. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35755. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35756
35757.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
35758 "Adding drivers or lookups"
35759.cindex "adding drivers"
35760.cindex "new drivers, adding"
35761.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
35762The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
35763authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
35764
35765.olist
35766Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
35767existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
35768.next
35769Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
35770.display
35771<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
35772.endd
35773where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
35774code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
35775should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
35776.next
35777Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
35778.code
35779#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
35780.endd
35781.next
35782Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
35783and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
35784.next
35785Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
35786&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
35787driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
35788.next
35789Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
35790&_src_&.
35791.next
35792Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
35793as for other drivers and lookups.
35794.endlist
35795
35796Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
35797proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
35798occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
35799options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
35800searched using a binary chop procedure.
35801
35802There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
35803the interface that is expected.
35804
35805
35806
35807
35808. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35809. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35810
35811. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35812. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
35813. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
35814. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
35815. processors.
35816. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35817
35818.literal xml
35819<?sdop
35820 format="newpage"
35821 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
35822 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
35823?>
35824.literal off
35825
35826.makeindex "Options index" "option"
35827.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
35828.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
35829
35830
35831. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35832. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////